AMET Ltd B737 NG SERIES REFRESHER COURSE B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd CONTENTS ATA 00 – GEN FAM GEN FAM ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 8 -800 STRUCTURE DIMENSIONS ..................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 10 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 10 -700 STRUCTURE DIMENSIONS ..................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 12 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 12 TURNING RADIUS................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 12 FUSELAGE DIMENSIONS ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 14 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 14 TRAINING INFORMATION POINT........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 14 WINGLETS ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 16 GENERAL DESCRIPTION ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 16 POWERPLANT ENGINE HAZARDS ............................................................................................................................................................................................................... 18 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 18 INLET SUCTION .................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 18 EXHAUST HEAT ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 18 EXHAUST VELOCITY ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 18 ENGINE NOISE ..................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 18 ENGINE ENTRY/EXIT CORRIDOR.......................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 18 TRAINING INFORMATION POINT........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 18 ANTENNA LOCATIONS .................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 20 ANTENNA LOCATIONS ......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 20 FLIGHT COMPARTMENT PANELS ............................................................................................................................................................................................................... 22 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 22 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd MAIN INSTRUMENT PANEL ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 24 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 24 FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION.................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 24 TRAINING INFORMATION POINT........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 24 P7 GLARESHIELD PANEL ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 26 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 26 P2 CENTER INSTRUMENT AND P9 FORWARD ELECTRONICS ........................................................................................................................................................... 28 PANEL ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 28 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 28 CONTROL STAND .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 30 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 30 P8 AFT ELECTRONICS PANEL ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 32 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 32 P5 AFT OVERHEAD PANEL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 34 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 34 P5 FORWARD OVERHEAD PANEL ................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 36 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 36 AFT FLIGHT COMPARTMENT PANELS ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 38 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 38 LOADABLE SOFTWARE ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 40 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 40 SYSTEMS .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 40 LOADABLE SOFTWARE BINDER ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 40 LOCATION OF JUNCTION BOXES ................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 42 GENERAL DESCRIPTION ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 42 ELECTRONIC EQUIPMENT COMPARTMENT ........................................................................................................................................................................................... 44 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 44 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 3 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ELECTRONIC EQUIPMENT RACKS E1, E8 ................................................................................................................................................................................................. 46 E1 RACK .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 46 E8 RACK .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 46 PROGRAM SWITCH MODULES .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 46 ELECTRONICS EQUIPMENT RACKS E2, E3, & E4 .................................................................................................................................................................................... 48 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 48 TRAINING INFORMATION POINT........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 48 ELECTRONIC EQUIPMENT RACK E5 .......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 50 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 50 ELECTRONIC EQUIPMENT RACK E6 .......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 52 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 52 PASSENGER COMPARTMENT - PASSENGER SERVICE UNITS ............................................................................................................................................................ 54 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 54 PHYSICAL DESCRIPTION/LOCATION .................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 54 TRAINING INFORMATION POINT........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 54 EXTERIOR LIGHTING ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 56 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 56 LANDING LIGHTS .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 58 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 58 PHYSICAL DESCRIPTION ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 58 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 58 EMERGENCY LIGHTING ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 60 POWER SUPPLIES ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 60 PHYSICAL DESCRIPTION ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 60 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 60 EMERGENCY LIGHTING - FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION ...................................................................................................................................................................... 62 OPERATION .......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 62 FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION.................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 62 TRAINING INFORMATION POINT........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 62 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 64 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 64 SYSTEM PLUMBING .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 64 SHUTOFF VALVE .................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 64 PRESSURE INDICATION ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 64 OVERPRESSURE DISCHARGE AND INDICATION .................................................................................................................................................................................................... 64 FLIGHT CREW COMMUNICATIONS SYSTEMS........................................................................................................................................................................................................ 64 FLIGHT CREW ORONASAL MASK ......................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 64 FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN - OXYGEN CYLINDER ...................................................................................................................................................................................... 66 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 66 PHYSICAL DESCRIPTION ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 66 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 66 PASSENGER OXYGEN - OXYGEN GENERATOR ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 68 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 68 PHYSICAL DESCRIPTION ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 68 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 68 POTABLE WATER - FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION ................................................................................................................................................................................... 70 FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION.................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 70 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 70 TRAINING INFORMATION POINT........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 70 WATER TANK PRESSURIZATION ................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 72 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 72 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 72 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 72 TRAINING INFORMATION POINT........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 72 PASSENGER WATER - WATER HEATER ..................................................................................................................................................................................................... 74 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 74 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 74 PHYSICAL DESCRIPTION ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 74 FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION.................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 74 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 5 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd VACUUM WASTE - FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION .................................................................................................................................................................................... 76 VACUUM TOILET ASSEMBLIES ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 76 WASTE TANK ASSEMBLY .................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 76 INTERFACES ......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 76 TRAINING INFORMATION POINT........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 76 VACUUM TOILET ASSEMBLY ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 78 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 78 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 78 PHYSICAL DESCRIPTION ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 78 FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION............................................................................................................................................................................ ERROR! BOOKMARK NOT DEFINED. WASTE TANK QUANTITY INDICATION ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 80 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 80 AFT ATTENDANT PANEL WASTE QUANTITY INDICATION ................................................................................................................................................................................... 80 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 80 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 80 PHYSICAL DESCRIPTION ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 80 OPERATION .................................................................................................................................................................................................... ERROR! BOOKMARK NOT DEFINED. VACUUM WASTE - COMPONENT LOCATIONS - AFT CARGO COMPARTMENT ............................................................................................................................ 82 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 82 MAINTENANCE DOCUMENTS – INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................................................................................... 84 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 84 SCHEDULED MAINTENANCE ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 84 UNSCHEDULED MAINTENANCE ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 84 MAINTENANCE PLANNING DOCUMENT ............................................................................................................................................................................................................... 84 AIRPLANE MAINTENANCE MANUAL .................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 84 SYSTEM SCHEMATICS MANUAL........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 86 WIRING DIAGRAM MANUAL ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 86 ILLUSTRATED PARTS CATALOGUE ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 86 STANDARD WIRING PRACTICES MANUAL ........................................................................................................................................................................................................... 86 FAULT REPORTING MANUAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 86 FAULT ISOLATION MANUAL ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 86 STRUCTURAL REPAIR MANUAL ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 86 MECHANICAL DISPATCH MANUAL ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 86 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd DISPATCH DEVIATION PROCEDURES GUIDE .......................................................................................................................................................................................... 88 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 88 INTRODUCTION .................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 88 MINIMUM EQUIPMENT LIST ITEMS ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 88 CONFIGURATION DEVIATION LIST ITEMS ............................................................................................................................................................................................................ 90 FERRY ITEMS ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 90 MISCELLANEOUS ITEMS....................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 90 TRAINING INFORMATION POINT........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 90 FAULT ISOLATION MANUAL ......................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 92 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 92 FIM INTRODUCTION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 92 FIM CHAPTER SUBJECTS ..................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 92 - MAINTENANCE MESSAGE INDEX ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 92 TRAINING INFORMATION POINT........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 92 AIRPLANE MAINTENANCE MANUAL - AMM PART I ............................................................................................................................................................................. 94 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 94 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 94 ORGANIZATION .................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 94 DIVISIONS ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 94 AIRPLANE MAINTENANCE MANUAL - AMM PART II ............................................................................................................................................................................ 96 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 96 CHAPTER NUMBERING SYSTEM ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 96 TRAINING INFORMATION POINT........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 96 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 7 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ATA 00-00-00 GEN FAM The 737-6/7/800 is a two engine airplane. It is for short to medium range flights with a capacity of up to 189 passengers. The Delta Air Lines configuration has a capacity of 154 passengers, with 16 in first class and 138 in coach class. The Next Generation 737-6/7/800 aircraft has many new features. These new features increase the airplane payload, service ceiling, and range. The airplane has a design max range of 2,900 nautical miles. - Zero fuel weight - 136,000 lbs. - Max. Landing weight - 144,000 lbs. - Max. Takeoff weight - 172,500 lbs. - Max. Taxi weight - 173,000 lbs. - Total useable fuel - 45,275 lbs. - Service ceiling - 41,000 ft. Turning Radius 737-800 - Outer wing Arc - 47.9 yds (143.7 ft) - Minimum pavement for a 180 degree turn - 25.7 yds (77 ft) B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 1 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 9 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd -800 STRUCTURE DIMENSIONS General These are the structure dimensions of the B-737-800 airplane: - Length; 129 feet 6 inches - Wing span; 112 feet 7 inches (117 feet 2 inches with winglets) - Tail height; 41 feet 2 inches - Horizontal stabilizer span; 47 feet 1 inch - Top of fuselage 18 feet - Bottom of passenger doors 9 feet B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 10 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 2 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 11 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd -700 STRUCTURE DIMENSIONS General These are the structure dimensions of the 737-700 airplane: - Length; 110 feet 4 inches, 33.69meters - Wing span; 117 feet 2 inches, 35.7 meters (with winglets) - Tail height; 41 feet 2 inches, 12.5 meters - Horizontal stabilizer span; 47 feet 1 inch, 14.4 meters - Top of fuselage 18 feet, 6 meters - Bottom of passenger doors 9 feet, 3 meters Turning Radius B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 12 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 3 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 13 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd FUSELAGE DIMENSIONS General Dimensions give locations on the fuselage. The scale for each dimension is inches. You use these dimensions to find components on the fuselage: - Body station line - Body buttock line - Water line The body Station line (STA) is a horizontal dimension. It starts at station line zero. You measure the body station line from a vertical reference plane that is forward of the airplane. The Buttock Line (BL) is a lateral dimension. You measure the buttock line to the left or right of the airplane centre line. The Water Line (WL) is a height dimension. You measure the water line from a horizontal reference plane below the airplane. Training Information Point A stretch section was added to the fuselage at station 500 and at station 727. The station numbers in these stretch sections have a letter after the number. The fuselage plugs on the -800 aircraft are 198in at station 500 and 212in at station 727. The fuselage plugs on the -700 aircraft are 88in at station 500 and 90in at station 727. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 14 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 4 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 15 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd WINGLETS General Description The upper and lower skin panels of the winglets are made of composite fibreglass/graphite/epoxy honeycomb material with an aluminium leading edge and aluminium ribs. The winglet has anti-collision lights and forward and aft position lights. An access panel on the bottom of the winglet gives access to the electrical connectors from the wing and the electrical connectors inside the winglet for the anti-collision lights and forward position lights. Access for the aft position light is in the winglet aft canoe. Older winglets have a single lens and a single mount bracket for the forward position lights and the anti-collision lights. Newer winglets have two lenses and two mount brackets for separate forward position lights and a separate anti-collision light in each winglet. Weight added to the winglet can cause a safety condition. The old paint must be removed before new paint is applied to the winglet. No new paint or logos may be applied over the old paint. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 16 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 5 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 17 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd POWERPLANT ENGINE HAZARDS General Engine Entry/Exit Corridor Two CFM56-7B engines supply thrust for the airplane. The CFM56-7B is a high bypass ratio, dual rotor, turbo fan engine. Use the entry/exit corridor when the engine is in operation. Stay out of the inlet and exhaust areas when the engine is in operation. These are some of the hazards around an operating engine: Engine entry/exit corridors are between the inlet hazard area and the exhaust hazard area. You should only go near an engine that is operating when: - Inlet suction - Exhaust heat - Exhaust velocity - Engine noise Training Information Point - The engine is at idle - You are in contact with the people in the flight compartment When the engine is in operation, the anti-collision lights should be on. Inlet Suction Engine inlet suction can pull people and large objects into the engine. At idle power, the inlet hazard area is a 13 ft. radius around the inlet. If the wind is over 25 knots, increase the inlet hazard area by 20 %. Exhaust Heat The engine exhaust is very hot for a long distance behind the engine. This can cause damage to personnel and equipment. Exhaust Velocity The exhaust velocity is very high for a long distance behind the engine. This can cause damage to personnel and equipment. Engine Noise Engine noise can cause temporary and permanent loss of your ability to hear. You must wear ear protection when near an engine in operation. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 18 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 6 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 19 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ANTENNA LOCATIONS Antenna Locations - Weather radar - Traffic alert and collision avoidance system (TCAS) - Air traffic control (ATC) - Global positioning system (GPS) - Very high frequency (VHF) communication - Automatic direction finder (ADF) - VHF omni range (VOR) / localizer - Marker beacon - Radio altimeter - Distance measuring equipment (DME) - Localizer - Glideslope - High frequency (HF) communication - ELT (-700 aircraft only) B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 20 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 7 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 21 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd FLIGHT COMPARTMENT PANELS General These are the major panels in the flight compartment: - P1 Captain instrument panel - P2 Centre instrument panel - P3 First officer instrument panel - P5 Aft overhead panel - P7 Glareshield panel - P8 Aft electronic panel - P9 Forward electronic panel - Control stand B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 22 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 8 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 23 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd MAIN INSTRUMENT PANEL General In the TEST position, a ground is supplied to make all of the indicators come on in the BRIGHT mode. Each type of indicator light assembly has a press to test switch circuit. This does a test of the lamps. The lens of each indicator light assembly is coloured. The controls and displays on the main instrument panels (P1 and P3) include these components: - Clock (2) - Display unit (4) - Display select panel (2) - Master dim and test switch - Brake pressure indicator - Auto flight status annunciator (2) - GPWS control panel - Lighting control (2) - Conditioned air outlet control (2) - Alternate nose wheel steering switch The lens colour means: - Red; warning - Amber; caution - Blue; position - Green; power on - White; information Master Dim and Test The Master Dim and Test (MD&T) system lets you do these tasks: Training Information Point - Do a test of the flight compartment annunciators and lighted push-button switches - Set annunciators and lighted push-button switches to the bright or dim mode The fire warning indicators are not part of the MD&T system. The fire warning system has its own test switch on the P8 panel. There are two types of lamps that you can install in the indicator lights. If you use the wrong lamp, damage to the lens cover can occur. Functional Description When the MD&T switch is in the bright (BRT) position, power goes directly to the indicators. When the MD&T switch is in the DIM position, a relay energizes, power goes through a dim diode. This decreases the voltage to the system indicator light. This causes the light to be dim. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 24 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 9 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 25 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd P7 GLARESHIELD PANEL General The controls and displays on the P7 glare shield include these components: - Master caution annunciator (2) - System caution annunciator (2) - Mode control panel (MCP) - EFIS control panel (2) - Fire warning light (2) B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 26 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 10 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 27 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd P2 CENTER INSTRUMENT AND P9 FORWARD ELECTRONICS PANEL General The controls and displays on the P2 centre instrument panel include these components: - Yaw damper indicator - Standby instruments - Engine display control panel - Antiskid and autobrake switch and lights - Flap position indicator - Landing gear lever and position indicator - Upper centre display unit The controls and displays on the P9 forward electronics panel include these components: - Lower centre display unit - Multifunction Control Display Unit (MCDU) (2) B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 28 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 11 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 29 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd CONTROL STAND General The controls and indicators on the control stand include these components: - Forward thrust lever (2) - Reverse thrust lever (2) - Speed brake handle - Horizontal stabilizer trim wheel (2) and indicator (2) - Parking brake lever and indication light - Flap lever - Stabilizer trim cut out switch (2) - Start lever (2) B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 30 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 12 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 31 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd P8 AFT ELECTRONICS PANEL General The P8 aft electronics panel has these components: - Dual weather radar control panel - Overheat / fire protection panel - ATC / TCAS control panel - VHF radio control panel - Navigation control panel - Audio control panel - Aileron / rudder trim panel - ADF control panel - ACMS printer - Lighting control - Cargo fire control panel - Heads-up guidance system control panel - ACMS print event panel B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 32 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 13 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 33 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd P5 AFT OVERHEAD PANEL General The controls and displays on the P5 aft overhead panel include these components: - Inertial system display unit - IRS mode select unit - Engine panel - Observer audio control panel - Oxygen panel - Landing gear indicator lights (secondary) - White dome light switch - Service interphone switch - Proximity Switch Electronics Unit (PSEU) light - Leading edge devices annunciator panel B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 34 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 14 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 35 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd P5 FORWARD OVERHEAD PANEL General The controls and displays on the P5 forward overhead panel include these components: - APU control switch - APU indicator panel - Fuel control panel - Ground power and bus switching panel - Equipment cooling panel - Generator drive and standby power panel - AC and DC meter panel - Flight control panel - Air-conditioning / bleed-air control panels - Hydraulic control panel - Cabin altitude panel - Cabin pressure control panel - Engine start panel B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 36 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 15 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 37 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd AFT FLIGHT COMPARTMENT PANELS General The main circuit breaker panels are located behind the first officer’s and captain’s seats. The P6 and P18 panels have the component load circuit breakers. Circuit breakers are organized by airplane systems. The P61 panel has the airborne data loader controls. Located below the P61 panel is a area for the following manuals: - Mechanical Dispatch Manual (MDM) - Pilot Operation Manual (POM) - Fault Reporting Manual (FRM) B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 38 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 16 Figure 16 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 39 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd LOADABLE SOFTWARE General Some of the LRU’s (line replaceable units) in the B-737NG need both hardware and software. Without the software, the logic circuits in the LRU’s can not do their specified function. They must have the proper software loaded. You can load the software in the LRU at the shop or you can load it at the airplane. Systems These LRU’s have loadable software features: - FMC (flight management computer) - DEU (display electronics unit) - ACARS (ARINC communications addressing and reporting system) - FDAU (flight data acquisition unit) - ACMS (airplane condition monitoring system) - AIRSHOW - APU ECU (engine control unit) - EEC (electronic engine control) The airborne data loader on the P61 panel will load the software to all of these components, except the EEC. The EEC software is loaded at the engine with a portable data loader. Loadable Software Binder A binder is located in the book storage compartment at the bottom of the P61.The binder has all of the software that you can load at the airplane. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 40 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 17 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 41 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd LOCATION OF JUNCTION BOXES General Description The electrical system has many Junction (J) boxes. The junction boxes contain many different relays for the AC and DC loads on the airplane. Most of the junction boxes are in the E/E compartment or in the forward fuselage, below the flight compartment. These are the major junction boxes on the airplane: - J4 - J5 - J9 - J19 - J20 - J22 - J23 - J24 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 42 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 18 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 43 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ELECTRONIC EQUIPMENT COMPARTMENT General The electronic equipment compartment is below the main cabin floor, aft of the nose wheel well. On the ground, you enter this compartment through a door on the bottom of the fuselage. The door is just aft of the nose landing gear. There are five standard equipment racks. These are the E1, E2, E3, E4, and E5 racks. There is one optional equipment rack. The E8-1 rack is installed above the E1 rack. Shelf assemblies have equipment mounts, interconnect wiring, and accessory boxes. Most equipment rack shelves are cooled with air. Air is blown through or drawn through the equipment racks. There is a drip shield over the racks to protect the equipment from moisture. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 44 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 19 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 45 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ELECTRONIC EQUIPMENT RACKS E1, E8 E1 Rack System LRU’s have program pins to set up the instructions for that LRU. The program switch modules set these program pins. A seal plug is installed over the switches to keep the switches stationary. A security cover holds the seal plug in place. The program switch module gives this information to an LRU: The equipment on the E1 rack includes electronics for these functions: - Autothrottle - Autopilot - Communications - Navigation - Flight control - Equipment physical orientation (left, right, upper, lower) - Airplane type - Number of units installed - Customer specific options E8 Rack The E8-1 electronic equipment rack is installed above the E1 rack. The E8-1 is an optional equipment rack for airplanes that do not have airstairs installed, and need expanded space for optional systems. The equipment on the E8-1 rack includes electronics for these functions: See the Standard Wiring Practices Manual for more information on the program switch module. - HF Communications - IFE - Flight data recording (QAR) - ACARS Program Switch Modules Many of the Line Replaceable Units (LRU’s) are controlled by internal digital computers. These computers follow instructions (or programs) to do a certain task. The program switch module gives an external method to customize a computer’s program. The program switch module has these components: - Switches - Pin contacts - Switch seal plug - Security cover B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 46 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 20 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 47 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ELECTRONICS EQUIPMENT RACKS E2, E3, & E4 General The E2, E3, & E4 racks include electronics for these functions: - Window heat - Communications - Electrical power - Common display system - Flight control - Fire detection - Auxiliary power unit Training Information Point The E2, E3, & E4 racks are mounted across the aft wall of the E/E compartment. The E/E compartment light switch is located on a panel just aft of the access door opening. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 48 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 21 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 49 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ELECTRONIC EQUIPMENT RACK E5 General The equipment in the E5 rack includes electronics for these functions: - Air Data Inertial Reference System (ADIRS) - Flight Management Computer System (FMCS) - FMC transfer relays B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 50 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 22 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 51 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ELECTRONIC EQUIPMENT RACK E6 General The electronic E6 rack is located in the aft bag bin, just aft of the cargo door. The equipment in the E6 rack includes electronics for these functions: - Voice recorder - APU electronic control unit - Airfone The APU ECU is accessed from the forward end of the E6 rack. The voice recorder and Airfone boxes are located on the inboard side of the E6 rack. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 52 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 23 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 53 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd PASSENGER COMPARTMENT - PASSENGER SERVICE UNITS Purpose Passenger Service Units (PSUs) provide these functions for passengers: - Advisory information - Call switches Physical Description/Location PSUs are above each row of seats. PSUs include these features: - FASTEN SEAT BELT and NO SMOKING signs - Individual air outlets - Passenger address loudspeakers - Attendant call switches and lights - Oxygen masks - Reading lights - Oxygen generator PSUs have inboard and outboard support rails. They have hinges on the outboard side and latches on the inboard side. Small holes in the PSU face panels give access to the release latches. A lanyard limits movement as the unit swings open. Training Information Point To open passenger service units, insert a small allen key or other applicable tool into the latch release hole. Then lower the service unit. It is not necessary to lower the PSU to relamp a reading light. Firmly grasp the inner ring of the light bezel and turn counter clockwise. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 54 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 24 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 55 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd EXTERIOR LIGHTING Purpose The exterior lights supply light for airplane identification, direction, and to aid in the safe operation of the airplane. These are the exterior lights on the airplane: - Wing illumination - Landing lights - White anti-collision lights - Red anti-collision lights - Position lights - Taxi and runway turnoff lights B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 56 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 25 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 57 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd LANDING LIGHTS Purpose The landing lights help the pilots to see the runway for takeoff and landing. Physical Description There are two types of landing lights, fixed and retractable. The fixed landing light has these parts: - Lens assembly - Lamp - Step down transformer The retractable landing light has these parts: - Lens assembly - Lamp - Retainer screws - Extend/retract motor Location The fixed landing lights are in the wing root area of each wing. The retractable landing lights are on the fuselage, adjacent to the ram air inlet panels. The control switches for the fixed and retractable landing lights are on the P5 panel forward. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 58 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 26 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 59 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd EMERGENCY LIGHTING Power Supplies The power supplies give power to internal and external emergency lights. Physical Description The power supplies have these components: - Battery pack - Test switch - Electrical connector - Control logic and charging circuit Location The power supplies are at these locations: - Behind the ceiling panels at the forward entry area (2) - Behind the ceiling panels at the aft entry area (2) - Behind the carpet riser near station 500C, right side only - Behind the carpet risers near the emergency escape hatches (2) - Behind the carpet risers near body station 727 (2) B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 60 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 27 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 61 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd EMERGENCY LIGHTING - FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION Operation With the P5 switch in the ARM position, the power supply makes the emergency lights come on when one of these conditions occur: You use the emergency exit light switch on the P5 forward overhead panel or the emergency exit switch on the attendant panel. These switches control the emergency lights. - The attendant panel emergency exit switch is in the ON position - 28vdc bus 1 power drops below 12 volts The emergency exit light switch on the P5 panel has these positions: Training Information Point - ON, makes emergency lights come on - OFF, prevents automatic operation - ARM, prepares system for automatic operation If you remove all power from the airplane, the P5 emergency exit light switch must be in the OFF position and the attendant's switch in the NORM position. This prevents the emergency lights operation so the batteries do not discharge. The NOT ARMED and MASTER CAUTION lights illuminate when the emergency light switch on the P5 panel is in the ON or the OFF positions. The 28vdc bus 1 supplies power to these indication lights. The emergency exit switch on the attendant panel has ON and NORMAL positions. The ON position makes the emergency lights come on. The NORMAL position sets automatic operation. The attendant panel switch will cause the lights to come on even if the P5 switch is OFF. Functional Description The power supplies use 28vdc for their charge and control logic circuits. The charge circuits charge the battery packs when these conditions exist: - The P5 emergency exit light switch is in the OFF or ARM position - 28vdc bus 1 has power - The P14 attendant panel emergency exit light switch is in the NORMAL Position B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 62 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 28 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 63 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN Purpose oxygen will flow overboard. This flow will blow out a green indication disk on the airplane fuselage. The cylinder discharge works with the cylinder shutoff valve open or closed. If the cylinder shutoff valve is open, oxygen from the cylinder and the system supply tubing flows overboard. The schematic below shows the interfaces of the flight crew oxygen system. The flight crew oxygen system has these interfaces: Flight Crew Communications Systems - System supply tubing - Shutoff valve - Pressure indication - Overpressure discharge and indication - Flight crew communications systems The flight crew oxygen masks have internal microphones. These microphones are part of the communications system. See the communications systems chapter for more microphone information. Flight Crew Oronasal Mask System Plumbing The crew oxygen masks are diluter/demand masks. Controls on each mask determine the mode of oxygen delivery. In the demand mode, a mask regulator supplies oxygen to the crew member only when the crew member inhales. To select continuous flow mode, rotate the EMERGENCY/TEST knob to EMERGENCY. The masks have a goggle vent valve for smoke clearance. A push-pull slider on the top of the mask controls a goggle vent valve. Push this slider toward the face to close the vent valve. Pull it away from the face to open the vent valve. An open vent valve clears smoke from the goggles when the user exhales. The boxes have these features: The system plumbing has these components: - Corrosion resistant, seamless stainless steel tubing - Flareless fittings - Bayonet type quick disconnect connectors - Flexible silicon rubber hoses with braided sheathing Shutoff Valve A shutoff valve on the cylinder head opens or closes the cylinder to the supply system. Pressure Indication - A shutoff valve - A RESET/TEST lever (red) - An OXY-ON flag (white) - An oxygen flow indication blinker (yellow cross) A mechanical pressure gage on the oxygen cylinder shows the cylinder pressure. The gage shows pressure regardless of the cylinder shutoff valve position. An electrically powered gage on the P5 panel shows the pressure at the cylinder outlet coupling. A pressure transducer on the cylinder coupling supplies a signal to the gage. The system uses 28vdc from the battery bus. The box shutoff valve is closed when the mask is stowed. It opens when the mask is removed. The blinker is a visual indication of oxygen flow to the mask. The RESET/TEST lever is used to test the system and reset the shutoff valve when the mask is stowed. Overpressure Discharge and Indication A frangible (breakable) disk on the oxygen cylinder protects the cylinder from overpressure. If an overpressure condition breaks this disk, the B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 64 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 29 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 65 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN - OXYGEN CYLINDER Purpose The oxygen cylinder stores the oxygen for the flight crew system. Physical Description The oxygen cylinder is made of steel and is painted aviator green. The cylinder assembly has these features: - A slow opening shutoff valve - A cylinder pressure gage - An overpressure safety relief device - A pressure reducing regulator Location The crew oxygen cylinder is located in the E/E compartment, in the lower right area of the transverse rack. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 66 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 30 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 67 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd PASSENGER OXYGEN - OXYGEN GENERATOR Purpose The oxygen generators supply emergency oxygen to the passengers and flight attendants. Physical Description The oxygen generators are metal cased cylindrical devices. At one end of the generator is a spring loaded firing mechanism. At the other end is an output manifold and a relief valve. The oxygen generator output manifolds have 4,3, or 2 ports. The size of the generator determines the number of output manifold ports. Location The oxygen generators are in these units: - The Passenger Service Units (PSUs) - The lavatory service units - The attendant service units B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 68 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 31 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 69 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd POTABLE WATER - FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION Training Information Point Functional Description When you drain the water system, you must drain water from these two areas: The water system has one tank that holds potable water. You fill and drain the water tank at the water service panel. There are control handles for the fill/overflow valve and the water tank drain valve. The water drains overboard through drain fittings. The water tank supplies water to these locations: - The water service panel - The forward lavatory The water service panel lets you drain the water tank and aft supply lines. - Galley faucets - Lavatory faucets - Lavatory toilets The forward lavatory has a drain valve downstream of the water supply shutoff valve. The forward lavatory drain valve lets you drain the forward water supply lines. When you drain water from the forward lavatory, you must have the water supply shutoff valve open. Each lavatory has a water supply shutoff valve. The valve lets you isolate the water supply to the sink or to the toilet. The valve also lets you isolate both the sink and toilet at the same time. The forward lavatory has a drain valve. This valve drains water from the forward water supply lines. A water heater in each lavatory increases the temperature of the water. The water goes to the hot side of the faucet. The water tank level sensor sends the water quantity data to a water quantity transmitter. The transmitter sends the information to a water quantity indicator at the aft attendant's panel. The water quantity indicator shows the level of water in the tank It is necessary to fully drain the water system before you add a disinfectant. Also, drain the water system fully when you park the airplane in cold weather. B737-800 aircraft are equipped with a gray water drain valve. This directs water to drain from the fwd drain fitting on the ground and to the fwd drain mast in the air. Location The potable water tank is located behind the aft wall in the aft cargo bin. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 70 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 32 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 71 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd WATER TANK PRESSURIZATION Purpose The water tank pressurization system pressurizes the potable water tank. General Pressure for the water tank comes from the air compressor or the system. The water tank pressurization has these functions: - Controls the air pressure that goes into the water tank - Selects the source of the pressurized air - Prevents contamination from unwanted material in the air Location When the potable water air compressor is fitted it is located on the left side of the aircraft behind the waste tank. Training Information Point You can release pressure from the water tank by opening the fill and overflow valve. Use the handle at the water service panel. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 72 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 33 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 73 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd PASSENGER WATER - WATER HEATER Purpose The lavatory water heaters increase the temperature of water for use in the lavatory sink. Location There is a water heater in each lavatory. You open the sink cabinet door to get access to it. The overheat switch is under the water heater cover. Physical Description The water heater has these parts: - Power switch - Indicator light - Cover - Overheat switch - Pressure relief valve (inside tank) - Heater elements (inside tank) - HIGH/LOW/MEDIUM switch The power switch has ON and OFF positions. Functional Description The heater operates when 115vac power is available and there is not an over temp. You can see the orange indicator light is on when the heater operates. The pressure relief valve opens if pressure inside the water heater is greater than 140 psi. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 74 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 34 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 75 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd VACUUM WASTE - FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION Interfaces Vacuum Toilet Assemblies The flush switch sends a signal to operate the vacuum blower. The signal goes through the waste drain ball valve and the barometric switch. The waste drain ball valve must be closed. The barometric switch disables the vacuum blower when the airplane is above 16,000 ft. Operation of the toilet flush switch sends a signal through the logic control module to the Flush Control Unit (FCU) and the vacuum blower. The FCU sends an open signal to the rinse valve to supply a quantity of potable water to the toilet bowl. After the rinse valve closes, the FCU opens the toilet flush valve for four seconds and closes it. Training Information Point Waste Tank Assembly The waste tank must be rinsed at every service interval. If the waste tank is not serviced properly, unwanted waste material can collect on the point level sensors. The collection of material on the point level sensors can cause a tank full signal. This will stop operation of the lavatory toilets. You should flush crushed ice down the toilets at regular intervals. This will help to prevent the collection of unwanted material in the vacuum tubing. Do not use ice cubes at a substitute for crushed ice. Ice cubes can cause damage to the point level sensors. Differential pressure causes the toilet bowl contents to flow from the toilet to the waste tank. The vacuum blower or ambient pressure pulls air out of the waste tank through a water separator. This causes the tank to have a lower pressure than the cabin pressure. The waste tank collects the waste from all the lavatory toilet assemblies. Servicing the waste tank is from the waste service panel. You attach the service hose and open the waste tank drain valve. When the tank is empty, you attach the rinse hose and supply water pressure. Water flows through two filters and two rinse nozzles. The rinse nozzles spray water around the inside of the tank to clean the inside components. The chemical precharge is put in after the tank is fully drained, and flushed. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 76 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 35 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 77 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd VACUUM TOILET ASSEMBLY Purpose The vacuum toilet assembly collects human waste material. It operates the vacuum waste system to send the waste to the waste tank. Location There is a vacuum toilet assembly in each lavatory. Physical Description The vacuum toilet assembly has these parts: - Rinse ring - Toilet bowl - Anti-siphon valve - Rinse valve - Flush valve - Manual shutoff valve - Manual shutoff valve handle - Assembly mounting stand - Flush Control Unit (FCU) B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 78 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 37 Figure 36 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 79 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd WASTE TANK QUANTITY INDICATION Physical Description General The attendant panel waste quantity indicator is part of the waste system module. The waste system module has these indications: The waste tank quantity indication system does these functions: - Monitors and displays the level of waste in the waste tank - Stops operation of the vacuum toilets when the tank is full - Gives indication when the lavatories stop operation for waste tank full condition - Gives indication when the sensors are dirty - BITE - Waste tank quantity indicator - CLEAN/CHECK SENSOR light - LAVS INOP test switch These components are in the waste tank quantity indication system: - Waste tank point level sensor (2) - Waste tank continuous level sensor - Logic Control Module (LCM) - Attendant panel waste quantity indicator Aft Attendant Panel Waste Quantity Indication Purpose The attendant panel waste quantity indicator gives information about the waste tank. Location The attendant panel waste quantity indicator is at the aft attendant station. It is on the partition, adjacent to the aft entry door. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 80 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 38 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 81 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd VACUUM WASTE - COMPONENT LOCATIONS AFT CARGO COMPARTMENT Location These components are in the aft cargo compartment, left side, behind the cargo lining: - Liquid separator - Waste drain ball valve and pull rod - Vacuum blower and filter - Vacuum check valve - Waste tank - Waste drain valve assembly - Waste tank rinse fitting assembly - Waste tank rinse filter - Waste tank point level sensor - Waste tank continuous level sensor - Logic control module The liquid separator is on top of the waste tank. The waste tank ball valve is below outboard, and forward of the waste tank. The vacuum check valve and vacuum blower are forward of the waste tank. They are behind the sidewall panels in the aft cargo compartment. The waste drain valve assembly and the waste drain rinse fitting assembly are on the waste service panel. You can access them from below the floor. The waste tank rinse nozzles are on the top of the waste tank. The waste tank rinse filters are along the inboard side of the waste tank. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 82 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 39 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 83 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd MAINTENANCE DOCUMENTS – INTRODUCTION General - Service problems - Structural damage The maintenance documents for the B-737 Next Generation and B-777 supply help for maintenance activities. Many different documents work together to permit you to maintain the airplane. The maintenance documents will help you perform scheduled and unscheduled maintenance. You use these documents to perform unscheduled maintenance: - Fault Reporting Manual (FRM) - Fault Isolation Manual (FIM) - Structural Repair Manual (SRM) - Mechanical Dispatch Manual (MDM) - Airplane Maintenance Manual (AMM) Scheduled Maintenance These are examples of scheduled maintenance: - Through service checks - Layover checks - Service checks - Letter checks Maintenance Planning Document The Maintenance Planning Document (MPD) defines the tasks for each type of scheduled maintenance check. Airlines use the MPD to make task cards that the technician uses during the maintenance checks. You use these documents to perform scheduled maintenance: Airplane Maintenance Manual - Maintenance Planning Document (MPD) - Airplane Maintenance Manual (AMM) The Airplane Maintenance Manual (AMM) has two parts. Part I is the Systems Description Section (SDS). This section replaces the Description and Operation (D and O) section of older Boeing airplane models. Part II is Practices and Procedures. The practices and procedures section has data related to these functions: These documents supply supporting data to perform scheduled maintenance: - System Schematics Manual (SSM) - Wiring Diagram Manual (WDM) - Structural Repair Manual (SRM) - Illustrated Parts Manual (IPC) - Removal / Installation of components - Component location - Maintenance practices - Servicing - Adjustment / Test - Inspection / Check - Cleaning / Painting - Repair Unscheduled Maintenance These are examples of unscheduled maintenance: - Flight faults - Ground faults B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 84 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 40 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 85 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd INTRODUCTION pt 2 System Schematics Manual The fault code permits faster maintenance when the airplane lands. FRM fault codes refer you to the FIM. The System Schematic Manual (SSM) gives the user an understanding of system operation and helps in the fault isolation process. It supplies the interconnection of all LRU’s of a system or subsystem. It also supplies a general knowledge about system operation. Fault Isolation Manual You use the Fault Isolation Manual (FIM) to repair airplane faults. You start the fault isolation process with FRM fault codes or a fault description. The FIM will identify the maintenance action(s) to correct the fault. Wiring Diagram Manual The Wiring Diagram Manual (WDM) supplies details of the point-to-point wiring on the airplane. Structural Repair Manual Illustrated Parts Catalogue The Structural Repair Manual (SRM) supplies descriptive information and specific instructions to help in field repairs of the airplane structure. The SRM is not customized. It has data relative to these areas: The Illustrated Parts Catalogue (IPC) supplies part replacement data. This data includes: - Replacement part number - Part illustrations - Supplier data - Specification numbers - Recommended spares - Service bulletin activity - Allowable damage evaluation - Typical repairs - Material identification - Material substitution - Fastener Installation - Alignment check - Planning Standard Wiring Practices Manual Mechanical Dispatch Manual The Standard Wiring Practice Manual has instructions for maintenance and repair of the wiring of all Boeing airplanes. It is not customized. The Mechanical Dispatch Manual (MDM) supplies minimum equipment required for dispatch. It also supplies the procedures for dispatch with a fault if permitted. Fault Reporting Manual The flight crew uses the Fault Reporting Manual (FRM) to improve communication with maintenance personnel. The flight crew uses the FRM to get fault codes for airplane faults. These faults can be flight deck effects or other faults. The FRM has standard log book write-ups for each fault code. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 86 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 41 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 87 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd DISPATCH DEVIATION PROCEDURES GUIDE These are the parts of the minimum equipment list items: General - Item - Repair interval - Number installed - Number required for dispatch - Remarks or exceptions - Placard - Maintenance procedure (optional) - Operations procedure (optional) The Dispatch Deviation Procedures Guide (DDG) helps airlines make the procedures needed to operate their aircraft in the different nonstandard configurations. This manual shows permitted nonstandard configurations. It has these sections: - Introduction - Minimum Equipment List Items - Configuration Deviation List Items - Ferry Items - Miscellaneous Items The item is the equipment, system, or function installed in the airplane. The repair interval shows when you must repair the item. Repair intervals are specified in the front section of the MEL. These letter codes show the time interval: Introduction The Introduction section gives the purpose, background, contents, and organization of the DDG. - A; as shown in the remarks or exceptions column - B; within 3 consecutive calendar days - C; within 10 consecutive calendar days - D; within 120 consecutive calendar days Minimum Equipment List Items The CAA publishes a Master Minimum Equipment List (MMEL). The operator can add to the MMEL. Then it is the operator’s Minimum Equipment List (MEL). The MMEL tells you the minimum equipment and procedures necessary to operate the aircraft. The operator’s MEL cannot be less restrictive than the Master Minimum Equipment List. The MEL has an ATA index of MEL items and a list of definitions. The MEL items are in ATA sequence. There is a general system schematic at the start of each ATA chapter. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE Repair intervals are specified in the front section of the MMEL. 88 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 42 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 89 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd DISPATCH DEVIATIONS PROCEDURES GUIDE (CONT.) Miscellaneous Items Minimum Equipment List (continued) The Miscellaneous items section contains a list of other items that are unique. The number installed is the quantity usually installed in the airplane. A dash (-) shows if the quantity can change. The number required for dispatch is the minimum quantity necessary for operation if you meet the conditions in the remarks of exemptions column. The MMEL may show a dash (-) in this column. The MEL must show actual quantity required. The remarks or exemptions column shows what you must do to release the airplane. It may also show operations notes and limits. The placard section shows the placard and where you must put it when this item does not operate. Some MEL items have a maintenance procedure that you must do to release the airplane. The maintenance procedure is listed in the MEL if it is simple. A reference to the procedure in the 900 page block of the Airplane Maintenance Manual (AMM) is listed if the procedure is more complex. Some MEL items have an operations procedure. The flight crew must do this procedure if your airline operates the airplane when this item does not operate. Training Information Point Some airlines have combined the MMEL and CDL into one onboard manual and call it the Mechanical Dispatch Manual (MDM). Configuration Deviation List Items The Configuration Deviation List (CDL) is an appendix to the approved Aircraft Flight Manual (AFM). It includes secondary airframe and engine parts which you do not have to have for dispatch. Ferry Items The ferry items section contains information for dispatch with configuration deviation for which revenue passengers are not permitted by the MMEL or the CDL. A ferry flight occurs when it is necessary to fly the aircraft back to a maintenance base for repairs. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 90 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 43 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 91 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd FAULT ISOLATION MANUAL General These are the chapter subjects: You use the Fault Isolation Manual (FIM) to isolate and correct airplane faults. To isolate a fault, you must get a FIM task number. You use different sections of the FIM along with airplane data to identify the correct task number. The FIM has these parts: - How to use the FIM - Fault code index - Introduction - Front subjects - Chapter subjects - Fault isolation tasks - Task support pages FIM Introduction Training Information Point - Maintenance message index The introduction is a very important part of the FIM. It explains the parts of the FIM and tells how to use them. FIM Front Subjects You use the front subjects to find a task number. With a fault description or a cabin fault code, you can find which tasks in the FIM you must do to correct the fault. These are the front subjects: The flight crew uses the Fault Reporting Manual (FRM) to find the fault code. If the flight crew does not supply a fault code, you can use the front subjects of the FIM to find the task number. Lists are used if you have a fault, but do not have a fault code or FIM task number. Index’s are used if you have a fault code and are looking for the FIM task number. - Observed fault list in alphabetical order - Observed fault list in system order - Cabin fault list - Cabin fault code index FIM Chapter Subjects The chapter subjects have two types of information. The subjects have the fault isolation tasks. They also have information that help you identify the correct task. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 92 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 44 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 93 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd AIRPLANE MAINTENANCE MANUAL - AMM PART I General Each subject of the SDS has this information: The Airplane Maintenance Manual (AMM) Part I is the first of two parts of the AMM. It is called the System Description Section (SDS). This section replaces the Description and Operation (D & O) section of older Boeing AMM’s. Both Part I and Part II of the AMM show the configuration of the airplanes in an operator’s fleet. They have frequent revisions for improvements and for configuration changes. - Purpose/Introduction - General description - Component location - Interface - Operation - Functional description - Training Information Points (TIPs) Purpose The SDS gives descriptions of the interfaces, function, and operation of the airplane systems and subsystems. You use these descriptions to become familiar with the airplane systems so that you can do fault isolation and system maintenance. The SDS (AMM Part I) content can be used as a training manual. Organization The SDS uses text/graphic Para visuals (page sets). Each graphic has one or more pages of text that describe the information on the graphic. The graphic has the primary information and the associated text pages (s) have the support information or explanations. The SDS uses a horizontal (sometimes called landscape) format. All pages (Graphic and text) are 8-1/2 by 11 inches. The graphic page is always on the bottom (odd numbered page) of the text/graphic Para visual. The text pages have a double galley (two columns) format. Divisions The SDS organization is by ATA chapter (system) or chapter/section (Subsystem). Each ATA chapter/ section usually defines an airplane system or subsystem. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 94 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 45 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 95 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd AIRPLANE MAINTENANCE MANUAL - AMM PART II General Part II of the AMM contains the maintenance practices and procedures to do maintenance on the airplane. If all of the topics for an ATA chapter, subsystem, or sub-subsystem are brief, all of the topics will be in a single maintenance practice page block. The dispatch deviation guide page block has procedures with maintenance tasks that prepare the airplane for flight with certain systems and or components inoperative. It also has tasks that put the airplane back to its usual condition. Chapter Numbering System The manual has a tab section for each ATA chapter. Within each tab section, the manual has more divisions that use the assigned subject number (ASN). Example: XX-YY-ZZ, Training Information Point - XX is the ATA chapter - YY is the subsystem or sub-subsystem - ZZ is the unit (component) Each chapter in Part II of the AMM has a list of effective pages at the beginning of each chapter. The table of contents for each chapter lists the maintenance procedures in numerical order for each subsystem and sub-subsystem. The maintenance tasks are in alphabetical order based on the page number sections described below. Page Type Page Block Maintenance Practices (MP) 201-299 Servicing (SRV) 301-399 Removal/Installation (R/I) 401-499 Adjustment/Test (A/T) 501-599 Inspection/Check (I/C) 601-699 Cleaning/Painting (C/P) 701-799 Repairs (AR) 801-899 Dispatch Deviation Guide (DDG) 901-999 Dispatch Deviation Guide B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 96 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 46 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 97 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 98 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 00-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ATA 21-00-00 AIR CONDITIONING B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd CONTENTS ATA 21 – AIR CONDITIONING GENERAL DESCRIPTION - CONTROL - 800/900 .......................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 AIR CONDITIONING ACCESSORY UNIT................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 PACK FLOW CONTROL AND PACK COOLING -......................................................................................................................................................................................... 8 LOCATIONS ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 8 GENERAL DESCRIPTION - AIR FLOW ......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 10 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 10 PACK FLOW CONTROL ......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 10 PACK COOLING SYSTEM ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 10 ZONE TEMPERATURE CONTROL ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 10 GENERAL DESCRIPTION - AIR FLOW (CONT.) ........................................................................................................................................................................................ 12 RECIRCULATION .................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 12 AIR DISTRIBUTION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 12 PACK FLOW CONTROL – INTRODUCTION ............................................................................................................................................................................................... 14 AIR SUPPLY ......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 14 COMPRESSION ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 14 CONDENSE ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 14 WATER REMOVAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 14 REHEAT ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 14 EXPANSION .......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 14 PACK FLOW CONTROL AND PACK COOLING - RAM AIR .................................................................................................................................................................... 16 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 16 GROUND MODE ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 16 FLIGHT (FLAPS NOT UP) ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 16 FLIGHT CRUISE (FLAPS UP) ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 16 INDICATION.......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 16 B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd TEMPERATURE CONTROL – OPERATION ................................................................................................................................................................................................ 18 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 18 TEMPERATURE SELECTORS .................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 18 DUCT OVERHEAT LIGHT ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 18 TRIM AIR SWITCH ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 18 TEMPERATURE CONTROL - GENERAL DESCRIPTION ......................................................................................................................................................................... 20 TRIM AIR ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 20 PHYSICAL DESCRIPTION ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 20 GENERAL DESCRIPTION ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 20 PACK/ZONE TEMPERATURE CONTROLLER - GENERAL ..................................................................................................................................................................... 22 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 22 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 22 TRAINING INFORMATION POINT........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 22 DISTRIBUTION - GENERAL DESCRIPTION ................................................................................................................................................................................................ 24 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 24 MAIN AIR DISTRIBUTION ..................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 24 FLIGHT COMPARTMENT DISTRIBUTION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................... 24 PASSENGER COMPARTMENT DISTRIBUTION ........................................................................................................................................................................................................ 24 RECIRCULATION SYSTEM .................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 24 VENTILATION....................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 24 EQUIPMENT COOLING SYSTEM ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 24 RECIRCULATION SYSTEM – INTRODUCTION ......................................................................................................................................................................................... 26 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 26 RECIRCULATION .................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 26 ACCESS ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 26 RECIRCULATION AIR FILTERS.............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 26 EQUIPMENT COOLING SYSTEM - GENERAL DESCRIPTION ............................................................................................................................................................... 28 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 28 SUPPLY ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 28 EXHAUST ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 28 B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 3 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd PRESSURIZATION CONTROL - GENERAL DESCRIPTION .................................................................................................................................................................... 30 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 30 GENERAL DESCRIPTION ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 30 AUTOMATIC PRESSURIZATION CONTROL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................ 30 MANUAL PRESSURIZATION CONTROL ................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 30 COMPONENT LOCATION ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 32 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 32 CABIN PRESSURE CONTROL MODULE AND CABIN .............................................................................................................................................................................. 34 ALTITUDE PANEL .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 34 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 34 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 34 CABIN PRESSURE CONTROL MODULE – GENERAL .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 34 AIR CONDITIONING - GENERAL DESCRIPTION - 600/700 ..................................................................................................................................................................... 36 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 36 AIR-CONDITIONING CONTROL PANELS ................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 36 CABIN TEMPERATURE PANEL .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 36 AIR CONDITIONING/BLEED AIR CONTROLS PANEL ............................................................................................................................................................................................. 36 EQUIPMENT COOLING PANEL .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 36 CABIN PRESSURE SELECTOR PANEL/CABIN ALTITUDE PANEL ............................................................................................................................................................................ 36 COOLING - GENERAL DESCRIPTION .......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 38 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 38 AIR CONDITIONING/BLEED AIR CONTROLS PANEL ............................................................................................................................................................................................. 38 FLOW CONTROL SHUTOFF VALVE ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 38 PRIMARY HEAT EXCHANGER ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 38 AIR CYCLE MACHINE............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 38 SECONDARY HEAT EXCHANGER .......................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 38 RAM AIR SYSTEM ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 38 LOW LIMIT (35F) SYSTEM ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 38 WATER SEPARATOR............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 38 TEMPERATURE CONTROL – OPERATION ................................................................................................................................................................................................ 42 B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 42 CONTROLS ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 42 INDICATIONS ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 42 CABIN TEMPERATURE CONTROLLER ................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 42 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 42 TEMPERATURE CONTROL - CABIN TEMP SENSOR -............................................................................................................................................................................. 44 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 44 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 44 PHYSICAL DESCRIPTION ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 44 FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION.................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 44 DISTRIBUTION - GENERAL DESCRIPTION – COMPONENET .............................................................................................................................................................. 46 GENERAL DESCRIPTION ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 46 MAIN AIR DISTRIBUTION ..................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 46 FLIGHT COMPARTMENT CONDITIONED AIR DISTRIBUTION ................................................................................................................................................................................. 46 PASSENGER COMPARTMENT CONDITIONED AIR DISTRIBUTION .......................................................................................................................................................................... 46 RECIRCULATION SYSTEM .................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 46 VENTILATION....................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 46 EQUIPMENT COOLING SYSTEM ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 46 DISTRIBUTION COMPONENT LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................... 46 COOLING SYSTEM COMPONENT LOCATION ......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 46 RECIRCULATION SYSTEM – INTRODUCTION ......................................................................................................................................................................................... 48 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 48 GENERAL DESCRIPTION ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 48 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 48 OPERATION .......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 48 AIR CONDITIONING - FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION ............................................................................................................................................................................... 50 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 50 PACK FLOW CONTROL ......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 50 PACK COOLING SYSTEM ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 50 ZONE TEMPERATURE CONTROL ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 50 RECIRCULATION .................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 50 B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 5 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd GENERAL DESCRIPTION - CONTROL - 800/900 General These flight compartment panels let you control the Air Conditioning system: - Air conditioning/bleed air control panel - Temperature control panel - Equipment cooling control panel - Cabin pressure control panel These components in the E/E compartment control the functions of the air conditioning system: - Two pack/zone temperature controllers - Two Air Conditioning Accessory Units (ACAU) - Two Cabin Pressure Controllers (CPC) Pack/Zone Temperature Controllers The pack/zone temperature controllers control these functions of the air conditioning system: - Pack cooling temperature - Trim air, regulation (on or off) - Zone temperature Air Conditioning Accessory Unit The Air Conditioning Accessory Units (ACAU) are the interface for airplane operational logic and the air systems. Cabin pressure Controller The cabin pressure controller controls the cabin pressure function of the air conditioning system. B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 1 B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 7 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd PACK FLOW CONTROL AND PACK COOLING A/C COMPARTMENT COMPONENT LOCATIONS Locations These are the air conditioning components that are in the air conditioning compartments: - Heat exchanger (primary/secondary) - Heat exchanger clean out access panel - Plenum/diffuser assembly - Fan bypass check valve - Air Cycle Machine (ACM) - Ram air control temperature sensor - Turbine inlet overheat switch - Compressor discharge overheat switch - Standby temperature control valve - Temperature control valve - Condenser - Reheater - Water extractors - Trim air modulating valves - Trim air pressure regulating valve - Flow control and shutoff valve B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 2 B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 9 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd GENERAL DESCRIPTION - AIR FLOW Pack Cooling System General This part of the A/C system removes water as necessary and controls the temperature of fresh air before it flows into the distribution part of the air conditioning system. The primary components are the left and right packs. The normal control for the left pack makes sure that it supplies air at a temperature that gives the necessary cooling for the flight compartment. The normal control for the right pack makes sure that it supplies air at a temperature that gives necessary cooling for the mix manifold. These are the primary parts of the Air Conditioning (A/C) system that have an effect on the supply of fresh air or recirculation of conditioned air: - Pack flow control - Pack cooling system - Zone temperature control - Recirculation - Air distribution Zone Temperature Control This part of the A/C system increases the temperature of the conditioned air that flows into the occupied areas of the airplane. It also gives pressure regulation and on/off control for the trim air part of the system. These are the primary components: The primary parts of the A/C system have these functions: - Control fresh air flow for the airplane pressurization and ventilation system - Control the flight compartment and passenger cabin temperature - Recirculate cabin air for ventilation - Trim air pressure regulating and shutoff valve - Zone trim air modulating valves - Temperature sensors Pack Flow Control This part of the A/C system controls the quantity of fresh air that flows into the airplane. This is the primary component: - The system calculates the necessary pack outlet temperatures to satisfy the cooling needs of the flight compartment and the mix manifold. The system also calculates the heating necessary for each temperature control zone. These are the temperature control zones: Flow control and shutoff valve The quantity of fresh air necessary for ventilation is more than for pressurization. The ventilation quantity is based on a fixed value for the crew, allowable leakage, and on the number of passenger seats. Usually, the left and right flow control systems provide the same quantity of fresh air. Fresh air flow changes when airplane conditions change. B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE - Flight control zone - Forward cabin zone - Aft cabin zone Air from the pneumatic system adds heat to a zone that needs warm air. The trim air pressure regulating and shutoff valve gives on/off control and keeps trim air pressure at a preset limit. 10 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 3 B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 11 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd GENERAL DESCRIPTION - AIR FLOW (CONT.) The zone trim air modulating valves control the heat added to the conditioned air for each zone. Recirculation This part of the A/C system recycles approximately 50 percent of the cabin air for ventilation purposes. This reduces the quantity of air needed from the pneumatic system for ventilation. These are the primary components: - Left and right recirculation fans and filters Air Distribution This part of the A/C system moves conditioned air from the packs or ground air sources to the temperature control zones. These are the primary components: - Ground air connection - Mix manifold - Distribution ducts/risers B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 12 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 4 B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 13 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd PACK FLOW CONTROL – INTRODUCTION Air Supply Reheat Preconditioned engine bleed air or APU bleed air passes through the Flow Control and Shutoff Valve (FCSOV) which regulates airflow into the pack. It also functions as a shutoff valve. The air initially enters the pack at the primary heat exchanger. The dry air leaving the extractor is heated again on the second pass through the reheater, recovering the energy that normally would be added to the turbine exhaust in the cold side of the condenser. The function of the reheater is to minimize the temperature difference between the secondary heat exchanger outlet and the turbine inlet, thereby reducing the amount of warm air that needs to be added to the pack discharge air. Compression Expansion The air passes through the primary heat exchanger where it is cooled by ram air. It then enters the compressor section of the Air Cycle Machine (ACM) where pressure and temperature are increased. The compressor discharge air is cooled by ram air in the secondary heat exchanger and then enters the reheater. After passing through the reheater, the dry air enters the turbine section of the Air Cycle Machine (ACM). The ACM has three rotating sections all mounted on a common shaft supported by air bearings. The three rotating sections are: Condense - Turbine - Compressor - Fan The air passes through the reheater hot side and is cooled by transferring heat to the colder air passing through the cold side. After leaving the reheater, the air passes through the condenser where further temperature reduction takes place, lowering it to the level required for moisture condensation. The air is cooled in the condenser by cold turbine exhaust air. In expanding through the turbine, the air delivers power to drive the compressor and fan. The energy lost from the turbine airflow causes a temperature reduction resulting in turbine discharge air well below ram air temperature. The cold discharge air passes through the condenser on its way to the mix manifold. The cold air may cause condensation to form on the inlet of the condenser. This is regulated by the introduction of warm air from the standby temperature control valve. The fan section of the ACM is used to bring cooling air into the ram air duct when the aircraft is on the ground. Water Removal Condensed water droplets are removed by an inertial process in the water extractor. Water removed by high pressure through the extractor is routed to the water spray injector in the ram air inlet for the primary and secondary heat exchangers. The spray cools the ram air and increases the systems cooling capacity. B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 14 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 5 B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 15 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd PACK FLOW CONTROL AND PACK COOLING RAM AIR SYSTEM -­‐ RAM AIR INLET – OPERATION Flight Cruise (Flaps Up) General In flight, when the flaps are at the full up position, the pack/zone temperature controller has control of the ram air actuator. The pack/zone controller opens or closes the ram air inlet modulation panels to control the pack temperature. The ram air system controls the airflow through the primary and secondary heat exchangers. The ram air inlet assembly has these two major assemblies: Indication - Ram air inlet modulation panel - Ram air inlet deflector door The RAM DOOR FULL OPEN (Blue) light on the Air Conditioning/Bleed air panel illuminates anytime the ram air inlet actuator is driven to the full open position. These are the three modes of control for the ram air system: - Ground - Flight (flaps not up) - Flight cruise (flaps up) The Air Conditioning Accessory Units (ACAU) relays control power to the pack zone temperature controllers for ram air actuation and control. Ground Mode When the airplane is on the ground, the ram air inlet actuator is in the fully retracted position. When the actuator is in the fully retracted position, the ram air deflector door is in the extend position, and the ram air inlet modulation panel is in the open position. The RAM DOOR FULL OPEN lights are on. Flight (Flaps Not Up) At takeoff, the actuator moves the ram air deflector door out of the airstream. The ram air modulation panel stays open. The RAM DOOR FULL OPEN lights are on. B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 16 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 6 B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 17 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd TEMPERATURE CONTROL – OPERATION General The temperature controls panel is the air conditioning indication and control interface for the flight crew. Temperature Selectors The three temperature selectors give automatic temperature control for their related zones. The selector has these temperature set points: - C (cool) sets a temperature of 65F - W (warm) sets a temperature of 85F - Intermediate selector positions set proportionate temperature Turn selector to the OFF position to close the related trim air modulating valve. Duct Overheat Light The three duct overheat lights show over temperature or control channel fault/failures: Trim Air Switch The trim air switch controls the trim air pressure regulating and shutoff valve B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 18 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 7 B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 19 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd TEMPERATURE CONTROL - GENERAL DESCRIPTION Trim Air The temperature control system automatically controls the temperature in these three airplane air conditioning zones: - Flight compartment zone - Forward passenger compartment zone - Aft passenger compartment zone Physical Description The temperature control system uses these components: - Temperature control panel - Sensors and overheat switches - Digital pack/zone controllers - Pack temperature control valves (normal and standby) - Trim air system valves - Air Conditioning Accessory Units (ACAUs) General Description The temperature control system is automatic. The flight crew makes the required selections on the temperature control panel to operate the system. During operation, the digital pack/zone controllers modulate the temperature control valve. They control pack discharge temperature to the requirements of the zone that requires the most cooling. The pack/zone controllers modulate the trim air modulating valves to inject hot trim air into the ducts of the other zones. This increases the temperature of the air supply to the other zones. B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 20 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 8 B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 21 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd PACK/ZONE TEMPERATURE CONTROLLER GENERAL Purpose The pack/zone temperature controllers do these things: - Control their related air conditioning pack - Give automatic standby control to the opposite air conditioning pack - Control two zone trim air control channels - Control their related air conditioning pack ram air actuators - Give maintenance crews automatic built in test equipment (BITE) that isolates faults to the line replaceable unit (LRU) level Location The controllers are in the EE compartment in the transverse racks Training Information Point The pack/zone temperature controllers are electrostatic discharge sensitive (ESDS) devices. Use ESDS safe handling techniques. B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 22 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 9 B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 23 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd DISTRIBUTION - GENERAL DESCRIPTION General Ventilation The A/C distribution system supplies conditioned air to the passenger and flight compartments. The ventilation system uses differential pressure to pull air out of the airplane. The air moves through overboard vents from the cabin, galley, and the lavatory areas. Main Air Distribution Equipment Cooling System The main air distribution system gets air from these sources: The equipment cooling system removes heat from the equipment in the main equipment centre and the flight compartment. - Air conditioning packs - Ground conditioned air - Recirculation system The main mix manifold collects and mixes air from any combination of these sources. Flight Compartment Distribution The flight compartment gets conditioned air from the left pack or the mix manifold. A duct on the left side of the airplane transmits the air. The flight compartment has supply ducts and outlets to control the airflow at each station. Passenger Compartment Distribution The passenger conditioned air distribution system gets air from the mix manifold. The air goes through riser ducts and up sidewalls to an overhead distribution duct. Outlets along the sidewalls and the center of the ceiling divide the air for symmetrical supply. Recirculation System The recirculation system uses two fans to move air from the passenger compartment to the mix manifold. This system reduces the amount of air that the packs need to supply. B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 24 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 10 B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 25 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd RECIRCULATION SYSTEM – INTRODUCTION Purpose The recirculation system recirculates the conditioned air from the collector shroud and distribution bay. This reduces the requirement for bleed air from the engines for air conditioning to the cabins. Recirculation The recirculation system has these components in the distribution compartment (aft of the forward cargo compartment): - Recirculation air filters - Recirculation fans - Recirculation fan check valves Access Access is through the bulkhead in the aft section of the forward cargo compartment. Recirculation Air Filters The recirculation air filters clean the air as it enters the recirculation system. The filters cannot be bypassed. This maintains the quality of the air in the air conditioning distribution system. B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 26 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 11 B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 27 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd EQUIPMENT COOLING SYSTEM - GENERAL DESCRIPTION General The overboard exhaust valve lets exhaust air go overboard when the airplane is on the ground (unpressurised). The exhaust air supplements heating in the forward cargo compartment in flight (pressurised). The equipment cooling system uses these two systems to remove heat from equipment: - Supply system (pushes air) - Exhaust system (pulls air) The supply system and the exhaust system use fans to move air. Each system has a primary fan and an alternate fan. The supply and exhaust fans move air through ducts and manifolds. The ducts and manifolds connect to shrouds around the electronic and electrical equipment. Low flow sensors monitor the ducts for cooling flow conditions. Supply The supply fans push filtered air to these components: - P1, P2, P3 (display units) - P9 panel (FMC control display units) - Equipment racks in the EE compartment Exhaust The exhaust fans pull air from these components: - P1, P2, P3 (display units) - P9 (FMC control display units) - P6 (circuit breaker panel) - P5 (control and indication) - P8 (center aisle stand) - Equipment racks in the EE compartment B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 28 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 12 B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 29 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd PRESSURIZATION CONTROL - GENERAL DESCRIPTION Purpose At high altitudes the air is too thin to sustain life. The airplane pressurization system keeps the cabin air density adequate to sustain life. General Description The system controls the position of the outflow valve to control cabin pressure. The air conditioning packs force air into the airplane/pressure vessel (cabin).The pressurization system controls the rate at which the air flows out of the cabin. This maintains a safe cabin pressure. The pressurization control systems are designed for a nominal operating pressure of 7.8-8.35 psid with a maximum operating pressure of 8.45 psid. Safety relief valves protect the fuselage structure from overpressure or negative pressure. They are set to open and release pressure at 8.65 psid or -1.0 psid. Automatic Pressurization Control In the automatic mode of operation, the system uses a redundant system of digital pressure controllers to schedule cabin pressurization through all phases of flight. The active pressure controller keeps cabin altitude at a safe, comfortable pressure altitude (8,000 ft ISA maximum). The pressure controllers are line replaceable units and incorporate standard front face BITE. Manual Pressurization Control In the manual mode of operation, the flight crew has direct control of the outflow valve from the P5 panel. B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 30 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 13 B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 31 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd COMPONENT LOCATION General The control panel is on the right side of the P5-6 panel. The No. 1 Cabin Pressure Controller (CPC) is on the E2 rack. The No. 2 CPC is on the E4 rack. The outflow valve is on the aft right fuselage skin, below the aft service door. There are two safety relief valves. One is inboard of the outflow valve. The other is outboard of the outflow valve. The negative pressure relief valve is on the aft right fuselage skin, forward of the outflow valve. The cabin altitude warning switch is on the ceiling of the forward EE compartment. Access is through the lower nose access door. The cabin altitude warning horn is in the aural warning module. The module is on the right side of the pilots' control stand. B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 32 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 14 B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 33 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd CABIN PRESSURE CONTROL MODULE AND CABIN ALTITUDE PANEL Purpose The cabin pressure control module and cabin altitude panel let the crew monitor and control the pressurization system. The control panel has these parts: A three position toggle switch controls the aft outflow valve when in the manual mode. It has three positions: - CLOSE - NEUTRAL - OPEN - Cabin pressure control module - System status lights - Pressure indication panel It is spring loaded to the neutral position. There are four system status lights above the control module: Location The cabin pressure control module is on the P5-6 panel. The system status lights are above the module. The cabin altitude panel (P5-16) is next to the module. - AUTO FAIL - OFF SCHED DESCENT - ALTN - MAN Cabin Pressure Control Module – General The cabin pressure control module has these controls: - Mode selector - Landing altitude selector with display - Flight altitude selector with display - Aft outflow valve position indicator - Manual control toggle switch The mode selector has three positions. They set these system modes of operation: - AUTO for automatic operation - ALT for alternate automatic operation - MAN for manual control B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 34 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 15 B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 35 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd AIR CONDITIONING - GENERAL DESCRIPTION 600/700 Equipment Cooling Panel General The supply and exhaust fan switches are on the equipment cooling panel. The flight compartment panels let you control the air conditioning system. Air-conditioning Control Panels Cabin Pressure Selector Panel/Cabin altitude Panel These flight compartment panels on the P5 forward overhead panel let you control the air conditioning subsystems: These controls and indications are on the cabin pressure control panel: - Landing altitude selector - Flight altitude selector - Mode selector - Outflow valve position indicator - Outflow valve switch - Cabin differential pressure indicator - Cabin rate of climb indicator - Altitude horn cut-out switch - Cabin temperature panel - Air conditioning/bleed air controls panel - Equipment cooling panel - Cabin pressure control panel - Cabin altitude panel Cabin Temperature Panel These controls and indications are on the cabin temperature panel: - Control cabin temperature control - Passenger cabin temperature control - Temperature indication and selection - Duct overheat indication - Air mix valve position indication Air Conditioning/Bleed Air Controls Panel These controls and indications are on the air conditioning panel: - Ram air inlet door indication - Recirculation fan switch - Cooling pack switches - Pack overheat indication - Pack reset push button B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 36 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 16 B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 37 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd COOLING - GENERAL DESCRIPTION General Primary Heat Exchanger The cooling system uses these components and systems to cool the bleed air: The primary heat exchanger receives bleed air from the flow control shutoff valve. As the bleed air goes through the heat exchanger, ram air removes heat. The cooled bleed air goes to the compressor section of the air cycle machine. - Air conditioning/bleed air controls panel - Flow control shutoff valve - Heat exchangers (2) - Air cycle machine - Ram air system - Low limit (35F) system - Water separator Air cycle machine The air cycle machine is a three-wheel air bearing air cycle machine. Cooled bleed air from the primary heat exchanger enters the air cycle machine and is compressed. The compressed air then goes to a secondary heat exchanger and back to the air cycle machine. The bleed air is then rapidly expanded and goes to a condenser. Air Conditioning/Bleed Air Controls Panel Secondary Heat Exchanger The air conditioning/bleed air controls panel gives control and indications of the cooling system. These are the controls and indications of the cooling system: The secondary heat exchanger receives compressed air from the air cycle machine. As the air goes through the heat exchanger, ram air removes heat. After the compressed air is cooled, it goes through a water extractor duct and back to the air cycle machine. - RAM DOOR FULL OPEN Lights - L/R PACK switches - PACK TRIP OFF Lights - TRIP RESET button Ram Air System The ram air system controls the quantity of outside ambient air that flows through the heat exchangers. Flow Control Shutoff Valve Low Limit (35F) System Bleed air from the pneumatic system supplies bleed air to the flow control shutoff valve. The valve controls the flow of bleed air into the pack. After the bleed air goes through the flow control shutoff valve it enters the primary heat exchanger. The low limit (35F) system keeps the air temperature into the water separator at a temperature of 35F. Water Separator The water separator collects and removes moisture from the air before it goes into the distribution system. B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 38 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 17 B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 39 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd COOLING -­‐ FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION Functional Description The turbine section uses rapid expansion to decrease the temperature of bleed air. The cold bleed air then goes into the water separator. While the cold bleed air goes through the water separator, moisture is removed. This moisture goes to the water spray nozzle. The water spray nozzle sprays the water into the ram air duct. If the temperature of the cold bleed air in the water separator goes below 35F, the low limit 35F system adds partially cool bleed air to cold bleed air in the low pressure water separator mix muff. This heats the air and prevents ice in the water separator. After the water separator, the cold bleed air goes to the mix chamber. The mix chamber adds hot bleed air from the hot side of the air mix valve. The Flow Control Shutoff Valve (FCSOV) gets hot bleed air from the pneumatic manifold. The flow control shutoff valve controls the flow of hot bleed air to the primary heat exchanger and the hot side of the air mix valve. A hot air connection downstream of the FCSOV supplies hot bleed air to the turbine case. This prevents ice in the turbine case. The ram air system controls the flow of ram air to the primary and secondary heat exchangers. These are the ram air system components: - Ram air control temperature sensor - Ram air inlet controller - Ram air inlet actuator - Ram air inlet deflector door - Ram air inlet modulation panels - Impeller fan - Fan bypass check valve When bleed air goes through the primary heat exchanger, ram air removes some of the heat. This partially cool bleed air goes to the cool side of the air mix valve. From the air mix valve, partially cool bleed air goes to the compressor section of the air cycle machine. The compressor section increases the pressure and temperature of the partially cool bleed air. This compressed air goes to the secondary heat exchanger. When the compressed air goes through the secondary heat exchanger, ram air removes some of the heat. This bleed air goes to the turbine section of the air cycle machine. B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 40 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 18 B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 41 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd TEMPERATURE CONTROL – OPERATION General Cabin Temperature Controller The controls and indications for the temperature control system are on the temperature control panel. The Cabin Temperature Controller (CPC) is located in the E/E compartment The Cabin Temperature Controller (CTC) controls the temperature of conditioned air for the cabin areas. Controls Location The selector for the flight compartment is on the left side (CONT CABIN). The passenger compartment temperature selector is on the right side (PASS CABIN). The passenger compartment has an AIR TEMP selector in the centre. The CTC is in the EE compartment on the E4-1 rack. Physical Description It has BITE controls and instructions on the front face. The temperature selectors are spring-loaded to the OFF position. The selector has a MANUAL COOL and MANUAL WARM position. These positions are momentary positions. You must hold the selector in these positions for manual operation. Air temperature is measured by the temperature bulbs in the passenger cabin and the passenger supply duct. The air temperature (AIR TEMP) selector lets you select which bulbs to monitor. Indications The left and right air conditioning packs have an air mix valve position indicator. This shows the proportion of the hot and cold air in the air-streams. The temperature (TEMP) indicator shows the passenger compartment air temperature or the supply duct air temperature. The DUCT OVERHEAT light gives indication when the duct temperature is too high. There is a DUCT OVERHEAT light for the flight and passenger compartment supply ducts. B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 42 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 19 B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 43 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd TEMPERATURE CONTROL - CABIN TEMP SENSOR Purpose The cabin temperature sensor assembly provides a flow of filtered air over a cabin temperature sensor and bulb. The cabin temperature sensor provides compartment temperature data to the cabin temperature controller. Location The flight compartment cabin temperature sensor assembly is in the ceiling of the flight compartment. Physical Description These components are part of the cabin temperature sensor assembly: - Temperature sensor - Inlet grille - Air filter - Temperature sensor fan Functional Description The fan pulls in cabin air through the inlet grille and air filter. The temperature sensor sends the air temperature to the Cabin Temperature Controller (CTC). The CTC uses this data to compare with the selected temperature. The flight compartment temperature sensor fan comes on when 115vac is available and the left pack switch is in AUTO or HIGH. The passenger compartment temperature sensor fan comes on when 115vac is available. B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 44 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 20 B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 45 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Ventilation DISTRIBUTION - GENERAL DESCRIPTION – COMPONENET General Description The ventilation system uses differential pressure to pull air out of the airplane. The air moves through overboard vents from the cabin, galley and the lavatory areas. The distribution system has the following sub-systems. Equipment Cooling System Main Air Distribution The equipment cooling system removes heat from the equipment in the main equipment centre and the flight compartment. The main air distribution system gets air from these sources: Distribution Component Location - Air conditioning packs - Ground conditioned air - Recirculation system The distribution system has these components in the distribution compartment (aft of the forward cargo compartment): - Main distribution manifold - Recirculation fan - Ground conditioned air connection The main distribution manifold collects and mixes air from any combination of the sources. Flight Compartment Conditioned Air Distribution The equipment cooling system has components in these areas: The flight compartment gets conditioned air from the let pack and the mix manifold. The air goes through a duct on the left side of the airplane. The flight compartment has supply ducts and outlets to control the air flow at each station. - EE compartment - Forward equipment compartment - Flight compartment Passenger Compartment Conditioned Air Distribution Cooling System Component Location The Passenger conditioned air distribution gets air from the mix manifold. The air goes through riser ducts and up side walls to an overhead distribution duct. The two air conditioning packs are in the air conditioning compartments. The air conditioning compartments are on the left and right sides of the keel beam in the wing-to-body area. Access is from the bottom of the fuselage. Recirculation System The recirculation system uses a fan to move air from the passenger compartment to the main distribution manifold. This system reduces the amount of air necessary for the packs to supply. B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 46 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 21 B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 47 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd RECIRCULATION SYSTEM – INTRODUCTION Purpose The recirculation system supplies air for ventilation. The use of cabin air for ventilation decreases the use of air from the engine bleed system. General Description The recirculation system collects cabin air to use with pack air in the distribution system. The distribution system supplies air to the passenger compartment area. The passenger cabin air moves through these recirculation components: - Collector shroud - Air filter - Fan - Check valve Location The recirculation components are in the distribution compartment. Operation The recirculation fan is enabled when you move the RECIRC FAN switch to the AUTO position. Recirculation fan operation depends on air conditioning pack operation. B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 48 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 22 B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 49 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd AIR CONDITIONING - FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION General The usual control for the left pack makes sure that it supplies air at a temperature that gives the necessary cooling for the flight compartment. These are the primary parts of the Air Conditioning (A/C) system that have an effect on the supply of fresh air or the recirculation of conditioned air: The control for the right pack makes sure that it supplies air at a temperature that gives the necessary cooling for the passenger compartment. - Pack flow control - Pack cooling system - Zone temperature control - Recirculation - Air distribution Zone Temperature Control This part of the A/C system controls the temperature in the two zones, the flight compartment and the passenger cabin. The temperature changes are made by the mix valve with signals from the temperature regulator. The primary parts of the A/C system have these functions: - Control fresh air flow for airplane pressurization and ventilation - Control the flight compartment and passenger cabin temperature - Recirculate cabin air for ventilation Recirculation This part of the A/C system recycles 50 percent of the cabin air for ventilation purposes. This reduces the quantity of fresh air necessary from the pneumatic system for ventilation. The recirculation fan and filter are the primary components. Pack Flow Control This part of the A/C system controls the quantity of fresh air that goes into the airplane. The control is by a flow control and shutoff valve. The quantity of fresh air necessary for ventilation is more than for pressurization. The ventilation quantity is based on a fixed value for the crew and allowable leakage, and on the number of passenger seats. Usually, the left and right flow control systems provide the same quantity of fresh air. Fresh air flow changes when airplane conditions change. See the pack flow control section for more information about the pack flow control systems. Pack Cooling System This part of the A/C system removes water as necessary and controls the temperature of the fresh air before it goes into the air distribution part of the air conditioning system. The primary components are the left and right packs. B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 50 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 23 B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 51 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK B737 NG GEN FAM AIR-CON REFRESHER COURSE 52 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ATA 23-00-00 COMMUNICATIONS B737 NG GEN FAM COMS REFRESHER COURSE 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 23-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK B737 NG GEN FAM COMS REFRESHER COURSE 2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 23-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd CONTENTS ATA 23 – COMMUNICATIONS FLIGHT INTERPHONE SYSTEM ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 4 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 4 FLIGHT CREW INTERFACES .................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 4 OTHER COMPONENT AND SYSTEM INTERFACES .................................................................................................................................................................................................... 4 AUDIO CONTROL PANEL .................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 6 PURPOSE ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 6 CONTROLS ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 6 MICROPHONE SELECTOR SWITCHES ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 RECEIVER SWITCHES ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 6 FILTER SWITCH ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 FLIGHT CREW CALL SYSTEM / CABIN INTERPHONE - .......................................................................................................................................................................... 8 GENERAL DESCRIPTION ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 8 LOCATION .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 8 SERVICE INTERPHONE SYSTEM .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 10 GENERAL DESCRIPTION ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 10 JACK LOCATIONS ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 10 PASSENGER ADDRESS SYSTEM .................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 12 GENERAL DESCRIPTION ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 12 RADIO COMMUNICATION PANEL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................... 14 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 14 CONTROLS AND INDICATIONS .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 14 VOICE RECORDER SYSTEM ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 16 GENERAL DESCRIPTION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 16 COMPONENTS ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 16 B737 NG GEN FAM COMS REFRESHER COURSE 3 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 23-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd FLIGHT INTERPHONE SYSTEM General The remote electronic unit (REU) sends audio signals to the headsets and to the flight interphone speakers. The Remote Electronics Unit (REU) and the Audio Control Panel (ACP) control the audio signals to and from the flight crew. The REU also controls the communication with the service interphone and related electronics equipment. Other Component and System Interfaces The REU connects to these other components: During a system failure, emergency operation bypasses all active system circuitry and maintains airplane to ground station communication. - Communications radios; the REU sends Push-To-Talk (PTT) and microphone audio to the transceivers and receives audio back from them - Navigation receivers; the REU receives voice and Morse code identification tones. Flight Crew Interfaces This system description shows the captain's system. Interfaces and components for other flight crew stations are similar. The flight crew uses microphone (mic) switches on these components to send audio to the REU: The flight interphone system also has an interface with these other systems: - Passenger addresses system; lets the flight crew make announcements to passengers - Service interphone system; lets the flight crew speak with attendants and service personnel - Voice recorder; records the flight crew microphone and receive audio - Ground Proximity Warning Computer (GPWC); lets flight crew monitor warning signals - Traffic Alert and Collision Avoidance system (TCAS); lets the flight crew monitor TCAS signals - Flight Control Computer (FCC); gives discrete signals to the REU. This signal activates an altitude alert tone generator - Control wheel - ACP - Hand microphone A microphone on these components lets the flight crew speak on the flight interphone system: - Oxygen mask - Headset - Hand mic The flight crew uses the audio control panels for these functions: - Listen to the communication and navigation receivers - Adjust the volume of the received audio - Select a transmitter and microphone - Key the microphone B737 NG GEN FAM COMS REFRESHER COURSE 4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 23-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure1 B737 NG GEN FAM COMS REFRESHER COURSE 5 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 23-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd The transmitter selectors (except PA) have call lights in the switch. The call lights come on when the flight crew get any one of these calls: AUDIO CONTROL PANEL Purpose - SELCAL on a VHF or HF radio - ACARS call from the ACARS MU - Ground crew call (FLT light) - Flight crew call (CABIN light) The flight crew uses the Audio Control Panels (ACPs) to control audio for the communication and navigation systems. Each ACP controls one station. Controls To turn off the call light, the flight crew selects the system and sends a PTT to that system. When you push a PTT switch, the microphone audio and PTT signals go to the system set by the selector switches. When the ACP initially gets power, the flight interphone system is active. These are the controls on the ACP: - Transmitter selectors - Receiver switches - Radio-Intercom PTT switch - Filter switch - ALT-NORM switch Receiver Switches Push the receiver switch (push-on, push-off) to listen to communication or navigation system audio. Turn it to adjust the volume. You can monitor any combination of systems at any time. Microphone Selector Switches The flight interphone system gets audio from these microphones: CAUTION: RECEIVER SWITCHES ARE PUSH-ON/PUSH OFF TYPE. THE KNOB IS IN WHEN THE CONTROL IS ON, AND OUT WHEN OFF. DO NOT PULL THESE KNOBS, OR YOU WILL DAMAGE THEM. - Boom - Oxygen mask - Hand-held Radio-Intercom PTT Switch You push a transmitter selector to select a communication transmitter or system. You can select only one system at a time. When you push a transmitter selector, this happens: The radio-intercom PTT switch is a three position switch with momentary contacts in the R/T and I/C position. In the R/T position, the microphone audio and PTT signals go to the communication system set by the transmitter selectors. In the I/C position, the boom or mask microphone jacks connect to the flight interphone system. The radio-intercom PTT switch is in parallel with the PTT switch on the control wheel. - The selector switch light comes on - The received audio comes on at the volume set by the receiver volume control - The microphone audio and PTT signals are enabled for that system Filter Switch The filter switch controls the filter that processes the navigation audio you Receive. B737 NG GEN FAM COMS REFRESHER COURSE 6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 23-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 2 B737 NG GEN FAM COMS REFRESHER COURSE 7 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 23-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd FLIGHT CREW CALL SYSTEM / CABIN INTERPHONE - Aural and visual indications from the system tell the flight and cabin crew to use the cabin interphone. GENERAL DESCRIPTION Flight Compartment to Attendant Stations Handsets You push the ATTEND switch on the passenger signs panel to call the attendant stations from the flight compartment. When you make this call, these are the indications in the passenger cabin: The attendants use handsets to speak with each other. They also use them to make announcements on the Passenger Address (PA) system. - The pink light on the forward and the aft exit locator signs comes on - The passenger address system sends a HI/LO chime to the cabin speakers Physical Description The interphone handset is like a telephone handset. It has these features: Attendant Station to Flight Compartment - Earpiece speaker - Microphone - Push-button switches You use the handset to call the flight compartment from an attendant station. When you make this call, these are the indications in the flight compartment: Location There is a handset at the forward attendant's panel and at the aft attendant's panel in the passenger compartment. - The CALL light on the passenger signs panel comes on - The aural warning module makes a HI chime General Attendant Station to Attendant Station The flight crew call system lets the flight crew and attendants call each other. These are the calls that can be made: You use the handset to call one attendant station from another attendant station. When you make this call, these are the indications in the passenger cabin: - The pink light on the exit locator sign comes on at the other attendant station - The passenger address system sends a HI/LO chime to the cabin speaker - Flight compartment to attendant stations - Attendant station to flight compartment - Attendant station to attendant station B737 NG GEN FAM COMS REFRESHER COURSE 8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 23-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 3 B737 NG GEN FAM COMS REFRESHER COURSE 9 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 23-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd SERVICE INTERPHONE SYSTEM Jack Locations GENERAL DESCRIPTION The service interphone system is for the: These locations have service interphone jacks: - P19 external power panel - Electronic equipment compartment - Fuelling station, behind the access door on the right wing - Right wheel well, on the forward wheel well fairing exterior - Left wheel well, on the forward wheel well fairing exterior - Aft cabin, on the ceiling above the attendant station - APU service area, adjacent to the 48 section access door - Flight crew - Attendants - Ground crew The flight crew selects the service interphone function from the Audio Control Panel (ACP). Flight interphone microphones send audio to the Remote Electronics Unit (REU). Flight interphone headsets and speakers get audio from the REU. The flight crew can also use a handset to talk on the service interphone system. The handset jack connects to the system without ACP control. The attendants operate a handset to connect into the system. An attendant panel connects the handset to the REU. The ground crew microphones connect into the system through the service interphone switch. You must turn on the service interphone switch to operate the system from the service station jacks. The headset gets audio from the REU. The REU does these functions: - Combines audio from the microphones - Amplifies the audio signal - Sends audio to handsets, headsets, and speakers B737 NG GEN FAM COMS REFRESHER COURSE 10 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 23-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 4 B737 NG GEN FAM COMS REFRESHER COURSE 11 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 23-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd PASSENGER ADDRESS SYSTEM GENERAL DESCRIPTION The Passenger Address (PA) amplifier puts a priority on the audio inputs from these places: - Pilots - Attendants - Pre-Recorded Announcement and boarding Music reproducer (PRAM) The PA amplifier amplifies the audio input with the highest priority and sends the signal to these places: - Passenger cabin and lavatory speakers - Passenger entertainment system - Remote Electronics Unit (REU) The amplified audio to the REU goes through muting circuits for the forward and aft attendant speakers. When an attendant makes an announcement, the muting circuits stop the audio for that attendants speaker. B737 NG GEN FAM COMS REFRESHER COURSE 12 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 23-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 5 B737 NG GEN FAM COMS REFRESHER COURSE 13 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 23-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd RADIO COMMUNICATION PANEL General The radio communication panel provides these: - Active/Standby frequency selection - HF sensitivity control - Mode selection to the HF transceiver - Test initiation to the VHF transceivers Controls and Indications At power up, RCP -1 controls VHF-1. RCP 2 controls VHF 2. RCP 3 controls VHF 3. Any radio communication panel can control any transceiver. Push the radio tuning switch to select the transceiver for that RCP. The light above the switch comes on. Each radio communication panel can tune only one transceiver at a time. When you select an off-side radio, two off-side tuning lights come on. One light is on the radio communication panel that you use to make the selection. The other light is on the on-side radio communication panel of the radio you select. Set the frequency in the standby frequency indicator. Turn the frequency selectors to set the frequency. The first digit is always 1. The outer knob sets the second two digits (10 MHz and 1 MHz) in 1 MHz increments. The inner 25KHz increments. Push the frequency transfer switch to change the active and standby frequencies. Push the OFF switch to stop the operation of the radio communication panel. The switch shows white when it is off. B737 NG GEN FAM COMS REFRESHER COURSE 14 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 23-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 6 RADIO COMMUNICATION PANEL B737 NG GEN FAM COMS REFRESHER COURSE 15 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 23-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd VOICE RECORDER SYSTEM GENERAL DESCRIPTION The voice recorder unit makes a continuous record of flight crew communication and flight compartment sounds. It erases the communication data automatically so that the memory stores only recent audio. The voice recorder unit keeps the last 120 minutes of communication data in memory. The voice recorder unit receives audio from the remote electronics unit and the area microphone. The area microphone is in the cockpit voice recorder panel. Components The voice recorder system has these components: - Cockpit voice recorder panel - Voice recorder unit-located on E6 rack in aft cargo compartment B737 NG GEN FAM COMS REFRESHER COURSE 16 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 23-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd VOICE RECORDER SYSTEM - GENERAL DESCRIPTION B737 NG GEN FAM COMS REFRESHER COURSE 17 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Figure 7 23-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK B737 NG GEN FAM COMS REFRESHER COURSE 18 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 23-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. Training Manual B 737-600/700/800 ATA 38 Water and Waste Level 2 Lufthansa Technical Training GmbH Lufthansa Base REFRESHER COURSE FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Issue: July 1999 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa 1995 AMET Ltd. For training purposes and internal use only. Copyright by Lufthansa Technical Training GmbH. All rights reserved. No parts of this training manual may be sold or reproduced in any form without permission of: Lufthansa Technical Training GmbH Lufthansa Base Frankfurt D-60546 Frankfurt/Main Tel. +49 69 / 696 41 78 Fax +49 69 / 696 63 84 Lufthansa Base Hamburg Weg beim Jäger 193 D-22335 Hamburg Tel. +49 40 / 5070 24 13 Fax +49 40 / 5070 47 46 REFRESHER COURSE FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Ltd. TABLE OF CONTENTS ATA 38 WATER AND WASTE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 38-00 WATER AND WASTE - INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . GENERAL DESCRIPTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 4 6 38-10 POTABLE WATER - INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 38-10 POTABLE WATER - INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 12 38-1 1 POTABLE WATER SERVICE PANEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FILL/OVERFLOW VALVE AND CONTROL CABLE . . . . . WATER TANK DRAIN VALVE AND CONTROL CABLE . WATER TANK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LAVATORY WATER SUPPLY SHUTOFF VALVE . . . . . . . FORWARD LAVATORY DRAIN VALVE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LAVATORY FAUCET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 38-13 WATER HEATER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . WATER HEATER - FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION . . . . . 28 30 38-14 WATER QUANTITY INDICATION SYSTEM - INTRO . . . . . WATER QUANTITY TRANSMITTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . WATER QUANTITY INDICATOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 34 36 38 38-42 WATER TANK PRESSURIZATION SYSTEM - INTRO . . . . COMPONENT LOCATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AIR COMPRESSOR / INLET AIR FILTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . PRESSURE LIMIT SWITCH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AIR COMPRESSOR FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION . . . . PRESSURE REGULATOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CHECK VALVE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IN-LINE AIR FILTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PRESSURE RELIEF VALVE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 42 44 46 48 50 52 54 56 38-30 WASTE DISPOSAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 38-31 GRAY WATER SYSTEM - DRAIN MAST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 REFRESHER COURSE 38-32 VACUUM WASTE SYSTEM - INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . COMPONENTLOCATION - LAVATORY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . COMPONENT LOCATION - AFT CARGO COMPRTMNT WASTE SERVICE PANEL - COMPONENTS . . . . . . . . . . FLUSH SWITCH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . VACUUM TOILET ASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FLUSH CYCLE - OPERATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . VACUUM BLOWER AND FILTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . VACUUM CHECK VALVE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . VACUUM BLOWER BAROMETRIC SWITCH . . . . . . . . . VACUUM BLOWER - FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION . . . LIQUID SEPARATOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . WASTE TANK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . WASTE DRAIN BALL VALVE AND PULL ROD . . . . . . . . WASTE DRAIN VALVE ASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . WASTE TANK RINSE FITTING ASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . WASTE TANK RINSE FILTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . WASTE TANK RINSE NOZZLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DRAIN LINE BLOCKAGE REMOVAL VALVE . . . . . . . . . . FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION - MECHANICAL . . . . . . . . 62 64 66 68 70 72 74 76 78 80 82 84 86 88 90 92 94 96 98 100 38-33 WASTE TANK QUANTITY INDICATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . WASTE TANK POINT LEVEL SENSOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . WASTE TANK CONTINUOUS LEVEL SENSOR . . . . . . . LOGIC CONTROL MODULE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ATTENDANT PANEL WASTE QUANTITY INDICATOR . FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LOGIC CONTROL MODULE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 104 106 108 110 112 114 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: i AMET Ltd. TABLE OF FIGURES Figure 1 Figure 2 Figure 3 Figure 4 Figure 5 Figure 6 Figure 7 Figure 8 Figure 9 Figure 10 Figure 11 Figure 12 Figure 13 Figure 14 Figure 15 Figure 16 Figure 17 Figure 18 Figure 19 Figure 20 Figure 21 Figure 22 Figure 23 Figure 24 Figure 25 Figure 26 Figure 27 Figure 28 Figure 29 Figure 30 Figure 31 Figure 32 Figure 33 Figure 34 Figure 35 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . General Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Potable Water Service Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Water Tank Drain Valve and Control Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . Water Tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lavatory Water Supply Shutoff Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lavatory Drain Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lavatory Faucet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Water Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Water Heater - Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Water Quantity Indication System - Introduction . . . . . . Water Quantity Transmitter and Adapter Cable . . . . . . . Water Quantity Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Water Quantity Indication - Functional Description . . . Water Tank Pressurization - Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . Water Tank Pressurization - Component Location . . . . . Air Compressor and Inlet Air Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pressure Limit Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Air Compressor Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pressure Regulator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Check Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . In-Line Air Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pressure Relief Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Gray Water System - Drain Mast . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Vacuum Waste System - Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Vacuum Waste - Component Locations - Lavatory . . . . Component Locations - Aft Cargo Compartment . . . . . . Vacuum Waste - Waste Service Panel Components . . Vacuum Waste - Flush Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Vacuum Waste - Vacuum Toilet Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . REFRESHER COURSE 3 5 7 9 11 13 15 19 21 23 25 27 29 31 33 35 37 39 41 43 45 47 49 51 53 55 57 59 61 63 65 67 69 71 73 Figure 36 Figure 37 Figure 38 Figure 39 Figure 40 Figure 41 Figure 42 Figure 43 Figure 44 Figure 45 Figure 46 Figure 47 Figure 48 Figure 49 Figure 50 Figure 51 Figure 52 Figure 53 Figure 54 Figure 55 Figure 56 Vacuum Waste - Flush Cycle - Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . Vacuum Waste - Vacuum Blower and Filter . . . . . . . . . . Vacuum Waste - Vacuum Check Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Vacuum Waste - Vacuum Blower Barometric Switch . . Vacuum Waste - Vacuum Blower - Funktional Description Vacuum Waste - Liquid Separator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Vacuum Waste - Waste Tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Vacuum Waste - Waste Drain Ball Valve and Pull Rod . Vacuum Waste - Waste Drain Valve Assembly . . . . . . . Vacuum Waste - Waste Tank Rinse Fitting Assembly . . Vacuum Waste - Waste Tank Rinse Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . Vacuum Waste - Waste Tank Rinse Nozzle . . . . . . . . . . Waste Tank Drain Line Blockage Removal Valve . . . . . Vacuum Waste - Functional Description - Mechanical . Waste Tank Quantity Indication - Introduction . . . . . . . . Waste Tank Point Level Sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Waste Tank Continuous Level Sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Waste Tank Quantity Indication - Logic Control Module Attendent’s Panel Waste Quantity Indicator . . . . . . . . . . Waste Tank Quantity Indication - Functional Description Logic Control Module - Training Information Point . . . . . FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 75 77 79 81 83 85 87 89 91 93 95 97 99 101 103 105 107 109 111 113 115 Page: ii AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 w 38-00 ATA 38 WATER AND WASTE For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE INTRODUCTION 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 1 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-00 38-00 WATER AND WASTE - INTRODUCTION For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE INTRODUCTION 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 2 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-00 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE INTRODUCTION Figure 1 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Introduction FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 3 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-00 GENERAL DESCRIPTION For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE GENERAL DESCRIPTION 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 4 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-00 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE GENERAL DESCRIPTION Figure 2 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br General Description FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 5 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-00 FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE GENERAL DESCRIPTION 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 6 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-00 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE GENERAL DESCRIPTION Figure 3 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Functional Description FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 7 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-10 38-10 POTABLE WATER - INTRODUCTION For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 8 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-10 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER Figure 4 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Introduction FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 9 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-10 38-10 POTABLE WATER - INTRODUCTION For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 10 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-10 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER Figure 5 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Introduction FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 11 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-10 FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 12 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-10 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER Figure 6 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Functional Description FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 13 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-1 1 38-1 1 POTABLE WATER SERVICE PANEL For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 14 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-1 1 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER Figure 7 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Potable Water Service Panel FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 15 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-1 1 FILL/OVERFLOW VALVE AND CONTROL CABLE For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 16 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-1 1 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 17 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-1 1 WATER TANK DRAIN VALVE AND CONTROL CABLE For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 18 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-1 1 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER Figure 8 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Water Tank Drain Valve and Control Cable FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 19 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-1 1 WATER TANK For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 20 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-1 1 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER Figure 9 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Water Tank FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 21 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-1 1 LAVATORY WATER SUPPLY SHUTOFF VALVE For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 22 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-1 1 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER Figure 10 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Lavatory Water Supply Shutoff Valve FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 23 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-1 1 FORWARD LAVATORY DRAIN VALVE For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 24 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-1 1 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER Figure 11 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Lavatory Drain Valve FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 25 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-1 1 LAVATORY FAUCET For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 26 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-1 1 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER Figure 12 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Lavatory Faucet FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 27 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-13 38-13 WATER HEATER For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 28 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-13 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER Figure 13 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Water Heater FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 29 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-13 WATER HEATER - FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 30 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-13 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER Figure 14 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Water Heater - Functional Description FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 31 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-14 38-14 WATER QUANTITY INDICATION SYSTEM - INTRODUCTION For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 32 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-14 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER Figure 15 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Water Quantity Indication System - Introduction FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 33 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-14 WATER QUANTITY TRANSMITTER For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 34 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-14 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER Figure 16 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Water Quantity Transmitter and Adapter Cable FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 35 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-14 WATER QUANTITY INDICATOR For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 36 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-14 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER Figure 17 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Water Quantity Indicator FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 37 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-10 FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 38 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-10 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER Figure 18 25 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Water Quantity Indication - Functional Description FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 39 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-42 38-42 WATER TANK PRESSURIZATION SYSTEM - INTRODUCTION For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 40 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-42 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER Figure 19 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Water Tank Pressurization - Introduction FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 41 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-42 COMPONENT LOCATION For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 42 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-42 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER Figure 20 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Water Tank Pressurization - Component Location FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 43 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-42 AIR COMPRESSOR / INLET AIR FILTER For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 44 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-42 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER Figure 21 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Air Compressor and Inlet Air Filter FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 45 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-42 PRESSURE LIMIT SWITCH For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 46 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-42 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER Figure 22 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Pressure Limit Switch FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 47 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-42 AIR COMPRESSOR FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 48 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-42 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER Figure 23 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Air Compressor Functional Description FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 49 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-42 PRESSURE REGULATOR For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 50 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-42 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER Figure 24 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Pressure Regulator FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 51 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-42 CHECK VALVE For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 52 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-42 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER Figure 25 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Check Valve FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 53 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-42 IN-LINE AIR FILTER For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 54 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-42 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER Figure 26 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br In-Line Air Filter FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 55 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-42 PRESSURE RELIEF VALVE For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 56 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-42 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE POTABLE WATER Figure 27 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Pressure Relief Valve FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 57 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-30 38-30 WASTE DISPOSAL For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 58 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-30 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL Figure 28 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Introduction FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 59 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-31 38-31 GRAY WATER SYSTEM - DRAIN MAST For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 60 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-31 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL Figure 29 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Gray Water System - Drain Mast FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 61 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 38-32 VACUUM WASTE SYSTEM - INTRODUCTION For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 62 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL Figure 30 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Vacuum Waste System - Introduction FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 63 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 COMPONENTLOCATION - LAVATORY For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 64 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL Figure 31 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Vacuum Waste - Component Locations - Lavatory FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 65 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 COMPONENT LOCATION - AFT CARGO COMPARTMENT For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 66 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL Figure 32 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Vacuum Waste - Component Locations - Aft Cargo Compartment FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 67 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 WASTE SERVICE PANEL - COMPONENTS For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 68 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL Figure 33 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Vacuum Waste - Waste Service Panel Components FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 69 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 FLUSH SWITCH For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 70 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL Figure 34 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Vacuum Waste - Flush Switch FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 71 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 VACUUM TOILET ASSEMBLY For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 72 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL Figure 35 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Vacuum Waste - Vacuum Toilet Assembly FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 73 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 FLUSH CYCLE - OPERATION For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 74 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL Figure 36 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Vacuum Waste - Flush Cycle - Operation FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 75 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 VACUUM BLOWER AND FILTER For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 76 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL Figure 37 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Vacuum Waste - Vacuum Blower and Filter FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 77 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 VACUUM CHECK VALVE For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 78 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL Figure 38 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Vacuum Waste - Vacuum Check Valve FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 79 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 VACUUM BLOWER BAROMETRIC SWITCH For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 80 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL Figure 39 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Vacuum Waste - Vacuum Blower Barometric Switch FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 81 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 VACUUM BLOWER - FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 82 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL Figure 40 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Vacuum Waste - Vacuum Blower - Funktional Description FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 83 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 LIQUID SEPARATOR For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 84 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL Figure 41 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Vacuum Waste - Liquid Separator FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 85 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 WASTE TANK For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 86 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL Figure 42 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Vacuum Waste - Waste Tank FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 87 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 WASTE DRAIN BALL VALVE AND PULL ROD For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 88 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL Figure 43 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Vacuum Waste - Waste Drain Ball Valve and Pull Rod FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 89 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 WASTE DRAIN VALVE ASSEMBLY For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 90 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL Figure 44 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Vacuum Waste - Waste Drain Valve Assembly FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 91 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 WASTE TANK RINSE FITTING ASSEMBLY For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 92 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL Figure 45 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Vacuum Waste - Waste Tank Rinse Fitting Assembly FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 93 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 WASTE TANK RINSE FILTER For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 94 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL Figure 46 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Vacuum Waste - Waste Tank Rinse Filter FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 95 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 WASTE TANK RINSE NOZZLE For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 96 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL Figure 47 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Vacuum Waste - Waste Tank Rinse Nozzle FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 97 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 WASTE TANK DRAIN LINE BLOCKAGE REMOVAL VALVE For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 98 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL Figure 48 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Vacuum Waste - Waste Tank Drain Line Blockage Removal Valve FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 99 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-32 FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION - MECHANICAL For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 100 B737-600/700/800 38-32 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL Figure 49 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Vacuum Waste - Functional Description - Mechanical FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 101 B737-600/700/800 38-33 38-33 WASTE TANK QUANTITY INDICATION For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 102 B737-600/700/800 38-33 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL Figure 50 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Waste Tank Quantity Indication - Introduction FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 103 B737-600/700/800 38-33 WASTE TANK POINT LEVEL SENSOR For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 104 B737-600/700/800 38-33 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL Figure 51 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Waste Tank Quantity Indication - Waste Tank Point Level Sensor FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 105 B737-600/700/800 38-33 WASTE TANK CONTINUOUS LEVEL SENSOR For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 106 B737-600/700/800 38-33 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL Figure 52 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Waste Tank Quantity Indication - Waste Tank Continuous Level Sensor FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 107 B737-600/700/800 38-33 LOGIC CONTROL MODULE For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 108 B737-600/700/800 38-33 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL Figure 53 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Waste Tank Quantity Indication - Logic Control Module FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 109 B737-600/700/800 38-33 ATTENDANT PANEL WASTE QUANTITY INDICATOR For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 110 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-33 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL Figure 54 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Waste Tank Quantity Indication - Attendent’s Panel Waste Quantity Indicator FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 111 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-33 FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 112 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-33 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL Figure 55 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Waste Tank Quantity Indication - Functional Description FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 113 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-33 LOGIC CONTROL MODULE For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 114 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 38-33 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training WATER AND WASTE WASTE DISPOSAL Figure 56 19 Jul 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Waste Tank Quantity Indication - Logic Control Module - Training Information Point FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 115 AMET Ltd. Training Manual B 737-600/700/800/9000 ATA 34-60 FMC, ATA 22-23 SMYD ATA 27-24 WTRIS CONFIG. C2 22-23 Yaw Damper System 27-24 WTRIS (Wheel to Rudder Interconnect System) ATA 104 Level 2 Book No: Lufthansa Technical Training GmbH Lufthansa Base B737-6 34-60 C2 L2 E REFRESHER COURSE FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Issue: November 2001 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa 1995 AMET Ltd. For training purposes and internal use only. Copyright by Lufthansa Technical Training GmbH. All rights reserved. No parts of this training manual may be sold or reproduced in any form without permission of: Lufthansa Technical Training GmbH Lufthansa Base Frankfurt D-60546 Frankfurt/Main Tel. +49 69 / 696 41 78 Fax +49 69 / 696 63 84 Lufthansa Base Hamburg Weg beim Jäger 193 D-22335 Hamburg Tel. +49 40 / 5070 24 13 Fax +49 40 / 5070 47 46 REFRESHER COURSE FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Ltd. TABLE OF CONTENTS ATA 34-61 FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 ATA 22-23 YAW DAMPER SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 ATA 27-24 WHEEL TO RUDDER INTERCONNECT SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 34-61 FMC SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ABBREVIATIONS AND ACRONYMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS - GENERAL DESCRIPTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS — FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS — FLIGHT COMPARTMENT COMPONENT LOCATIONS . . . FMCS — ELECTRONIC EQUIPMENT COMPARTMENT LOCATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS - FMC AND CDU POWER INTERFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS - TRANSFER RELAY POWER INTERFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS - DIGITAL INPUT INTERFACE 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS - DIGITAL INPUT INTERFACE 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS - DIGITAL OUTPUT INTERFACE 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS - DIGITAL OUTPUT INTERFACE 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS - CDU INTERFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS - FMC DATA LOADER INTERFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS - ACARS INTERFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS - ANALOG DISCRETES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS - STATUS ANNUNCIATOR INTERFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS - PROGRAM PIN INTERFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS - CONTROL DISPLAY UNIT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS - CONTROL DISPLAY UNIT: CONTROLS AND DISPLAYS . . FMCS - LCD CDU: CONTROLS AND DISPLAYS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . REFRESHER COURSE 2 2 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 28 30 32 34 36 38 40 44 46 50 FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS - LCD CDU DATA LOAD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - CDU CONTROLS AND DISPLAYS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - AIRBORNE DATA LOADER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - TRANSFER RELAYS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - DISPLAYS: CDU, POWER UP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - DISPLAYS: CDU, IDENT PAGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - DISPLAYS: CDU, INIT/REF INDEX PAGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - DISPLAYS: CDU, POSITION PAGES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - DISPLAYS: CDU MESSAGES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - DISPLAYS: CDS FLIGHT MODE ANNUNCIATIONS . . . . . . . DISPLAYS - CDS - THRUST MODE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DISPLAYS - CDS - AIRSPEED INDICATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DISPLAYS - CDS - MAP DISPLAY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DISPLAYS - CDS - PLAN DISPLAY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DISPLAYS - CDS, NON-NORMAL DISPLAYS . . . . . . . . . . . . - DATA LOADER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - DATABASE LOAD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - CROSSLOAD PAGES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - DATABASE CROSSLOAD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - BITE PAGES: INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - BITE PAGES: BITE ENTRY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - BITE PAGES: AUTOMATIC BITE ENTRY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - BITE PAGES: INFLIGHT FAULTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - BITE PAGES: CDU TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - BITE PAGES: SENSORS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - BITE PAGES: DISCRETES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - BITE PAGES: FMCS FIXED OUTPUTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - BITE PAGES: IRS MONITOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - BITE PAGES: PERFORMANCE FACTORS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - BITE PAGES: SOFTWARE OPTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - BITE PAGES: AIRPL. MODEL, ENGINE CONFIG. . . . . . . . . - LCD BITE PAGES: INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - LCDU BITE PAGES: FAULTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - LCDU BITE PAGES: KEY TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - LCDU BITE PAGES: COLOR TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 56 58 62 64 66 70 72 74 76 80 82 84 86 88 90 92 94 96 98 100 102 104 106 108 110 112 114 116 118 120 122 124 126 128 130 Page i AMET Ltd. TABLE OF CONTENTS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS FMCS - LCDU BITE PAGES: - LCDU BITE PAGES: - LCDU BITE PAGES: - LCDU BITE PAGES: - LCDU BITE PAGES: - LCDU BITE PAGES: - LCDU BITE PAGES: - LCDU BITE PAGES: DISPLAY TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CONFIG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SW OPTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . POWER SUPPLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TEMP SENSORS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LIGHT SENSORS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LAMP TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CALIBRATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132 134 136 138 140 142 144 146 22-23 YAW DAMPER SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ABBREVIATIONS AND ACRONYMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . YAW DAMPER SYSTEM (YDS) - INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . YDS - GENERAL DESCRIPTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . YDS - COCKPIT COMPONENT LOCATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . YDS - E+E COMPARTMENT COMP. LOCATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . YDS - VERTICAL STABILIZER COMP. LOCATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SMYD 1 - YDS: INTERFACES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SYMD 2: YD - INTERFACES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . YDS - OPERATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . YDS - OPERATIONS: ENGAGE INTERLOCKS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . YDS - SMYD BITE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . YDS - SMYD BITE: EXISTING FAULTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . YDS - SMYD BITE: FAULT HISTORY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . YDS - SMYD BITE: GROUND TESTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . YDS - SMYD BITE: SERVO TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . YDS - SMYD BITE: OTHER FUNCTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 150 150 152 154 156 158 160 162 164 166 168 170 172 174 176 178 27-24 WHEEL TO RUDDER INTERCONNECT SYSTEM . . . . . . . ABBREVIATIONS AND ACRONYMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . WTRIS - INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . WTRIS - GENERAL DESCRIPTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . WTRIS - COMPONENT LOCATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SMYD 2 WTRIS - INTERFACES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SYMD 2 - WTRIS: OPERATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SMYD 2 - WTRIS OPERATIONS: ENGAGE INTERLOCKS . . . . . . . SMYD 2 - WTRIS: FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180 180 180 182 184 188 190 192 194 REFRESHER COURSE SMYD 2 - WTRIS: BITE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . WTRIS - SMYD BITE: GROUND TESTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . WTRIS - SMYD BITE: SERVO TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 196 198 200 Page ii AMET Ltd. TABLE OF FIGURES Figure 1 Figure 2 Figure 3 Figure 4 Figure 5 Figure 6 Figure 7 Figure 8 Figure 9 Figure 10 Figure 11 Figure 12 Figure 13 Figure 14 Figure 15 Figure 16 Figure 17 Figure 18 Figure 19 Figure 20 Figure 21 Figure 22 Figure 23 Figure 24 Figure 25 Figure 26 Figure 27 Figure 28 Figure 29 Figure 30 Figure 31 Figure 32 Figure 33 Figure 34 Figure 35 FMCS INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS GENERAL DESCRIPTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS COMPONENT: COMPUTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS COMPONENT LOCATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS COMPONENT LOCATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMC and CDU POWER INTERFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMC TRANSFER RELAY POWER INTERFACE . . . . . . FMC DIGITAL INPUT INTERFACE - 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMC DIGITAL INPUT INTERFACE - 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMC DIGITAL OUTPUTS INTERFACE - 1 . . . . . . . . . . FMC DIGITAL OUTPUTS INTERFACE - 1 . . . . . . . . . . FMC DIGITAL OUTPUTS INTERFACE - 2 . . . . . . . . . . FMC CDU INTERFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMC DATA LOADER INTERFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMC ACARS INTERFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMC ANALOG DISCRETES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMC STATUS ANN. INTERFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMC PROGRAM PINS INTERFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS - SYSTEM SUMMARY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS - CONTROL DISPLAY UNIT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS - CONTROL DISPLAY UNIT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS - CONTROL DISPLAY UNIT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS - CONTROL DISPLAY UNIT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS - CONTROL DISPLAY UNIT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMS LCD CDU-DATA LOAD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMC CDU CONTROLS AND DISPLAYS . . . . . . . . . . . . FMC CDU CONTROLS AND DISPLAYS . . . . . . . . . . . . FMC AIRBORNE DATA LOADER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMC XFR RELAYS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMS POWER UP, NORMAL DISLPLAY . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMS POWER UP, NON-NORMAL DISPLAY . . . . . . . . FMC IDENT PAGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMC INIT/REF PAGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMC POSITION PAGES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMC CDU MESSAGES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . REFRESHER COURSE 7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23 25 27 29 31 33 35 37 39 41 43 45 49 51 53 55 57 59 61 63 65 67 69 71 73 75 79 Figure 36 Figure 37 Figure 38 Figure 39 Figure 40 Figure 41 Figure 42 Figure 43 Figure 44 Figure 45 Figure 46 Figure 47 Figure 48 Figure 49 Figure 50 Figure 51 Figure 52 Figure 53 Figure 54 Figure 55 Figure 56 Figure 57 Figure 58 Figure 59 Figure 60 Figure 61 Figure 62 Figure 63 Figure 64 Figure 65 Figure 66 Figure 67 Figure 68 Figure 69 Figure 70 FMC FLIGHT MODE ANN. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMC THRUST MODE ANN. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMC MACH AIRSPEED INDICATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMC MAP DISPLAY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMC PLAN DISPLAY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMC NON-NORMAL DISPLAYS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMS DATA LOADER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMS DATA BASE LOADING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMS CROSSLOAD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMS CROSS LOADING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMS BITE INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMS BITE ENTRY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMS BITE ENTRY AUTOMATIC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMS INFLIGHT FAULTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMS BITE PAGES CDU TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMS BITE PAGES, SENSORS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMS BITE PAGES, DISCRETES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMS BITE PAGES, FIXED OUTPUTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMS BITE PAGES, IRS MONITOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMS BITE PAGES, PERFORMANCE FACTORS . . . . FMS BITE PAGES, SOFTWARE OPTIONS . . . . . . . . . FMS BITE PAGES, AC-CONFIG. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS BITE PAGES - LCD CDU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS BITE PAGES - LCD CDU FAULTS . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS BITE PAGES - LCD CDU KEY TEST . . . . . . . . . FMCS BITE PAGES - LCD CDU COLOR TEST . . . . . . FMCS BITE PAGES - LCD CDU DISPLAY TEST . . . . . FMCS BITE PAGES - LCD CDU CONFIG . . . . . . . . . . . FMCS BITE PAGES - LCD CDU SW OPTIONS . . . . . . FMCS BITE PAGES - LCD CDU PWR SUPPLY . . . . . . FMCS BITE PAGES - LCD CDU TEMP SENSORS . . . FMCS BITE PAGES - LCD CDU LIGHT SENSORS . . FMCS BITE PAGES - LCD CDU LAMP TEST . . . . . . . FMCS BITE PAGES - LCD CDU CALIBRATION . . . . . FMCS - SYSTEM SUMMARY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 81 83 85 87 89 91 93 95 97 99 101 103 105 107 109 111 113 115 117 119 121 123 125 127 129 131 133 135 137 139 141 143 145 147 149 Page iii AMET Ltd. TABLE OF FIGURES Figure 71 Figure 72 Figure 73 Figure 74 Figure 75 Figure 76 Figure 77 Figure 78 Figure 79 Figure 80 Figure 81 Figure 82 Figure 83 Figure 84 Figure 85 Figure 86 Figure 87 Figure 88 Figure 89 Figure 90 Figure 91 Figure 92 Figure 93 Figure 94 Figure 95 Figure 96 YAW DAMPER (YD) INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . YD GENERAL DESCRIPTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . YD COMPONENT LOCATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . YD COMPONENT LOCATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . YD COMPONENT LOCATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . YD INTERFACES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SMYD 2 - YD INTERFACES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . YD OPERATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . YD ENGAGE INTERLOCK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SMYD - BITE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . YDS BITE, EXISTING FAULTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . YDS BITE, FAULT HISTORY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . YDS BITE, GROUND TESTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . YDS BITE, SERVO TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . YDS BITE, OTHER FUNCTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . WTRIS INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . WTRIS - GENERAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . WTRIS - COMPONENT LOCATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . WTRIS COMPONENT LOCATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SMYD 2 - WTRIS INTERFACES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SMYD 2 - YD/WTRIS OPS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SMYD 2 - WTRIS ENGAGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SMYD 2 - FUNCTIONAL DESCR. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SMYD - BITE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SMYD WTRIS BITE GROUND TESTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . SMYD WTRIS SERVO TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . REFRESHER COURSE 151 153 155 157 159 161 163 165 167 169 171 173 175 177 179 181 183 185 187 189 191 193 195 197 199 201 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page iv AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 ATA 34-61 FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM ATA 22-23 YAW DAMPER SYSTEM ATA 27-24 WHEEL TO RUDDER INTERCONNECT SYSTEM For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION AUTOFLIGHT Aug 1999 REFRESHER COURSE FRA USE NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 1 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training For Training Purposes Only NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMCS) 34-61 B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMC SYSTEM ABBREVIATIONS AND ACRONYMS act AC ADIRU ADIRS ADL alt appr APU ARINC arr A/T ATA BITE brg C calc CAS CAPT CDS CDU clb clr CO CON cmd chng comp crs crz — active — alternating current — air data inertial reference unit — air data inertial reference system — airborne data loader — altitude — approach — auxiliary power unit — aeronautical radio incorporated — arrival — autothrottle — actual time of arrival — built in test equipment — bearing — celsius — calculate — computed airspeed — captain — common display system — control display unit — climb — clear — company — continuous — command — change — complete — course — cruise Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM ctr DC del dep des dest DEU dev DFCS DIR dist dspl DTG DME E E/O econ ECU E/D EEC ELEX eng EPR ETA EXEC F FF FL FDAU — center — direct current — delete — departure — descent — destination — display electronic unit — deviation — digital flight control system — direct — distance — display — distance to go — distance measuring equipment — east — engine out — economy — engine control unit — end of descent — electronic engine control — electronics — engine — engine pressure ratio — estimated time of arrival — execute — fahrenheit — fuel flow — flight level — flight data acquisition unit FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 2 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training For Training Purposes Only NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMCS) lim LNAV long FMC FMCS F/O flt FMA FMCS FPA FQIS FQPU fwd G G/A GMT GPWC GRWT GS HF hdg hrdw ident IFSAU ILS inbd info INIT/REF INTC ISA KTS L 34-61 — limit — lateral navigation — longitude — flight management computer — flight management computer system — first officer — flight — flight mode annunciation — flight management computer system — flight path angle — fuel quantity indicating system — fuel quantity processor unit — forward — ground — go around — greenwich mean time — ground proximity warning computer — gross weight — ground speed — high frequency — heading — hardware — identification — integrated flight system accessory unit — instrument landing system — inboard — information — initialization/reference — intercept — international standard atmosphere — nautical miles per hour (knots) — left Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM B737-600/700/800 lat LED LVL CHG MASI max MCDU MCP MMR mod msg M N nav NAV RAD NDB NM OAT OFP OFST OP PDB PDL perf pln pos PPOS pred preflt proc prof PROG PSEU — latitude — light emitting diode — level change — mach airspeed indicator — maximum — multi—purpose control display unit — mode control panel — multi mode receiver — modification — message — meters — north — navigation — navigation radio — navigation database —nautical miles —outside air temperature —operational flight program — offset — operational program — performance data base — portable data loader — performance — plan — position — present position — predicted — preflight — procedure — profile — progress — proximity switch electronics unit FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 3 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training For Training Purposes Only NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMCS) PTH QFE QNH QUAD qty R rad RDY REC ref RTA rte R/W rwy s S/C SAT sel SID SMYD SPD STAR Sw TACAN TAS TAT T/C T/D tgt thr thr ref TO/GA 34-61 — path — altimeter setting to indicate altitude above reference airfield — altimeter setting to indicate altitude above mean sea level — quadrant — quantity — right — radio — ready — recorder — reference — required time of arrival — route — read/write — runway — south —step climb — static air temperature — selector — standard instrument departure — stall management yaw damper — speed — standard terminal arrival route — software — tactical air navigation — true airspeed — total air temperature — top of climb — top of descent — target — thrust — thrust reference — takeoff/go—around Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM B737-600/700/800 trans trk UTC V1 V2 v V VNAV VR VREF V/S VTK w wpt wt XFR XTK z ZFW — transition — track — universal time (coordinated) — takeoff decision speed — climbout speed — volt — volt — vertical navigation — rotation speed — reference speed — vertical speed — vertical track — west — waypoint — weight — transfer — cross track — zulu — zero fuel weight FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 4 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMCS) Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 5 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMCS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) - INTRODUCTION General The flight crew uses the flight management computer system (FMCS) to enter route and vertical performance flight plan data for a flight. With the flight plan and inputs from the airplane sensors, the FMCS does these functions: S Navigation S Performance S Guidance. For Training Purposes Only Navigation A navigation data base is in the FMC memory. It includes the navigation data for the area of operation. The pilot can use the navigation data base to set the entire flight plan before a flight. The FMC calculates the airplane position during the flight. To do the calculation, it uses the inertial reference function and the radio navigation aids, if available. The FMC compares the calculated position with the set position. If there is a difference, it shows on the common display system. Guidance The FMC sends commands to the digital flight control system (DFCS) and the autothrottle (A/T). The DFCS and the A/T use these signals to control the airplane in the lateral (LNAV) and vertical (VNAV) modes of flight. Built In Test equipment You use the FMCS CDU to select and control BITE for these systems: S FMCS S Fuel quantity indication system (FQIS) S Digital flight control system (DFCS) S Autothrottle (A/T) S Common display system (CDS) S APU engine control unit (ECU) S Electronic engine controller (EEC) S Air data inertial reference unit (ADIRU). Performance A performance data base in the FMC contains data to model the airplane and the engines. The flight crew puts this data in the FMC: S Airplane gross weight S Cruise altitude S Cost index. The FMC uses the data to calculate these functions: S Economy speeds S Best flight altitude S Top of descent point The common display system (CDS) shows target speeds and altitudes. Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 6 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMCS) For Training Purposes Only CONTROL DISPLAY UNIT B737-600/700/800 34-61 FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER NAVIGATION DISPLAY Figure 1 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMCS INTRODUCTION FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 7 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMCS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - GENERAL DESCRIPTION General The main component of the flight management computer system (FMCS) is the FMC. The FMC receives the data and does the navigation and performance calculations. The flight crew uses the CDUs (also called MCDUs) to put data into the FMC. The FMC input and output data format is ARINC 429 digital data and analog discretes. Some FMC data goes directly to the user systems. Other output data goes to the user systems through the transfer relays. For Training Purposes Only NOTE: Some Airlines have only one FMC installed: But normally all provisions for a second set of Flight Management Computer System are installed. This includes also the FMCS transfer relay. The FMC transfer switch is not installed. Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 8 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training For Training Purposes Only NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMCS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 – GPS – DME – ILS – VOR RADIO NAVIGATION SYSTEMS Figure 2 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMCS GENERAL DESCRIPTION FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 9 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMCS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS — FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER Purpose The FMC uses data from sensors and data stored in the FMC to do the calculations for the FMCS. Physical Description The FMC is a rack—mounted chassis assembly in an ARINC 600, 4 MCU box. It weighs less than 22 pounds (10 kilograms). The FMCs are cooled with air from the equipment cooling supply and exhaust systems. Cooling air for FMC 1 is blow—thru. Cooling air for FMC 2 is draw— thru. Two light emitting diodes (LED) show through openings in the front of the unit. The PWR ON LED comes on when the FMC has power. The FMC VALID LED comes on after power is on and the unit passes internal tests. FAILURE TO OBSERVE ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE PRECAUTIONARY PROCEDURES WHEN TOUCHING, REMOVING, OR INSERTING PARTS OF ASSEMBLIES, MAY RESULT IN DEGRADATION OR FAILURE OF THE FMC. For Training Purposes Only CAUTION: Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 10 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training For Training Purposes Only NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMCS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMC Figure 3 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMCS COMPONENT: COMPUTER FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 11 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMCS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS — FLIGHT COMPARTMENT COMPONENT LOCATIONS FMCS Component Locations — P9 Forward Electronics Panel These are the FMCS components on the P9 forward electronics panel: S CDU 1 S CDU 2. FMCS Component Location — P5 FWD Overhead Panel The FMC source select switch is on the P5—28 forward overhead panel. For Training Purposes Only FMCS Component Locations — P61 Panel These are the FMCS components on the P61 panel: S Airborne data loader S Data loader control panel. Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 12 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMCS) Figure 4 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMCS COMPONENT LOCATIONS FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 13 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS — ELECTRONIC EQUIPMENT COMPARTMENT LOCATIONS FMCS— Component Location — Electronic Equipment Shelf The FMCS components on the electronic equipment shelf E5—2 are: S FMC 1 S FMC 2 S FMCS transfer relay 1 S FMCS transfer relay 2. For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMCS) Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 14 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMCS) Figure 5 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMCS COMPONENT LOCATIONS FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 15 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - FMC AND CDU POWER INTERFACE General The FMC and CDU primary power is 115v ac from electronics buses 1 and 2. For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 16 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) Figure 6 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMC and CDU POWER INTERFACE FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 17 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training For Training Purposes Only NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - TRANSFER RELAY POWER INTERFACE General The transfer relays are Ledex type relays. They mechanically latch to the position you select. The FMCS source select switch controls the FMCS transfer relays. These are the switch positions: S NORMAL S BOTH ON L (both on left FMC) S BOTH ON R (both on right FMC). Operation The transfer relay power is 28v dc from electronics bus 2. The FMC source select switch controls the dc power to the transfer relays. With the FMC source select switch in the NORMAL position, both transfer relays go to the normal position and mechanically latch in that position. With the FMC source select switch set to the BOTH ON R position, 28v dc goes from a contact on transfer relay 2 to the relay 1 coil winding. Relay 1 transfers to the both on right position and mechanically latches to that position. With the FMC source select switch set to the BOTH ON L position, 28v dc goes from a contact on transfer relay 1 to the relay 2 coil winding. Relay 2 transfers to the both on left position and mechanically latches to that position. Contacts on the transfer relays tell these LRUs the position of the transfer relays: S DEU (1&2) S FDAU S FMC (1&2). Training Information Point You use the FMCS BITE on the ANALOG DISCRETES page 3/4 to do a check of the FMC source selection. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 18 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) Figure 7 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMC TRANSFER RELAY POWER INTERFACE FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 19 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - DIGITAL INPUT INTERFACE 1 General These LRUs supply data to the FMCS: S VOR/MB S DME S MMR S Electronic clock. VOR/MB The left and right VOR receivers supply the bearing and the frequency of the VOR stations that are manual tuned. ILS/MMR The localizer deviation and the station frequency come from multi—mode receivers 1 and 2. DME The Slant range distance and the station frequency come from the left and right DME transceivers. For Training Purposes Only Electronic Clock The captain’s electronic clock supplies GMT to FMC 1. The first officers electronic clock supplies GMT to FMC 2. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 20 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) Figure 8 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMC DIGITAL INPUT INTERFACE - 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 21 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - DIGITAL INPUT INTERFACE 2 General These components send data to the FMCS: S ADIRU S DEU S APU engine control unit (ECU) S Engine electronic control (EEC) S A/T S DFCS MCP S FQPU. ADIRU The ADIRUs send this data to the FMCS: S Present position S Heading S Attitude S Ground speed S Vertical speed S Airspeed S Altitude S Mach S Temperature S ADIRU BITE words. DFCS The DFCS sends data to the mode control panel (MCP) The MCP sends it to the FMCS. The MCP sends this data: S LNAV and VNAV mode status S Trailing edge flap position S DFCS BITE words. A/T The autothrottle computer sends A/T BITE words. For Training Purposes Only FQPU The fuel quantity processor unit (FQPU) calculates total fuel weight and sends it to the FMCS. Fuel quantity BITE words also come from the FQPU. ADIRU Selection The FMC sees the inertial data and the air data as two different sensors. In normal operation, the FMCs receive inertial data from their on—side ADIRU (ADIRU L — FMC 1/ADIRU R — FMC 2). If the on—side ADIRU malfunctions or it is in the FMCS — DIGITAL INPUT INTERFACE — 2 ATT or ALIGN mode, the FMC automatically switches to its off—side ADIRU. The FMCs use the same air data source as the DFCS. CDS/APU/EEC The display electronic units (DEU) send EFIS control panel discretes and CDS BITE data to the FMCS. The DEUs, also send APU, ECU and engine EEC BITE data on the same bus. There is no direct BITE interface between the FMCS and the APU and EEC. The DEUs are a buffer between the APU, EEC and the FMCS. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 22 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) Figure 9 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMC DIGITAL INPUT INTERFACE - 2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 23 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - DIGITAL OUTPUT INTERFACE 1 General The FMC data on bus 01 and 02, goes directly to the ADIRUs. The other user systems get this FMC data through the transfer relays. ADIRU The FMCs send CDU latitude and longitude data to the ADIRUs to start alignment. The FMcs also send the CDU magnetic heading and a BITE test word. The ADIRUs use the magnetic heading when in the attitude mode. For Training Purposes Only A/T The FMC you select sends this data to the autothrottle: S N1 thrust limits S N1 targets S FMCS gross weight S Temperature S BITE test word. FCC The FMC sends this data to the FCCs: S Target airspeed S MACH S Target altitude S Target vertical speed S Roll command S FMC discretes (FMC mode logic) S BITE test word. DEU The FMC you select sends this data to the DEUs: S Thrust mode annunciation S Ground speed S N1 reference display S BITE test words S Flight mode annunciation S Gross weight (CDS calculates flap manuevering speeds that show on the MASI). The BITE test words are for the DEUs and these systems: S Engines (EEC) S APU (ECU). There is no direct BITE interface between the FMC 1 and the EEC and ECU. The DEUs are a buffer between the EECand ECU and the FMC. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 24 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training For Training Purposes Only NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMC 2 Figure 10 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMC DIGITAL OUTPUTS INTERFACE - 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 25 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - DIGITAL OUTPUT INTERFACE 1 (cont‘d) You select the source of FMC data with the FMC source select switch. FMC SOURCE SELECT SWITCH POSITION FCC A FCC B NORMAL FMC 1 FMC 2 BOTH ON LEFT FMC 1 FMC 1 BOTH ON RIGHT FMC 2 FMC 2 Fuel Quantity Processor Unit The selected FMC sends a BITE test word to the processor unit. FDAU The FMCS sends navigation data to the FDAU. SMYD The FMCS sends gross weight data to the stall management function in the SMYDs. You select the source of FMC data with the FMC source select switch. FMC SOURCE SELECT SWITCH POSITION SMYD 1 SMYD 2 NORMAL FMC 1 FMC 2 BOTH ON LEFT FMC 1 FMC 1 BOTH ON RIGHT FMC 2 FMC 2 For Training Purposes Only DME The FMCs send autotuned navigation frequencies to the NAV control panels and DMEs. In normal operation, the FMCs autotune the DME interrogators through the NAV control panels. If a NAV control panel fails, its on—side DME interrogator is autotuned directly from the FMC you select. You select the source of FMC data with the FMC source select switch. FMC SOURCE SELECT SWITCH POSITION DME LEFT DME RIGHT AND CAPT AND F/O NAV/DME CP NAV/DME CP NORMAL FMC 1 FMC 2 BOTH ON LEFT FMC 1 FMC 1 BOTH ON RIGHT FMC 2 FMC 2 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 26 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training For Training Purposes Only NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMC 2 Figure 11 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMC DIGITAL OUTPUTS INTERFACE - 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 27 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - DIGITAL OUTPUT INTERFACE 2 General The FMC data on bus 08 and 09, goes directly to the DEUs. The other user systems get this FMC data through the transfer relays. The DEUs get EFIS display data directly from both FMCs. The DEUs use contacts on the FMCS transfer relays to know the position of the transfer relays. The DEUs use the position information to know which FMC to use for data. See FMCS Transfer Relay Power Interface in this section, for more information. You select the source of FMC data with the FMC source select switch. FMC SOURCE SELECT SWITCH POSITION DEU 1 DEU 2 NORMAL FMC 1 FMC 2 BOTH ON LEFT FMC 1 FMC 1 BOTH ON RIGHT FMC 2 FMC 2 GPWC The selected FMC sends track and path angle plus wind direction. For Training Purposes Only FDAU The selected FMC sends present position (latitude and longitude) plus wind speed and direction. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 28 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) Figure 12 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMC DIGITAL OUTPUTS INTERFACE - 2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 29 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - CDU INTERFACE FMC Digital Output With the FMC source select switch set to the BOTH ON L or the NORMAL position, CDU 1 and CDU 2 get data from FMC 1. With the source select switch set to the BOTH ON R position, both CDUs get data from FMC 2. For Training Purposes Only FMC Digital Input CDU 1 and CDU 2 send data directly to both FMCs. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 30 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) Figure 13 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMC CDU INTERFACE FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 31 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - FMC DATA LOADER INTERFACE General The airborne data loader (ADL) connects to the FMCs through the data loader control panel. The data loader gets 115v ac power from the P18 circuit breaker panel. It goes through the data loader control panel. The data loader digital input and output connects to FMC 1 and FMC 2 through the data loader control panel. The control panel must be set to the FMC position to transfer data to the FMCs. With the FMC source select switch set to the BOTH ON L or NORMAL position, the data comes from FMC 1. With the source select switch set to the BOTH ON R position, the data comes from FMC 2. For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 32 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) Figure 14 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMC DATA LOADER INTERFACE FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 33 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - ACARS INTERFACE General ACARS data for FMC 1 and FMC 2 goes through FMCS Transfer Relay 1. ACARS data for the CDUs is direct. For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 34 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) Figure 15 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMC ACARS INTERFACE FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 35 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - ANALOG DISCRETES General Inputs from switches and valves give engine bleed air data to the FMCS. The FMCS uses these signals to calculate the performance values. The program pin selectable options customize the FMCS to your airline’ s configuration. For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 36 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) Figure 16 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMC ANALOG DISCRETES FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 37 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - STATUS ANNUNCIATOR INTERFACE General The autoflight status annunciators (ASA), have three warning lights. The warning lights are push to reset. The ASA also has a test switch. The ASAs show a change of condition for these systems: S Autopilot S Autothrottte S Flight management computer system (FMCS). For Training Purposes Only FMCS The FMC warning light is amber when an FMC has an alert message or when an FMC fails. The light comes also on when you put the TEST switch in position 1 or 2. You push the FMC warning light to reset the latch and turn the light off. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 38 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) Figure 17 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMC STATUS ANN. INTERFACE FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 39 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - PROGRAM PIN INTERFACE General These program pins customize the FMCS to your airline’s configuration. There are several FMCS options available. A dip switch assembly sets the options. These are your airplane options: S Airplane model 737-700 S Thrust rating 22,000 S Performance code 1 S ACARS installed S Selected course radial inhibit on EFIS S Degrees C default S Flight number entry S Runway position update on TO/GA S Weight in kilograms S JAA flight rules For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 40 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) Figure 18 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMC PROGRAM PINS INTERFACE FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 41 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 THE FOLLOWING PAGE IS FOR REFERENCE ONLY! For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 42 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 115V AC BUS 1 BUS 2 BUS 4 BUS 5 BUS 6 BUS 7 BUS 8 115V AC VOR 2 DME 1 VOR/MB ILS 2 DME 1 2 4 5 6 7 8 BUS 1 28V DC UPLINK XFER RLY DISCRETE CLOCK 1 BUS 4 C BUS 7 BUS 8 B DEU 2 FCC A BUS 6 BUS 2 BUS 5 BUS 6 GPS 1/2 MMR A/T COMP BUS 2 GPWC DEU 1 FDAU A ADR 4 XFR RLY 1 CLOCK SMYD 1 FMC 1/2 IR 3 ADIRU HGS (OPTION) FAIL WARN DME 1 115V AC DEU-FMC CDU 1 FAIL WARN A/T COMP ELT (OPTION) 115V AC A/T 1 DEU CAP NAV C/P B MCP 3 FQPU CDU 1 DFCS MCP ACARS MU FQPU 5 FQPU DIU (OPTION) BUS 1 CDU 2 DLDR 1 XFER RLY DISCRETE LOAD ENABLE C DATA LOADER CONTROL PANEL For Training Purposes Only ENG 2 BLEED AIR SWITCH ENGINE 2 ANTICE SW RIGHT PACK VALVE RIGHT PACK A/C RELAY FCC B FDAU BUS 2 1 BUS 1 2 BUS 2 ENG 1 BLEED AIR SWITCH ON/OFF ENGINE 1 ANTICE SW ON/OFF LEFT PACK VALVE OPEN/CLOSE LEFT PACK A/C RELAY WING ANTICE A/C ISOL VALVE ON/OFF SMYD 2 28V DC ON/OFF DME 2 OPEN/CLOSE OFF/HIGH/ CDU 1 OR AUTO PORTABLE OFF/HIGH/ AUTO BUS 9 ON/OFF FMC MESSAGE FMC FAIL OPEN/CLOSE IFSAU INTERSYSTEM BUS XFR RLY 2 PROG SW MOD PROG SW MOD FMC 2 FMC 1 Figure 19 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM RESET F/O NAV C/P DEU 2 FMC MESSAGE FMC FAIL FMC FAIL FMC MESSAGE FMC CONFIG OPTIONS A PORTABLE CDU DEU 1 28V DC OPTIONS BITE PRINTER RECEPTACLE FMC WARN RESET CAPT ASA 28V DC FMC WARN RESET F/O ASA FMCS - SYSTEM SUMMARY FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 43 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training For Training Purposes Only NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - CONTROL DISPLAY UNIT Purpose The flight crew uses the control display unit (CDU, also called the MCDU) to put in flight data and to select displays and modes of operation. They also use the CDU to start ADIRU alignment. You use the CDU to test the FMCS and other systems. There are two CDUs in the airplane. They are functionally and physically interchangeable. Physical Description There are holes in the chassis for cooling air. The equipment cooling supply and exhaust systems supply the cooling air to the CDUs. Keep dust and dirt build—up from the CDU vent and surfaces. The procedures to clean the CDU are in the maintenance practices section for the CDU. The CDU has these annunciators: S Fail S CALL S MSG (Message) S OFST (Offset) S EXEC (Execute). The annunciators each use a two lamp circuit board assembly. Each board assembly is line replaceable. The EXEC light is on the right of the CDU. The EXEC light is a lamp assembly with two lamps. The lamp assembly is line replaceable. The lighted switch panel is line replaceable. Six screws hold the panel in place. The remove and replace procedures for the annunciators and the lighted switch panel are in part two of the maintenance manual. CAUTION: Training Information Point If you remove CDU number 2, install the ground lock assemblies on the landing gear. Put the control lever for the landing gear in the OFF position. CAUTION: MAKE SURE THAT YOU INSTALL THE GROUND LOCK ASSEMBLIES ON THE LANDING GEAR BEFORE YOU MOVE THE CONTROL LEVER FOR THE LANDING GEAR. YOU WILL DAMAGE THE AIRPLANE IF YOU RETRACT THE LANDING GEAR WHILE THE AIRPLANE IS ON THE GROUND. FAILURE TO OBSERVE ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE PRECAUTIONARY PROCEDURES WHEN TOUCHING, REMOVING, OR INSERTING PARTS OR ASSEMBLIES MAY RESULT IN DEGRADATION OR FAILURE OF THE CONTROL DISPLAY UNIT. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 44 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) Figure 20 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMCS - CONTROL DISPLAY UNIT FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 45 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - CONTROL DISPLAY UNIT: CONTROLS AND DISPLAYS Data shows in these colors: Black - background White - default color for text Magenta - active waypoint, active speed target and active altitude target in Flight plan Green - actively tuned VOR, ILS and DME data (frequency, station ID and course). Also, green will be used for data fields that can be toggled on and off in which case the active state is green Amber - FMC mismatch indications on maintenance BITE pages Cyan - Inactive route page titles Shaded white - data that modifies the flight plan until the EXEC key is pushed. Display Layout The first line shows these data blocks: Status Title Page number. Status shows that the information on the display is the active executed plan (ACT) or a modified plan (MOD). When the data on the display is not active or not a part of the flight plan, the status block is blank. The next block is the title for the display. An example of a title is POS INIT. The last character spaces in the first line show the page number for each display. This tells the operator the active page and the total number of pages. Data on lines two through thirteen (data field) applies to operation of the airplane. Line fourteen is a scratch pad to enter data from the keyboard. Also, this line shows this data: Failure messages Alerts during operation Advisory prompts. Alphanumeric Key Board You use the key board to enter data into the FMCS and to make changes to a flight plan. Each time you push an alphanumeric key, the entry shows in the scratch pad (line 14). In the scratch pad, you can edit the entry or clear it. The MCDU shows this data in white: Text Scratchpad messages Header line titles Box prompts Dashes, except when the dash is an integral part of the data field (i.e. negative temperature) in which case it will be the same color as the data Slashes, except when the slash has data on both sides in which case it will be the same color as the data. Function and Mode Keys These are the function and mode keys: S INIT REF S RTE S CLB S CRZ S DES S MENU S LEGS Display Format The multi-purpose control display unit (MCDU) data shows on the five-inch liquid crystal display (LCD). The basic display is a set of fourteen lines. Each line can show 24 characters. Each line can show alphanumeric characters and symbols. For Training Purposes Only Color The MCDU contains a liquid crystal display (LCD). It shows white text on a black background. The FANS MCDU contains a liquid crystal display (LCD). It shows white text on a black background. The LCD uses different colors to show flight activity and modes. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 46 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training For Training Purposes Only NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) S S S S S S B737-600/700/800 34-61 DEP ARR HOLD PROG N1 LIMIT FIX EXEC. These are the function and mode keys: - INIT REF - RTE - DEP ARR - ATC - VNAV - FIX - LEGS - HOLD - FMC COMM - PROG - MENU - N1 LIMIT - EXEC. The INIT REF key supplies access to a selection of data pages necessary to start the FMCS and ADIRU. Also, the operator can access navigation data and maintenance pages. The RTE key selects the page you use to enter route data. This includes the flight origin and destination plus the takeoff runway number. The CLB key shows the climb modes. Top-of-climb (T/C) altitude and speed/ altitude restrictions show here. Information about time and distance to the next waypoint is also shown here. The CRZ key shows the cruise modes. Information about optimum altitude, maximum altitude, step climb savings and turbulence N1 targets also show. The DES key shows the descent modes. The end-of-descent altitude and speed/altitude restrictions show here. Information about flight path angle, airplane vertical speed and vertical bearing also show. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM The MENU key gives access to other airplane data communication systems. The LEGS key shows and accepts input of data about each leg of the flight plan. Information about heading between the waypoints, speed and altitude is also shown. The DEP/ARR key supplies access to a selection of departure and arrival runways and procedures for the origin and destination airports. The HOLD key lets you plan or start a hold at a waypoint or present position. The PROG key shows this current flight status information. The N1 LIMIT key shows the FMC calculated N1 thrust limits for specific flight phases. This page also shows the reduced climb thrust limits CLB-1 (Climb 1)and CLB-2 (Climb 2). The flight crew can set N1 limit data from this page. The FIX key shows range and bearing data from the present position to a selected reference position (SRP). The ATC key is not active at this time and selecting this key will result in the display of the KEY/FUNCTION INOP message in the scratchpad. The VNAV key shows the climb, cruise, and descent performance pages. When the VNAV key is pushed in flight, the page shown will be the active flight phase. On the ground, the CLB page shows. The other flight phase pages may be shown with the PREV PAGE and NEXT PAGE keys. The FMC COMM key shows FMC communications page. This page has the airline operational communications (AOC) datalink functions. The EXEC key is used to make active or to modify a page with data entry when the EXEC light comes on. Page Select Keys You push the NEXT PAGE key to advance the display to the next higher number page. You push the PREV PAGE key to back-up the display to the next lower number page. The page strings are continuous. If the first page of a string is shown (1/9) and you push the PREV PAGE key, the display shows the last page in the string (9/9). If you go past the last page in a string (past 9/9 for example), this takes the display back to the first page in the string (1/9). Line Select Keys You use the line select keys for these operations: Move data from the scratch pad to a data field FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 47 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training For Training Purposes Only NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 Copy data from a data field to the scratch pad Remove data from a data field Select a BITE operation from the maintenance bite index. Lighted Annunciators These are the active annunciators: - CALL - MSG (Message) - OFST (Offset). The CALL light is on when there is a call from another system other than the FMCS. The MSG light is on to show there is an alert or advisory message. The MSG light stays on until you clear the message. The OFST light is on when a parallel offset is active. Special Keys The keyboard has special keys in addition to the alpha-numeric keys. These are the special keys: S Change sign (+/-) S Space (SP) S Delete (DEL). S Slash (/) S Clear (CLR). The change sign (+/-) and slash (/) keys are standard keys on a keyboard. The space key (SP) puts a space into the scratchpad. This will allow the flight crew to write messages into the scratchpad. A push of the DEL key puts the word DELETE in the CDU scratch pad. This lets the operator delete a data field with the line select key next to the data field. The DEL key does not work when the scratchpad contains data. Some data fields do not permit the DEL key function. In this case, the INVALID DELETE message shows in the CDU scratchpad. Push the CLR key once to remove one alphanumeric character in the scratch pad or an alert or advisory message from the scratch pad. Hold the CLR key down for one second to remove all scratch pad data. BITE The FMCS BITE function does a check of all key functions. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 48 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 TITLE BLOCK AMBIENT LIGHT SENSORS FOR AUTOMATIC CONTRAST ADJUSTMENT (2) PAGE NUMBER BLOCK 5-INCH DISPLAY, 14 24-CHARACTER LINES DATA STATUS BLOCK DATA BLOCK LINE SELECT KEYS LINE SELECT KEYS BRIGHTNESS ADJUSTMENT SCRATCH PAD/ MESSAGE BLOCK INIT REF FUNCTION AND MODE KEYS FIX RTE LEGS HOLD N1 MENU LIMIT PREV For Training Purposes Only ANNUNCIATORS CHANGE SIGN KEY FMCS - CONTROL DISPLAY UNIT - CONTROLS AND DISPLAYS Figure 21 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM NEXT C PAGE PAGE A L LW 1 2 3 F A I 5 6 LA 4 DECIMAL POINT KEY DEP ARR ATC VNAV BRT EXECUTE KEY FMC COMM PROG EXEC A B C D E F G H I J K L M N O P Q R S T Y 7 8 9 U V W X . 0 +/ - Z SP DEL / EXECUTE LIGHT M S G W O F S TW ANNUNCIATORS DELETE KEY SLASH KEY CLEAR KEY NUMERIC CHARACTER KEYS CLR ALPHABETIC CHARACTER KEYS FMCS - CONTROL DISPLAY UNIT FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 49 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - LCD CDU: CONTROLS AND DISPLAYS Display Format The multi-purpose control display unit (MCDU) data shows on the five-inch liquid crystal display (LCD). The basic display is a set of fourteen lines. Each line can show 24 characters. Each line can show alphanumeric characters and symbols. For Training Purposes Only Color The MCDU contains a liquid crystal display (LCD). It shows white text on a black background. The FANS MCDU contains a liquid crystal display (LCD). It shows white text on a black background. The LCD uses different colors to show flight activity and modes. Data shows in these colors: Black - background White - default color for text Magenta - active waypoint, active speed target and active altitude target in Flight plan Green - actively tuned VOR, ILS and DME data (frequency, station ID and course). Also, green will be used for data fields that can be toggled on and off in which case the active state is green Amber - FMC mismatch indications on maintenance BITE pages Cyan - Inactive route page titles Shaded white - data that modifies the flight plan until the EXEC key is pushed. The MCDU shows this data in white: - Text - Scratchpad messages - Header line titles - Box prompts Dashes, except when the dash is an integral part of the data field (i.e. negative temperature) in which case it will be the same color as the data Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM Slashes, except when the slash has data on both sides in which case it will be the same color as the data. Display Layout The first line shows these data blocks: - Status - Title - Page number. Status shows that the information on the display is the active executed plan (ACT) or a modified plan (MOD). When the data on the display is not active or not a part of the flight plan, the status block is blank. The next block is the title for the display. An example of a title is POS INIT. The last character spaces in the first line show the page number for each display. This tells the operator the active page and the total number of pages. Data on lines two through thirteen (data field) applies to operation of the airplane. Line fourteen is a scratch pad to enter data from the keyboard. Also, this line shows this data: S Failure messages S Alerts during operation S Advisory prompts. S Alphanumeric Key Board You use the key board to enter data into the FMCS and to make changes to a flight plan. Each time you push an alphanumeric key, the entry shows in the scratch pad (line 14). In the scratch pad, you can edit the entry or clear it. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 50 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 TITLE BLOCK AMBIENT LIGHT SENSORS FOR AUTOMATIC CONTRAST ADJUSTMENT (2) PAGE NUMBER BLOCK 5-INCH DISPLAY, 14 24-CHARACTER LINES DATA STATUS BLOCK DATA BLOCK LINE SELECT KEYS LINE SELECT KEYS BRIGHTNESS ADJUSTMENT SCRATCH PAD/ MESSAGE BLOCK INIT REF FUNCTION AND MODE KEYS FIX RTE LEGS HOLD N1 For Training Purposes Only ANNUNCIATORS CHANGE SIGN KEY C A L L F A I L DECIMAL POINT KEY FMCS - CONTROL DISPLAY UNIT - CONTROLS AND DISPLAYS Figure 22 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM DEP ARR ATC VNAV BRT EXECUTE KEY FMC COMM PROG EXEC MENU LIMIT A B C D E PREV PAGE F G H I J K L M N O 1 NEXT PAGE 2 3 4 5 6 P Q R S T 7 8 9 U V W X Y . 0 +/ - Z SP DEL / EXECUTE LIGHT M S G O F S T ANNUNCIATORS DELETE KEY SLASH KEY CLEAR KEY NUMERIC CHARACTER KEYS CLR ALPHABETIC CHARACTER KEYS FMCS - CONTROL DISPLAY UNIT FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 51 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training For Training Purposes Only NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 Function and Mode Keys These are the function and mode keys: S INIT REF S RTE S CLB S CRZ S DES S MENU S LEGS S DEP ARR S HOLD S PROG S N1 LIMIT S FIX S EXEC. These are the function and mode keys: - INIT REF - RTE - DEP ARR - ATC - VNAV - FIX - LEGS - HOLD - FMC COMM - PROG - MENU - N1 LIMIT - EXEC. The INIT REF key supplies access to a selection of data pages necessary to start the FMCS and ADIRU. Also, the operator can access navigation data and maintenance pages. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM The RTE key selects the page you use to enter route data. This includes the flight origin and destination plus the takeoff runway number. The CLB key shows the climb modes. Top-of-climb (T/C) altitude and speed/ altitude restrictions show here. Information about time and distance to the next waypoint is also shown here. The CRZ key shows the cruise modes. Information about optimum altitude, maximum altitude, step climb savings and turbulence N1 targets also show. The DES key shows the descent modes. The end-of-descent altitude and speed/altitude restrictions show here. Information about flight path angle, airplane vertical speed and vertical bearing also show. The MENU key gives access to other airplane data communication systems. The LEGS key shows and accepts input of data about each leg of the flight plan. Information about heading between the waypoints, speed and altitude is also shown. The DEP/ARR key supplies access to a selection of departure and arrival runways and procedures for the origin and destination airports. The HOLD key lets you plan or start a hold at a waypoint or present position. The PROG key shows this current flight status information. The N1 LIMIT key shows the FMC calculated N1 thrust limits for specific flight phases. This page also shows the reduced climb thrust limits CLB-1 (Climb 1)and CLB-2 (Climb 2). The flight crew can set N1 limit data from this page. The FIX key shows range and bearing data from the present position to a selected reference position (SRP). The ATC key is not active at this time and selecting this key will result in the display of the KEY/FUNCTION INOP message in the scratchpad. The VNAV key shows the climb, cruise, and descent performance pages. When the VNAV key is pushed in flight, the page shown will be the active flight phase. On the ground, the CLB page shows. The other flight phase pages may be shown with the PREV PAGE and NEXT PAGE keys. The FMC COMM key shows FMC communications page. This page has the airline operational communications (AOC) datalink functions. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 52 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 TITLE BLOCK AMBIENT LIGHT SENSORS FOR AUTOMATIC CONTRAST ADJUSTMENT (2) PAGE NUMBER BLOCK 5-INCH DISPLAY, 14 24-CHARACTER LINES DATA STATUS BLOCK DATA BLOCK LINE SELECT KEYS LINE SELECT KEYS BRIGHTNESS ADJUSTMENT SCRATCH PAD/ MESSAGE BLOCK INIT REF FUNCTION AND MODE KEYS FIX RTE LEGS HOLD N1 For Training Purposes Only ANNUNCIATORS CHANGE SIGN KEY C A L L F A I L DECIMAL POINT KEY FMCS - CONTROL DISPLAY UNIT - CONTROLS AND DISPLAYS Figure 23 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM DEP ARR ATC VNAV BRT EXECUTE KEY FMC COMM PROG EXEC MENU LIMIT A B C D E PREV PAGE F G H I J K L M N O 1 NEXT PAGE 2 3 4 5 6 P Q R S T 7 8 9 U V W X Y . 0 +/ - Z SP DEL / EXECUTE LIGHT M S G O F S T ANNUNCIATORS DELETE KEY SLASH KEY CLEAR KEY NUMERIC CHARACTER KEYS CLR ALPHABETIC CHARACTER KEYS FMCS - CONTROL DISPLAY UNIT FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 53 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training For Training Purposes Only NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 The EXEC key is used to make active or to modify a page with data entry when the EXEC light comes on. Page Select Keys You push the NEXT PAGE key to advance the display to the next higher number page. You push the PREV PAGE key to back-up the display to the next lower number page. The page strings are continuous. If the first page of a string is shown (1/9) and you push the PREV PAGE key, the display shows the last page in the string (9/9). If you go past the last page in a string (past 9/9 for example), this takes the display back to the first page in the string (1/9). Line Select Keys S You use the line select keys for these operations: S Move data from the scratch pad to a data field S Copy data from a data field to the scratch pad S Remove data from a data field S Select a BITE operation from the maintenance bite index. Lighted Annunciators These are the active annunciators: - CALL - MSG (Message) - OFST (Offset). The CALL light is on when there is a call from another system other than the FMCS. The MSG light is on to show there is an alert or advisory message. The MSG light stays on until you clear the message. The OFST light is on when a parallel offset is active. Special Keys Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM The keyboard has special keys in addition to the alpha-numeric keys. These are the special keys: S Change sign (+/-) S Space (SP) S Delete (DEL). S Slash (/) S Clear (CLR). The change sign (+/-) and slash (/) keys are standard keys on a keyboard. The space key (SP) puts a space into the scratchpad. This will allow the flight crew to write messages into the scratchpad. A push of the DEL key puts the word DELETE in the CDU scratch pad. This lets the operator delete a data field with the line select key next to the data field. The DEL key does not work when the scratchpad contains data. Some data fields do not permit the DEL key function. In this case, the INVALID DELETE message shows in the CDU scratchpad. Push the CLR key once to remove one alphanumeric character in the scratch pad or an alert or advisory message from the scratch pad. Hold the CLR key down for one second to remove all scratch pad data. BITE The FMCS BITE function does a check of all key functions. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 54 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 TITLE BLOCK AMBIENT LIGHT SENSORS FOR AUTOMATIC CONTRAST ADJUSTMENT (2) PAGE NUMBER BLOCK 5-INCH DISPLAY, 14 24-CHARACTER LINES DATA STATUS BLOCK DATA BLOCK LINE SELECT KEYS LINE SELECT KEYS BRIGHTNESS ADJUSTMENT SCRATCH PAD/ MESSAGE BLOCK INIT REF FUNCTION AND MODE KEYS FIX RTE LEGS HOLD N1 For Training Purposes Only ANNUNCIATORS CHANGE SIGN KEY C A L L F A I L DECIMAL POINT KEY FMCS - CONTROL DISPLAY UNIT - CONTROLS AND DISPLAYS Figure 24 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM DEP ARR ATC VNAV BRT EXECUTE KEY FMC COMM PROG EXEC MENU LIMIT A B C D E PREV PAGE F G H I J K L M N O 1 NEXT PAGE 2 3 4 5 6 P Q R S T 7 8 9 U V W X Y . 0 +/ - Z SP DEL / EXECUTE LIGHT M S G O F S T ANNUNCIATORS DELETE KEY SLASH KEY CLEAR KEY NUMERIC CHARACTER KEYS CLR ALPHABETIC CHARACTER KEYS FMCS - CONTROL DISPLAY UNIT FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 55 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMCS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - LCD CDU DATA LOAD General You use the airborne data loader (ADL) to load the operational program software (OPS) into the CDUs. To load the OPS into the CDUs, set the data loader selector to the CDU position and the data loader 3-position switch to the L or R position depending on which CDU is to be loaded. This connects the loader to the CDU being loaded. Preparation This is a summary of the steps to load the OPS with an ADL: S Airplane must be on the ground S Apply electrical power to the airplane S Set the data loader selector to the CDU position S Set the data loader 3-position switch to the CDU you will load (the L position loads CDU 1 and the R position loads CDU 2) S Open the data loader access door S Put the CDU OPS software diskette into the ADL. For Training Purposes Only The CDUs show the DATA LOADER page when the CDU receives valid data from the loader. The data load process is automatic. When the CDU shows the message LOAD COMPLETE, remove the diskette from the ADL and perform the applicable software verification procedure. Return the data loader selector to the NORM position after the transfer is complete. NOTE: Do not interrupt electrical power to the system during software loading. If power is interrupted, you will need to do the software load procedure again. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 56 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMCS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 DATA LOAD SELECTOR C SINGLE SYS R L CAPT F/O LWR UPR SYSTEM SELECT NORMAL FMC CDU DATA LOADER DATA LOADER DATA LOADER CONTROL PANEL For Training Purposes Only P18-2 CIRCUIT BREAKER PANEL Figure 25 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMS LCD CDU-DATA LOAD FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 57 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training For Training Purposes Only NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - CDU CONTROLS AND DISPLAYS Display Format The CDU (also called the MCDU) data displays show on the five—inch CRT. The basic display is a set of fourteen lines. Each line can show 34 characters. Each line can show alphanumeric characters and symbols. The first line shows these data blocks: S Status S Title S Page number. Status shows that the information on display is the active executed plan (ACT) or a modified plan (MOD). When the data on the display is not active or not a part of the flight plan, the status block is blank. The next block identifies the title for the display. An example of a title is POS INIT. The last character spaces in the first line show the page number for each display. This tells the operator the active page and the total number of pages. Data on lines two through thirteen (data field) applies to operation of the airplane. Line fourteen is a scratch pad to enter data from the keyboard. Also, this line shows this data: S Failure messages S Alerts during operation S Advisory prompts. Alphanumeric Key Board You use the key board to enter data into the FMCS and to make changes to a flight plan. Each time you push an alphanumeric key, the entry shows in the scratch pad (line 14). In the scratch pad, you can edit the entry or clear it. The space key (SP) puts a space into the scratchpad. Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM Flight Phase Keys These are the flight phase keys: S Climb (CLB) S Cruise (CRZ) S Descent (DES). The CLB key shows the climb modes. Top—of—climb (T/C), altitude, and speed/altitude limits show here. The CRZ key shows the cruise modes. Information about optimum altitude and turbulence N1 targets also show. The DES key shows the descent modes. The end—of—descent altitude and airport speed/altitude restrictions also show here. Function Keys These are the function keys: S INIT REF (Initialization/Reference) S RTE (ROUTE) S MENU S LEGS S N1 LIMIT S FIX (Fix Information) S DEP ARR (Departure Arrivals) S HOLD S PROG (Flight Progress) S EXEC (Execute). The INIT REF key supplies access to a selection of data pages necessary to start the FMCS and ADIRU. Also, the operator can access navigation data and maintenance pages. The RTE key selects the page you use to enter route data. This includes the flight origin and destination plus the takeoff runway number. The MENU key gives access to subsystems. The LEGS key shows and accepts input of data about each leg of the flight plan for both the lateral and vertical paths. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 58 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) Figure 26 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMC CDU CONTROLS AND DISPLAYS FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 59 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training For Training Purposes Only NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - CDU CONTROLS AND DISPLAYS (cont.) The N1 LIMIT key shows the calculated N1 limits for these functions: S G/A (Go—around) S CON (Maximum continuous thrust) S CLB (Climb) S CRZ (Cruise). This page also shows the reduced climb thrust limits CLB—1 (Climb 1) and CLB—2 (Climb 2). You can set both limits from this page. The FIX key shows range and bearing data from the present position to a different position. The DEP/ARR key supplies access to a selection of departure and arrival data for the origin and destination airports. The HOLD key lets you plan or start a hold at a waypoint or present position. The PROG key shows this current flight status information: S Fuel remaining at waypoint S Navigation radio status S Wind S Path error S ETA. Push the EXEC key to make active or to modify a page with data entry when the EXEC light comes on. Page Select Keys You push the NEXT PAGE key to advance the display to the next higher number page. You push the PREV PAGE key to back—up the display to the next lower number page. The page strings are continuous. If the first page of a string is shown (1/9) and you push the PREV PAGE key, the display shows the last page in the string (9/9). If you go past the last page in a string (past 9/9 for example), this takes the display back to the first page in the string (1/9). Line Select Keys You use the line select keys for these operations: S Move data from the scratch pad to a data field S Copy data from a data field to the scratch pad Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM S Remove data from a data field S Select a BITE operation from the maintenance bite index. Lighted Annunciators These are the active annunciators: S FAIL S MSG (Message) S CALL S OFST (Offset). The FAIL light is on if there is a system failure found by BITE. The MSG light is on to show there is an alert or advisory message. The MSG light stays on until you clear the message. The CALL light is on when there is a call from another subsystem. The OFST light is on when a parallel offset is active. Special Keys The keyboard has special keys in addition to the alpha— numeric keys. These are the special keys: S Change sign (+/-) S Slash (/) S Clear (CLR) S Delete (DEL). The change sign (+/-) and slash (/) keys are standard keys on a keyboard. Push the CLR key once to remove one alpha—numeric character in the scratch pad or an alert or advisory message from the scratch pad. Hold the CLR key down for one second to remove all scratch pad data. A push of the DEL key puts the word DELETE in the CDU scratch pad. This lets the operator delete a data field with the line select key next to the data field. The DEL key does not work when the scratchpad contains data. Some data fields do not permit the DEL key function. In this case, the INVALID DELETE message shows in the CDU scratchpad. BITE The FMCS BITE function does a check of all key functions. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 60 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) Figure 27 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMC CDU CONTROLS AND DISPLAYS FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 61 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training For Training Purposes Only NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - AIRBORNE DATA LOADER Purpose You use the airborne data loader (ADL) to load data into selected LRUs and to record data from selected LRUs. You use the data loader control panel to select the LRU. Physical Description/Features The airborne data loader (ADL) is an ARINC—615 high speed loader. These are the ADL features: S Access door S Disk drive S Disk drive light S Disk drive eject button S Status indicator panel. These messages show on the ADL status indicator panel: S PROG (Data transfer in progress) S CHNG (Diskette change required) S COMP (Data transfer complete) S RDY (The loader is ready for operation. If RDY flashes, the LRU has stopped the data transfer to check the data. The transfer will continue automatically) S XFER (Data transfer failure) S R/W (Unable to access diskette data) S HRDW (Internal loader failure. If HRDW flashes, there is no communication between the loader and the LRU). The data loader does an internal self test at power up. During the self test, all the front panel status indicators flash. At the end of the self test, the indicators go off. If there is a failure at power up, the HRDW status indicator is on. If the self test is satisfactory, the RDY message shows. The other indicators come on as the data loader moves through the load or transfer. Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 62 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) Figure 28 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMC AIRBORNE DATA LOADER FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 63 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - TRANSFER RELAYS Purpose There are two FMCS transfer relays. The relays select the FMC to send data to the systems that interface with the FMCS. The FMC SOURCE SELECT SWITCH controls the relays. The source select switch is in the flight deck. Location The relays are on the E5—2 shelf in the electronic equipment compartment. For Training Purposes Only Physical Description The relays mechanically latch (latch-type relays) and are hermetically sealed. Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 64 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) Figure 29 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMC XFR RELAYS FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 65 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - DISPLAYS: CDU, POWER UP General The CDU and FMCs do tests at power up. If the tests pass, the CDUs show the IDENT page for a normal power up. For Training Purposes Only Menu Key Push the MENU key on a CDU to see the full menu page on both CDUs. The MENU page shows all the subsystems that connect to the CDUs. Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 66 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only PUSH LSK < FMC NORMAL POWER UP Figure 30 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMS POWER UP, NORMAL DISLPLAY FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 67 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMC At power up, each FMC does a check of the status of the other FMC. If the primary FMC fails at power up, the FMC menu prompt does not show. The FMC warning light on the autoflight status annunciators also comes on. If the secondary FMC fails, the primary FMC shows the SINGLE FMC OPERATION message in the scratch pads. If the transfer switch is in normal, the FMC warning light comes on. CDU A CDU display is blank if the CDU fails at power up. For Training Purposes Only Other Tests The FMCs also check these functions at power up: S Airplane and engine configuration program pins for parity S Cross compare FMC 1 and FMC 2 data bases and operational flight programs. For example, the message OP PROGRAM INVALID shows if the operational flight program (OFP) of the primary FMC is invalid at power up. If the secondary FMC has a valid OFP, the message tells the operator to switch to the both on right position. Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 68 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) Figure 31 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMS POWER UP, NON-NORMAL DISPLAY FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 69 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - DISPLAYS: CDU, IDENT PAGE Purpose The IDENT page shows the FMCS data base and program configuration data. Also, you can select the POS INIT and INDEX pages from the IDENT page. Page Access The IDENT page shows after power up if the self—tests are normal (see the graphic for the other inputs). Page 1/2 Information Page 2/2 Information Line select key 1L shows the performance default data base number. Line select key 2L shows the identification number of the software options data base. Line select key 5L shows the identification number of the performance data base. This line is blank if the data base is not loaded. You can select the INIT/REF INDEX page with line select key 6L. For Training Purposes Only Line select key 1L shows the airplane model. The airframe/engine program pin configuration sets this information. This line is blank if the FMC finds a parity error for the airframe/engine program pins or a valid performance data base is not loaded into the FMC. Line select key 2L shows the navigation data base number loaded in the FMC. This line is blank if a navigation data base is not loaded. Line select key 4L shows the operational program software part number. Line select key 5L can show the Smiths Industries operational program part number. To show the number, put the word SIPART into the scratch pad and select key 5L. This line is blank when the part number is not shown. You can select the INIT/REF INDEX page with key 6L. Line select key 1R shows the engine thrust rating. This information is set by the airframe/engine program pin configuration. This line is blank if the FMC finds a parity error for the airframe/engine program pins or a valid performance data base is not loaded into the FMC. Line select key 2R shows the active data base. Key 3R shows the data base that is not active. You can interchange the data on these two lines to activate a new data base or recall the old one. The interchange can only be done when the airplane is on the ground. Line select key 5R shows there is supplemental data and gives the effective date of the data. The line is blank if an effective date is not set or there is no supplemental data. Line select key 6R selects the POS INIT page. Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 70 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) Figure 32 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMC IDENT PAGE FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 71 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - DISPLAYS: CDU, INIT/REF INDEX PAGE Purpose The INIT/REF INDEX page shows a menu of pages you can use to initialize the FMCS, the ADIRU and other reference data. Also, you can use this page to access the FMCS MAINT BITE INDEX page. Page Access To select this page, push line select key 6L on pages that show the index prompt and are not BITE pages. The INDEX prompt on BITE pages moves the display back to the last menu. For Training Purposes Only Information Select line select key 1L through line 5L to show the first page of the selected prompt. Select line select key 6L to show the lateral offset page. Select line select key 1R to show the navigation data reference page. Select line select key 5R to show configuration data for loadable software. Select tine select key 6R to show the maintenance bite index page. The bite page only shows with the airplane on the ground and the ground speed is below 20 knots. With the airplane in the air, the NAV STATUS prompt shows in place of the MAINT prompt. Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 72 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) Figure 33 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMC INIT/REF PAGE FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 73 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - DISPLAYS: CDU, POSITION PAGES Purpose There are three position pages. They show this information: S Present position and groundspeed calculated by the FMCS and each ADIRU S Box prompts to initialize the ADIRUs. The box prompts show that data must be set to complete the preflight. The dash prompts show the data is optional. For Training Purposes Only Page Access You use the INIT REF function key or these CDU pages, to go to the first position page: S INIT/REF INDEX S IDENT S TAKEOFF REF. Page 1/3 Information Line select key 2L shows dash prompts for an airport identifier. KBFI (Boeing Field International) is an example of a valid identifier. The identifiers you put here must also be in the navigation data base. If the identifier you put in is valid and is in the data base, the latitude/longitude (LAT/LON) for the airport identifier shows at line 2R. Line select key 3L shows dash prompts for airport gate identifiers. If the identifier you put in is valid and is in the data base, the LAT/LON for the gate shows at LSK 3R. You must put the airport identifier in first. Line select key 5L shows airplane clock input. The clock input (time and date) to both FMCs is from the captain’s clock. If the captain’s clock does not operate, both FMCs use the F/O’s clock. If a valid clock is not available, you can set time with the CDU. You can select the index page at key 6L Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM Line select key 1R shows the last calculated FMCS present position. This data is kept at power down. Line select key 2R and 3R show the LAT/LON position for the reference airport and gate identifiers set at Line select key 2L and 3L. Box prompts at Line select key 4R show the ADIRUs are ready for alignment and the airplane is on the ground. See the air data inertial reference unit section for more information on aligning the ADIRU.(AMM PART 1, 34— 21) A heading update can be set in Line select key 5R for an ADIRU in the attitude (ATT) mode. Line select key 5R is blank if there is no ADIRU in the ATT mode. 2/3 Information Information on page 2 shows the current position and ground speed calculated by the different systems. The information can be line selected to the scratch pad to initialize the ADIRUs. The radio position data does not show on the ground or in the air and radio position data is not valid. Page 3/3 Information This page shows the bearing and distance between the FMCS calculated position shown on page 2/3 (Line select key 1L), and the position of the systems shown on page 3/3. Page 3/3 also provides the capability to update the FMCS calculated position to one of the positions shown by line selection and execute (EXEC). FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 74 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 GPS L For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMC) < 274_/0.0NM GPS L N40_38.1 W73_46.0 Figure 34 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMC POSITION PAGES FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 75 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - DISPLAYS: CDU MESSAGES General The FMCS shows alert or advisory messages when there is a condition that degrades the system. The messages show one at a time, by priority, on the CDU scratch pad. All advisory and alert messages turn on the CDU MSG annunciator. Only an alert message turns on the FMC warning lights on the autoflight status annunciators. If the scratch pad is empty, any message shows immediately. Some messages replace other messages and show immediately. Other messages do not show until the scratch pad field is clear but the CDU MSG light still comes on. To clear a message, push the CLR key or remove the conditions that cause the message. Other messages clear when you change the page. The CDUs show these message types in this priority: S Alert S Entry error advisory S Advisory. Below are examples of messages that are maintenance related. The operations manual has a complete list of the CDU messages. Alert Messages Alert messages tell about conditions which you should know and correct before you use the FMCS. The messages show on both CDUs. ALERT MESSAGE CONDITION DATA BASE INVALID THE TEST OF THE NAV DATA BASE HAS FAILED NAV DATA OUT OF DATE THE NAVIGATION DATA BASE EFFECTIVITY IS OUT OF DATE ENTER IRS POSITION AN IRS IS IN THE ALIGN MODE AND NEEDS A POSITION SET CYCLE IRS OFF-NAV IRS IS NOT ABLE TO COMPLETE ALIGNMENT UNDER CURRENT CONDITIONS IRS MOTION THE IRS HAS AUTOMATICALLY RESTARTED THE ALIGNMENT DUE TO DETECTION OF EXCESSIVE MOTION MODEL ENGINE DATA INVALID A VALID PERFORMANCE DATA BASE IS NOT AVAILABLE OR HAS FAILED For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 76 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 77 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - DISPLAYS: CDU MESSAGES (cont‘d.) Entry Error Advisory Messages These messages show that data set in the scratch pad is not correct. Clear the message and enter the data again. These messages show only on the CDU where the entry error is made. ENTRY ERROR MESSAGE CONDITION INVALID ENTRY THE DATA HAS AN INCORRECT FORMAT OR RANGE NOT IN DATA BASE A SEARCH OF THE NAV DATA BASE DID NOT FIND THE REQUIRED DATA For Training Purposes Only Advisory Messages Advisory messages show the FMC/CDU system status. If the MSG annunciators are on but no message shows, you must first CLR the scratch pad of any messages. These messages show on both CDUs. ADVISORY MESSAGE CONDITION PROGRAM PIN ERROR THE AIRFRAME/ENGINE PROGRAM PIN CONFIGURATION IS NOT VALID CHECK FMC FUEL QUANTITY THE FMCS DETECTED AN UNEXPECTED DROP IN THE FUEL QUANTITY MODEL/ENG CFG INVALID THE AIRFRAME/ENGINE PROGRAM PINS DO NOT AGREE WITH DATA STORED IN THE PERFORMANCE DATA BASE. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 78 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) Figure 35 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMC CDU MESSAGES FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 79 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - DISPLAYS: CDS FLIGHT MODE ANNUNCIATIONS FMCS Flight Mode Annunciation These are the active FMCS flight mode annunciations (FMA) that can show during FMCS operation: S Autothrottle (A/T) mode annunciation S Pitch mode annunciation S Roll mode annunciation. See the digital flight control system section for more information about mode annunciation. (AMM PART 1, ATA 22—11) Autothrottle Mode Annunciation The A/T mode annunciation shows in column one of the FMA. These are the autothrottle modes that can show during FMCS operation: S FMC SPD S N1 S RETARD S ARM. Pitch Mode Annunciations The pitch mode annunciation shows in column two of the FMA. These are the pitch modes that can show during FMCS operation: S VNAV PTH S VNAV SPD. For Training Purposes Only Roll Mode Annunciation The roll mode annunciation LNAV, shows in column three of the FMA. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 80 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) Figure 36 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMC FLIGHT MODE ANN. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 81 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS DISPLAYS - CDS - THRUST MODE General The thrust mode annunciation display shows the active N1 limit mode calculated by the FMCS. The reference N1 bugs (2) show the N1 limit for the active mode. The N1 limit mode controls the N1 limit for autothrottle operation. The reference N1 readouts may be set manually. They are set with the N1 SET CONTROL inner knob. When the reference N1 readout is set manually, the N1 bugs show the N1 reference readout value. These manually set limits have no effect on autothrottle operation. Thrust Mode Display These thrust modes show on the engine display: S TO (Takeoff) S R-T O (Reduced takeoff) S CLB (Climb) S R-CLB (Reduced climb) S CRZ (Cruise) S CON (Continuous) S GA (Go-around) S - - - (no computed data from the FMCS). Display Control When the N1 SET CONTROL outer knob is set to the AUTO position, the thrust mode display and N1 bug position are set by the FMCS as a function of DFCS mode logic. To override automatic control, you can line select another mode from the N1 limit page. The displays go back to automatic control when the DFCS pitch mode changes. When the outer knob is set to the BOTH, 1 or 2 position, you can manually set the reference N1 bugs and the N1 reference readouts will be displayed above the digital N1 displays. With the outer knob in the AUTO position, the readout is blank. Non-Normal Operation In automatic operation, the thrust mode display and reference N1 bug readout are calculated by the FMCS. If the FMCS calculations are not valid, the autothrottle limit message A/T LIM shows. The autothrottle computer then calculates a single N1 limit for both engines. For Training Purposes Only Only one thrust mode can show and be active. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 82 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 N1 L I M I T N1 SET AUT O AUTO 1 BOTH For Training Purposes Only REF N1 BUG THRUST MODE DISPLAY - TO - R-TO - CLB - R-CLB - CRZ - GA - CON - - - - A/T LIM R-CLB 89.8 TAI 87.1 0 2 10 8 6 4 89.8 TAI 87.1 0 2 10 8 6 N1 CON 99. 8/ 99. 8% CL B 89. 8/ 89. 8% 83. 8/ 83 . 8% CRZ - - - - - - REDU CE D CL B - - - - - - CL B - 2 CL B- 1 < SEL > ENGINE DISPLAY CONTROL PANEL ACTUAL N1 101. 6/ 101 . 6% GA 2 ENGINE DISPLAY 1/ 1 REF N1 READOUT N1 LIMIT PAGE A CT E CON CL B CRZ A L T FL 3 3 0 T GT S P D 2004. 280/ . 720 S P D RE S T E RR 250/ 100 00 - - - - - - - - - - - 87. - - - < MA X RAT E 1/ 1 A T C R1 0 2 2 50 0A T O C R1 0 2 3 Z/ 1 9 NM A T C R1 0 2 3 10 LO CL B 1 - N1 1/ 8 7. 1% - - - - - - - E NG OU T > < MA X A NGL E RT A > 4 CLIMB PAGE FMCS - DISPLAYS - CDS - THRUST MODE Figure 37 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMC THRUST MODE ANN. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 83 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training For Training Purposes Only NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS DISPLAYS - CDS - AIRSPEED INDICATION General The takeoff and landing airspeed bugs show on the PFD speed tape indication. The bugs are set automatically by the FMC or, they can be set manually by the flight crew using the speed reference selector on the engine control panel. When set manually, the airspeeds show on the PFD speed tape indication and a digital display of the set value shows. You also use the speed reference selector to manually set the airplane takeoff or landing gross weight. CDS will use this weight value to calculate and display the flap maneuvering speeds. Speed Reference Selector The outer control has these functions: - AUTO (the FMCS supplies the reference airspeeds and gross weight automatically) - V1 (shows the takeoff decision speed on the ground and shows INVALID ENTRY in-flight) - VR (shows takeoff rotation speed on the ground and shows INVALID ENTRY in-flight) - WT (the pilot can set the gross weight manually) - VREF (shows the landing reference speed (REF) in the air and shows INVALID ENTRY on the ground) - Triangle symbol (shows an airspeed bug the pilot can set) SET (the FMC and the inner control cannot move the airspeed bugs). The inner control sets the selected bug to the desired airspeed or sets gross weight. The control is spring loaded to center. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM Takeoff This data shows on the PFD speed tape indication: Digital display (the display shows if the airspeed bug(s) or weight is set with the speed reference selector) S V1 (decision speed) S VR (rotation speed) Selected speed (indicates the airspeed manually set in the IAS/MACH display on the DFCS mode control panel (MCP) or the FMC computed airspeed when the IAS/MACH window is blank) S V2 (single engine climb speed) S V2+15 (single engine climb speed plus 15 knots) S Flap maneuver speed (maneuver speed for flap position shown. It does not show for 30 or 40 units of flap.) S Flaps up speed (shows after zero fuel weight is set in the CDU and takeoff gross weight is calculated, or after takeoff gross weight is set with the speed reference selector) Approach/Landing This data can show on the PFD speed tape during approach: S REF (landing reference speed VREF is set on the CDU APPROACH REF page or set with the speed reference selector) S VREF+15 (this shows after VREF is set) S Flap maneuver speed (maneuver speed for flap position shown). FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 84 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 SELECTED SPEED FLAP MANEUVERING SPEED 149 180 1 SPEED TREND VECTOR 160 140 122 VR V1 135 154 220 V2+15 200 SELECTED SPEED (V2 SPEED SHOWS AT TAKEOFF) TAKEOFF REFERENCE SPEEDS 162 140 REF 132 120 80 WT LB 104000 For Training Purposes Only LANDING REFERENCE SPEED (VREF) DIGITAL DISPLAY SPD REF AUTO OUTER CONTROL TAKEOFF (TYPICAL) 15 VREF + 15 CURRENT AIRSPEED 100 FLAP MANEUVER SPEED 180 V1 INNER CONTROL APPROACH/LANDING (TYPICAL) SET VR WT FMCS - DISPLAYS - CDS - AIRSPEED INDICATION VREF SPEED REFERENCE SELECTOR Figure 38 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMC MACH AIRSPEED INDICATION FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 85 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS DISPLAYS - CDS - MAP DISPLAY General The FMCS provides the navigation data for the MAP mode displays on the common display system (CDS). There are two types of navigation data, dynamic data and background data. Dynamic data changes as a function of time while background data is stationary data that does not move as a function of time. The FMCS formats and transmits the data (FMC bus 08 and FMC bus 09) to show the airplane position with respect to the flight plan and vertical profile. The CDS controls symbol color, size, and brightness. For Training Purposes Only Map Mode The map mode shows the progress of the flight and is the normal display the crew uses for navigation in flight. This display may show in either the expanded mode or the centered mode. The display is dynamic and moves as the airplane moves. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM Symbol Definitions This data is shown: S Active waypoint distance (distance to go to the active waypoint. White) S Active waypoint ETA (estimated time of arrival for the active waypoint. White) S T/C altitude profile point (top of climb position in the active route. Green) S T/D altitude profile point (top of descent position in the active route. Green) S E/D altitude profile point (end of descent position in the active route. Green) S S/C altitude profile point (step climb position in the active route. Green) S Speed profile point (deceleration point in the active route. Green) S Active waypoint (next waypoint in the active route. Magenta) S Range to altitude arc (range at which the airplane will reach the MCP altitude. Green) S Trend vector (predicted position of airplane at the end of 30, 60 or 90 second intervals. White) S Inactive waypoint (waypoint other than the active waypoint in the active route. White) S Vertical deviation scale (vertical deviation from the calculated descent profile. Scale is white and pointer is magenta) S Map options (options selected on the EFIS control panel. Cyan) S Wind data (wind speed and direction. White) S Map source (source of dynamic and background data. Green) S Navaids (navigation stations within the selected map area. Cyan) S Off route waypoints (waypoints within the selected map area but not in the active route. Cyan) S Airports (airports within the selected map area. Cyan) S Route data (altitude constraints and ETAs for the waypoint in the active route. Magenta or white) S Track angle (airplane track. White). FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 86 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) GROUND SPEED B737-600/700/800 34-61 GS 351 TAS 338 336_/15 140 TRK CHN 0838.4Z 32.5 NM MAG WIND DATA INACTIVE WAYPOINT DECE L TAU OFF ROUTE WAYPOINT RID TRACK ANGLE MAP OPTIONS 40 MUC ALTITUDE PROFILE POINT T/D ARPT WPT STA DINKU EDDF 2100 ACTIVE WAYPOINT VERTICAL DEVIATION SCALE AIRPORT FRA TREND VECTOR For Training Purposes Only ACTIVE WAYPOINT DISTANCE SPEED PROFILE POINT MARK RANGE TO ALTITUDE ARC ACTIVE WAYPOINT ETA NAVAID MAP SOURCE FMC L EXPANDED MAP MODE Figure 39 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMC MAP DISPLAY FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 87 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS DISPLAYS - CDS - PLAN DISPLAY General The FMCS provides the navigation data for the PLAN mode displays on the common display system (CDS). There are two types of navigation data, dynamic data and background data. Dynamic data changes as a function of time while background data is stationary data that does not move as a function of time. The FMCS formats and transmits the data (FMC bus 08 and FMC bus 09) to accurately show the airplane position with respect to the flight plan and vertical profile. The CDS controls symbol color, size, and brightness. Symbol Definitions This data shows: - Distance to go to the active waypoint (white) - Estimated time of arrival for the active waypoint (white) - Active waypoint (next waypoint in active route) (magenta) - Waypoints other than the active waypoint in the active route (white) - Options selected on the EFIS control panel (cyan) - Source of the dynamic and background data (green). For Training Purposes Only Plan Mode The plan mode shows NORTH UP. The crew uses the plan mode with the FMC/CDU LEGS page and the STEP line select key to review the route. The plan mode display is a static display. Range information shows as circles around the reference point that is in the middle of the display. The airplane symbol shows the current position and track if the airplane is in the range of the flight plan shown. Display Data Ground speed, wind data, and true airspeed show the same as for the APP, VOR, and MAP modes except that the wind direction arrow does not show. This data shows in the upper right corner: S Active waypoint identifier S Estimated time of arrival at the active waypoint S Distance to the waypoint. Only TCAS traffic data messages show in the plan mode. TCAS mode/status information shows in the lower left corner. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 88 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) GROUND SPEED WIND DATA B737-600/700/800 34-61 GS351 TAS 338 336_/15 CHN 0838.4Z 5.8NM N 80 ACTIVE WAYPOINT ETA ACTIVE WAYPOINT DISTANCE INACTIVE WAYPOINTS TAU 40 ACTIVE WAYPOINT MAP OPTIONS W RID E AIRPLANE SYMBOL ARPT WPT STA 40 For Training Purposes Only DINKU TCAS MODE/STATUS INFORMATION TA ONLY MAP SOURCE 80 FMC L E PLAN MODE Figure 40 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMC PLAN DISPLAY FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 89 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS DISPLAYS - CDS, NON-NORMAL DISPLAYS General These non-normal messages can show: S UNABLE REQD NAV PERF - RNP S MAP RANGE DISAGREE. These non-normal flags can show: - MAP flag - Vertical track (VTK). The UNABLE REQD NAV PERF - RNP message shows when the actual navigation performance (ANP) exceeds the required navigation performance (RNP) for the current flight environment. The map data is not blanked in this condition. The MAP RANGE DISAGREE message shows when a new range has been selected on the EFIS control panel and new map data is not received from the FMC. All map data is blanked in this condition. For Training Purposes Only The MAP flag shows if the map data from the FMC is invalid or NCD. All map data is blanked in this condition. The VTK (vertical track) flag shows when the vertical deviation data from the FMC is invalid or NCD. Only the vertical deviation scale is blanked in this condition. All these non-normal messages and flags can show in the map and plan modes. They are amber. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 90 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) GS 351 TAS 338 336_/15 TRK 140 MARK IAN B737-600/700/800 34-61 CHN 0838.4Z 32.5 NM MAG GS 351 TAS 338 336_/15 140 MAG DECEL DOT UNABLE REQD NAV PERF-RNP 40 TRK MAP RANGE DISAGREE AMY26 T/D MAP ARPT WPT STA WRB 2100 KJAN V T K FRA For Training Purposes Only FMC L FMC L EXPANDED MAP MODE EXPANDED MAP MODE Figure 41 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMC NON-NORMAL DISPLAYS FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 91 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training For Training Purposes Only NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMCS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - DATA LOADER General You use the airborne data loader (ADL) to load data into the FMCS and other airplane systems. The steps to load data into the FMCS and the other systems are similar. To load data into the FMCS, you set the data loader control panel selector to the FMC position. This connects the loader to the primary FMC. You can load the operational flight program (OFP) and these data bases into the FMCS: S Navigation S Model/engine data S Software options S Performance. You then do a crossload and load the data into FMC 2 through the FMCS cross channel bus. Return the data loader selector to the NORM position after the transfer is complete. Prepare The information below shows the steps to load a navigation data base. The procedure to load the other systems data or the other FMCS data is similar. This is a summary of the steps to load data: S The airplane must be on the ground S Apply electrical power to the airplane S Set the FMC source select switch to the FMC you will load (the BOTH ON L and the NORMAL positions load the left FMC and the BOTH ON R position loads the right FMC) S Set the data load selector to the FMC position S Open the data loader access door S Put the required diskette into the ADL. The CDUs automatically go to the FMCS DATA LOADER page when the FMC receives valid data from the loader. The data loading process is now automatic. With the FMCS source select switch in the normal position, the data loads into FMC 1. Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 92 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMCS) Figure 42 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMS DATA LOADER FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 93 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMCS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - DATABASE LOAD Load After you put the diskette into the Loader, the Load process is automatic. Except to change diskettes, no further operation is required. The load is complete when LOAD COMPLETE shows on the CDU. Press the eject button on the Loader to remove the diskette. For Training Purposes Only Load Failure Indications If the loader finds a problem, a message shows on the data loader display. If the FMC finds a problem with the data from the Loader, the CDU can show one of these messages: S CHECK MEDIA (part of the data on the disk cannot be read by the Loader) S RESET COUNT EXCEEDED (five Load attempts have failed) S DB EXCEEDS FMC (the data on the disk is too large for FMC memory) S DB—OFP INCOMPATIBLE (the data on the disk does not compare with the FMC operational program) S INCORRECT DISK INSERTED (the diskette does not compare with the diskette you used before) S CHECK DBL OR INTERFACE (there is a problem that the FMCS cannot isolate to the FMC or the Loader). Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 94 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMCS) Figure 43 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMS DATA BASE LOADING FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 95 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMCS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - CROSSLOAD PAGES General These are the two crossload pages that can show on the CDU: - DATABASE CROSSLOAD - OP PROGRAM CROSSLOAD. The OP PROGRAM CROSSLOAD page shows automatically for any of these conditions: S You apply power on the ground and the primary FMC, finds the OFPs in the two FMCS do not match (anytime the OFP in the primary FMC is not valid, the CDU shows a message to set the source select switch to the BOTH ON R position) S You load a new OFP in one FMC S The OFP does not compare between the primary and secondary FMCs and you enter FMCS BITE and select the Crossload line select key. For Training Purposes Only The DATABASE CROSSLOAD page shows automatically for any of these conditions: - You apply power on the ground and a database in the primary FMC and the secondary FMC do not match - You load a new database in one FMC - A database does not match between the primary and secondary FMCs when you enter FMCS BITE and select the Crossload line select key. The database pages show only the databases that do not match between FMCs. The example in the graphic shows the condition where all the databases do not match. Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 96 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMCS) Figure 44 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMS CROSSLOAD FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 97 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMCS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - DATABASE CROSSLOAD Operation The example in the graphic shows the steps to crossload a navigation database from the primary FMC to the secondary FMC. In this example, FMC 1 is the primary FMC. After you load a new navigation database and you remove the diskette from the loader, FMC 1 does a power—up test. Since the database in FMC 1 and FMC 2 do not compare, the DATABASE CROSSLOAD page shows automatically. To start the crossload, select COPY FROM LEFT on the CDU and push the EXEC key. The message CROSSLOAD COMPLETE shows at the end of the crossload. If, in this example, you select COPY FROM RIGHT in error, you will receive instructions on the CDU to set FMC 2 as the primary FMC. If you continue, you will load the old database from FMC 2, to FMC 1. For Training Purposes Only Crossload Failure These are the messages that show if the data base did not crossload: S CROSSLOAD FAIL (the database in the source FMC did not crossload to the other FMC) S DB EXCEEDS FMC MEMORY — (the size of the database in the source FMC is too large for the memory of the other FMC) S CROSSLOAD UNAVAILABLE (the source FMC cannot interface with the other FMC). Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 98 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMCS) Figure 45 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMS CROSS LOADING FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 99 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training For Training Purposes Only NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - BITE PAGES: INTRODUCTION General The FMCS has BITE functions for maintenance and test of the system. The BITE is in the FMC. You operate the BITE with the CDUs. The BITE functions continuously monitor the status of the FMC and CDU. The functions also continuously monitor the status of airplane sensor systems which interface with the FMCS. The monitors operate at all times. This includes power—up. These are the BITE functions: S INFLT FAULTS S CDU TEST S SENSORS S DISCRETES S FMCS — FIXED OUTPUTS S IRS MONITOR S PERF FACTR S SW OPTIONS S MODEL/ENG. INFLT FAULTS The FMCs record their in—flight faults and in—flight faults for the CDUs and the LRUs they interface with. They have storage capacity for nine flights. In addition, the FMCs record their ground faults and ground faults for the CDUs. Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM CDU TEST These are tests of the CDU display and keyboard. SENSORS/DISCRETES The status of the interface LRUs and analog discrete signals show on this page. FMCS — FIXED OUTPUTS Shows the values of outputs that are sent to the components selected on the CDU display. IRS MONITOR This page shows the ADIRU position error rate calculated by the FMC. PERF FACTR This page shows performance codes and performance factors. SW OPTIONS The status of the software option database show here. MODEL/ENG This page shows the status of the airplane model/engine configuration program pins. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 100 B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) Figure 46 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMS BITE INTRODUCTION FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 101 Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - BITE PAGES: BITE ENTRY General You use the INIT/REF INDEX page, line select key (LSK) 6R to show the MAINT BITE INDEX PAGE. Select LSK 1L on the MAINT BITE INDEX PAGE to enter FMCS BITE. On the FMCS BITE page, you select FMC L (FMC 1) or FMC R (FMC 2) as the BITE source. It is possible to select FMC 1 as the BITE source on the left CDU and FMC 2 as the BITE source on the right CDU. In this configuration you can show and compare sensor status for both FMCs. Primary/Secondary FMC Select Data from the BITE source comes through the primary FMC. The arrow direction on the CDUs show which FMC is primary. The example on the graphic shows a left arrow (FMC 1 is the primary FMC). A right arrow shows FMC 2 is the primary FMC. You use the FMCS transfer switch to select the primary FMC. In the NORMAL or BOTH—ON—LEFT position, FMC 1 is the primary FMC. In the BOTH-ON—RIGHT position, FMC 2 is the primary FMC. For Training Purposes Only FMC Download You can use your data loader to copy the file system from a FMC to a diskette. You start the procedure with line select key 6R (FMC DOWNLOAD). See the AMM, FMCS troubleshooting section 34—61, for more information about the data transfer. Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 102 B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) Figure 47 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMS BITE ENTRY FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 103 Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - BITE PAGES: AUTOMATIC BITE ENTRY General At start—up on the ground, the primary and secondary FMC compare this information: S Operational Flight Programs (OP) S Data bases S Analog discretes/program pins S Performance factor. If the information does not agree, the correct BITE page shows automatically. For in flight restarts, the two FMCs also compare their information. If the information does not agree, the secondary FMC stops operation and the message SINGLE FMC OPERATION shows on the CDUs. For Training Purposes Only Ground Start—up If the two OPs do not agree, the primary FMC shows the OP PROGRAM CROSSLOAD page. You use this page to crossload the correct OP. If a database does not agree between the two FMCs, a crossload page for that database shows on the CDU. If an analog discrete/program pin or a performance factor does not agree between the two FMCs, the analog discrete or the performance factor page shows. A highlight shows around the item that does not agree. If you exit BITE before you take corrective action, the secondary FMC stops operation and the message SINGLE FMC OPERATION shows on the CDUs. Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 104 B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) Figure 48 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMS BITE ENTRY AUTOMATIC FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 105 Lufthansa Technical Training For Training Purposes Only NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - BITE PAGES: INFLIGHT FAULTS General To look at in—flight faults, select INFLT FAULT on line select key (LSK) 1L, from the FMCS BITE page. The FMC stores in—flight faults for 9 flight legs and faults that occur on the ground. The FMC can store up to 20 faults for each flight leg. A new flight leg starts when the airplane goes above 20 knots ground speed and goes in the air. The new leg stops when the airplane is on the ground and ground speed goes below 20 knots. Faults that occur on the ground are stored as ground faults. IN FLT FAULTS Page This page shows this information: S Name of the possible LRU S Fault occurred, in flight or on the ground S Flight leg the fault occurred S Fault was recorded by one or both FMCs S Access code for engineering data you set in the scratch pad. All of the LRUs that interface with the FMCS show on the IN FLT FAULTS pages. The LRUs with a possible failure show a letter L (FMC 1), R (FMC 2) or B (FMC 1 and FMC 2) to show the FMC or FMCs that record the fault. If the FMCs did not record a fault for that LRU, no letter shows to the right of the LRU name. The alpha numeric characters at the top of the page show the flight legs. The letter G shows the FMCS recorded the fault on the ground after the last flight leg. The number 1 is the last flight leg. The number 9 is 9 flights ago. To see more details about the possible LRU failures, you can set the access code 300 into the scratch pad and push LSK 6R. The flight select page now shows. Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FLIGHT SELECT Page This page shows a menu of the flight legs. Flight G shows faults that occur on the ground. FLIGHT Page Flight leg faults and ground faults show on these pages. This information shows for each fault: S Possible LRU S Fault description S Fault is steady (S) or intermittent (I) S Time the fault occurred. The ground faults clear from storage after the airplane goes above 20 knots ground speed and goes in the air. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 106 B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) Figure 49 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMS INFLIGHT FAULTS FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 107 Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - BITE PAGES: CDU TEST General To test the CDUs, select CDU TEST on line select key (LSK) 2L, from the FMCS BITE page. The CDU TEST is an interactive self test that shows the CDU characters. It also tests the CDU push buttons and annunciators. FMCS CDU TEST Page On this page you can select the CDU DSPLY TEST (LSK 5R) or the CDU KEY TEST (LSK 5L). FMCS—DSPLY—TEST Page This test shows the complete CDU character set. Push LSK 6L to go back to the FMCS CDU TEST page. For Training Purposes Only FMCS KEY TEST This test displays the CDU faceplate keys on the CDU screens. As you push each key on a keyboard, the CDUs highlight the key on the screen while the scratchpad shows the name of the key you pushed. When you push LSK 6L the second time, the CDU goes back to the FMCS CDU TEST page. When you push the INIT/REF key the second time, the CDU goes back to the INIT/REF page. Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 108 B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) Figure 50 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMS BITE PAGES CDU TEST FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 109 Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - BITE PAGES: SENSORS General To check FMCS sensor status, select SENS0RS on line select key (LSK) 3L, from the FMCS BITE page. Sensor Status Pages The sensor status pages show the current status of the sensors that send data to the FMC selected as the BITE source. If the two FMCs do not agree on the status of an LRU, a highlight shows around the status field for that lRU. In the example shown on the graphic, FMC L and FMC R do not agree on the status of the right VOR. Dashed lines in the status field show the LRU does not exist or the FMC selected as the BITE source does not interface with the LRU. In the example shown on the graphic, the DFCS FCC A is the master FCC and it is the FCC that reports DFCS status to FMC 1 and FMC 2. For Training Purposes Only Sensor Data Pages This page shows engineering data for sensors which have a FAIL status on a SENSOR STATUS page. The faults show in chronological order. To clear the screen, push LSK 6R. After you push the key, only engineering data for faults that occur from the time you push the key will show. The clear key only clears the engineering data for the FMC selected as the BITE source. It does not clear the data for both FMCs. Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 110 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) Figure 51 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMS BITE PAGES, SENSORS FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 111 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - BITE PAGES: DISCRETES General To check FMCS discretes status, select DISCRETES on line select key (LSK) 4L, from the FMCS BITE page. Discretes Pages These pages shows the current status of the analog discretes that send data to the FMC selected as the BITE source. If the two FMCs do not agree on the status of a discrete, a highlight shows around the status field for that discrete. In the example shown on the graphic, FMC 1 does not see the right ECS PACK on. MAKE SURE THAT PERSONS AND EQUIPMENT ARE CLEAR OF THE SLATS BEFORE YOU REMOVE ELECTRICAL POWER FROM THE AIR/GROUND RELAYS. THE SLATS CAN MOVE AUTOMATICALLY WHEN FLAPS ARE IN POSITION 1, 2, OR 5, AND THE NOSE OR MAIN LANDING GEAR AIR/GROUND RELAYS INDICATE AN AIRBORNE CONDITION. THIS CAN CAUSE INJURY TO PERSONS OR DAMAGE TO EQUIPMENT. For Training Purposes Only WARNING: Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 112 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) Figure 52 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMS BITE PAGES, DISCRETES FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 113 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - BITE PAGES: FMCS FIXED OUTPUTS General To check FMCS fixed output status, select FMCS—FIXED OUTS on line select key (LSK) 5L, from the FMCS BITE page. The navigation control panels must be set to the MAP mode. FMCS FIXED OUTPUTS Page 1/2 This page shows FMCS data that goes to the thrust mode annunciation (TMA) on the engine display. The thrust modes show in sequence on the TMA. The word ON shows on the CDUs as each mode comes into view on the FMA. For Training Purposes Only FMCS FIXED OUTPUTS Page 2/2 When you select this page, these annunciators on the CDUs come on until you exit the page: S MSG S FAIL S CALL S OFST. Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 114 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) Figure 53 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMS BITE PAGES, FIXED OUTPUTS FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 115 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - BITE PAGES: IRS MONITOR General To check the IRS position error rate, select IRS MONITOR on line select key (LSK) 5R, from the FMCS BITE page. IRS MONITOR Page The position error rate (nautical miles per hour) for each IRS shows on this page. The FMCS calculates the position error rate for each flight. It divides the difference between the FMCS position and IRS position by the total flight time. The FMCS calculates the error rate at the end of each flight. The error rate does not show in—flight. The error rate does not show for an IRS that is not aligned in the NAV mode or is in the attitude mode. For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 116 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) The error rate does not show for an IRS that is not aligned in the NAV mode or is in the attitude mode. Figure 54 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMS BITE PAGES, IRS MONITOR FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 117 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training For Training Purposes Only NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - BITE PAGES: PERFORMANCE FACTORS General To check FMCS performance factors, select PERF FACTR on line select key (LSK) 4R, from the FMCS BITE page. PERFormance FACTORS Page The aerodynamic and engine models in the performance data base are from airplane design and flight test data. Since each production airplane may be different, the FMCS PERF FACTORS page lets the operator make adjustments for these factors. Some factors cannot be set on this page. They are set with the performance database. To set a new factor, put the word ARM in the scratch pad and LSK 6R. Put the new factor in the scratch pad and Line select the applicable key. If the two FMCs do not agree on the value for a performance factor, the factor is highlighted. In the example shown on the graphic, FMC 2 does not agree with the value for the engine out minimum rate of climb. These are the performance factors: S DRAG FACTOR (range is +/- 9.9 percent) S F — F (fuel flow factor) (range is +/- 9.9 percent) S MNVR MARGIN (maneuver margin) (range is set in the performance data base) S MIN CRZ TIME (minimum cruise time) (range is 1 to 20 minutes) S MIN R/C (minimum rate—of—climb for climb, cruise and engine out conditions) (range is 0—999 for climb and cruise and 0—500 for engine out). Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 118 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) Figure 55 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMS BITE PAGES, PERFORMANCE FACTORS FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 119 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - BITE PAGES: SOFTWARE OPTIONS General To show the FMCS software options, select SW OPTIONS on Line select key (LSK) 3R, from the FMCS BITE page. Software OPTION Pages The software option pages show the status of the options that are in the software options database. The graphics show pages with example options. The navigation data base (NDB) size is 1 meg words. These are the software options your airline selected (if no software options show here, your airline did not select any options): To find your option code add each column in the software code (start with the left column). For example, if you have these options: S High idle descent—(00000001) S GPS with integrity—(00000000) S GPSSU installation—(00000100) S Manual RNP entry—(00000200). Your code is 000003C1. If your airline did not select any software options, your code is 00000000. The software option code is a 12 digit hex code. The first four zeros are not shown here. For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 120 B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) Figure 56 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMS BITE PAGES, SOFTWARE OPTIONS FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 121 Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - BITE PAGES: AIRPL. MODEL, ENGINE CONFIG. General The model/engine configuration page shows the airplane and engine configuration. To access this page, select MODEL/ENG (line select key 1R), from the FMCS BITE page. For Training Purposes Only FMC MODEL/ENG Pages A normal display shows when the program pin connections match the data in the performance database. If there is a non normal condition, one of these messages show on the CDUs: S PARITY ERROR S INVALID S PROGRAM PIN NOT IN MODEL/ENGINE DATA BASE. The message PARITY ERROR shows if the program pins are not set to odd parity. INVALID shows if a performance database is not installed and there is not a parity error. PROGRAM PIN NOT IN MODEL/ENGINE DATA BASE shows if the program pins do not match the data in the performance database and there is not a parity error. Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 122 B737-600/700/800 34-61 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) Figure 57 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMS BITE PAGES, AC-CONFIG. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 123 Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - LCD BITE PAGES: INTRODUCTION GENERAL To see the CDU MAINT BITE INDEX page, use the LCD CDU prompt (LSK 5R) on the FMCS BITE INDEX page. The CDU MAINT BITE INDEX page has these CDU maintenance categories: S FAULTS S KEY TEST S COLOR TEST S DISPLAY TEST S CONFIG S SOFTWARE OPTIONS S POWER SUPPLY (P/S) S TEMPERATURE S LIGHT S LAMP TEST S CALIBRATION. For Training Purposes Only NOTE: Power supply, temperature, light, lamp test, and calibration are used primarily for bench test of the CDU. The EXIT prompt (LSK 6L) selects the FMCS BITE INDEX page. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 124 Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) LT < I NF L T < CDU F MC S B737-600/700/800 34-61 BI TE MO D E L / E N G > F AUL T T E S T S W OP TI ONS > < S E NS OR S P E RF < DI S CRE TE S I RS < F I XE D 1 / 1 OUT P UT S F ACT R> MO N I T R > L CD CDU> < I NDE X C DU MA I N T BI TE S W < F AUL T S < KE Y For Training Purposes Only < C ONF I G Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM P / S > T E MP > T E S T < DI S P L AY Figure 58 OPT I ONS > T E S T < C OLO R < E XI T I NDEX L I GHT > T E S T L AMP T E S T > C AL I B RAT I ON> FMCS BITE PAGES - LCD CDU FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 125 Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - LCDU BITE PAGES: FAULTS General To see the CDU faults page, first select FAULTS on line select key (LSK) 1L from the CDU MAINT BITE INDEX page. This selects the CDU BITE DISPLY INDEX page. For Training Purposes Only CDU BITE DISPLAY INDEX Page This page shows the fault history for the last ten full power-up cycles. When no faults are recorded during a cycle, the data field is blank. To see the fault data for a specific cycle, select that line select key. This selects the CDU BITE DISPLAY page for that power up cycle. Line select key 6L shows the INDEX prompt. This selects the CDU MAINT BITE INDEX page. CDU BITE DISPLAY Page This page shows the fault data for a specific cycle. Up to a maximum of five faults are recorded per cycle. The header shows the cycle number. This data shows for each fault: S Failed unit S Failure description S Fault state S Failure frequency S Failure time S Extended fault code. The failed unit can show FMC, CDU, or USER 1-5 where USER is an airplane sub-system. These are the failure descriptions that can show: S PROCESSOR S WATCHDOG TIMER S 429 FAULT S ANNUN FAULT S LCD S KEYBOARD S MEMORY S R/C TIMER (resistor/capacitor) S POWER SUPPLY S LIGHT SENSOR S ADC (analog to digital converter) S TEMP SENSOR S FMC FAULT S SUB-SYSTEM FAULT S EDC (error detection and correction logic) S SOFTWARE FAULT S FONTROM (read only memory). The fault state shows if the fault is steady (S) or intermittent (I). All faults are initially recorded as a steady fault. If the fault later goes away, the indication changes to intermittent. The failure frequency shows the number of times the fault occurs. The failure time shows the CDU elapsed time indication when the fault first occurred. The extended fault code is used by shop personnel only. Line select key 6L shows the INDEX prompt. This selects the CDU MAINT BITE INDEX page. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 126 Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) C DU MA I N T 34-61 BI T E SW < F A UL T S < KEY B737-600/700/800 I NDE X < EXI T I NDE X 0 1 CY CL E 0 6 > P/ S> < CYCL E 0 2 CY CL E 0 7 > T E MP > < CYCL E 0 3 CY CL E 0 8 > L I GH T > < CYCL E 0 4 CY CL E 0 9 > CY CL E 1 0 > TEST < CONF I G DS PL Y < CYCL E TEST < DI SP L A Y BI T OP T I ON S > T EST < COL O R CDU L A MP TEST> < I NDEX CA L I BRA T I ON> EXTENDED FAULT CODE CDU FAILED UNIT BI T CY CL E For Training Purposes Only FAILURE DESCRIPTION CDU L I GH T 0 9 S E NS OR DI S P L A Y F AUL T S S 1 5 7 0 2 1 6 . 0 FAULT STATE FAILURE FREQUENCY FAILURE TIME < I N D EX Figure 59 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMCS BITE PAGES - LCD CDU FAULTS FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 127 Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - LCDU BITE PAGES: KEY TEST General To see the CDU KEY TEST page, select KEY TEST on LSK 2L from the CDU MAINT BITE INDEX page. Key Test Page This page shows the test displays for the MCDU faceplate keys on the MCDU screens. As you push each key on the keyboard, the corresponding character set will be highlighted (shaded white) on the CDU screen. Push the same key again to return the character set to normal. For Training Purposes Only Line select key 6L shows the INDEX prompt. This selects the CDU MAINT BITE INDEX page. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 128 Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) CD U MA I N T B737-600/700/800 34-61 BI T E SW < FAU L T S < KE Y I NDE X OP T I ON S > TEST < CO L O R TEST < DI S P L A Y < CO N F I G < EX I T P/ S> T E MP > L I GH T > T EST L A MP TEST > CA L I B RA T I ON> C DU For Training Purposes Only 1 2 3 4 5 6 Figure 60 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM I NI R ME N L N1 F PRV N L L 1 2 3 L 4 5 6 L 7 8 9 L . 0 + L - - - PUS < I NDE X TE EG I X EX H KE Y T ES T CL B DEP C RZ H OL A B CD F GHI K L MN P QRS U V WX Z D/ 1 / 1 DES P RO E J O T Y C EXE 1 2 3 4 5 6 KEYS T O TEST- - - ( P U S H T WI C E ) R R R R R R FMCS BITE PAGES - LCD CDU KEY TEST FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 129 Lufthansa Technical Training For Training Purposes Only NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - LCDU BITE PAGES: COLOR TEST General To see the CDU color test page, select COLOR TEST on LSK 3L from the CDU MAINT BITE INDEX page. Color Test Page Line 1L shows the RED prompt. This selects a full screen display of the color red. Line 2L shows the GREEN prompt. This selects a full screen display of the color green. Line 3L shows the BLUE prompt. This selects a full screen display of the color blue. Line 4L shows the AMBER prompt. This selects a full screen display of the color amber. Line 5L shows the MAGENTA prompt. This selects a full screen display of the color magenta. Line 6L shows the INDEX prompt. This selects the CDU MAINT BITE INDEX page. Line 1R shows the CYAN prompt. This selects a full screen display of the color cyan. Line 2R shows the WHITE prompt. This selects a full screen display of the color white. Line 3R shows the GRAY SCALE prompt. This selects a display of the eight brightness levels for the gray scale. Line 4R shows the CHECKERBOARD prompt. This selects a full screen display of a black and white checkerboard pattern. Push the LSK a second time to return the MCDU screen to normal. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 130 Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) CD U MAI N T B737-600/700/800 34-61 BI TE SW < FAUL TS < KEY I NDE X OPT I ONS > P/ S> TE ST < C OL O R TEST < DI S P L A Y < C ON F I G < EXI T T E MP > L I GHT > T E ST L A MP T EST > CA L I B RA T I ON> CDU C O L OR T EST < RED CYAN> For Training Purposes Only < GRE E N < BL UE < A MB E R 1 / 1 WH I T E > GRA Y SCAL E> CH E CK E R B OA RD > < MA G E N T A < I NDE X Figure 61 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMCS BITE PAGES - LCD CDU COLOR TEST FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 131 Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - LCDU BITE PAGES: DISPLAY TEST General To see the CDU display test page, select the DISPLAY TEST prompt on LSK 4L from the MAINT BITE INDEX page. Display Test Page This page shows the complete MCDU character set. Selection of the PREV PAGE or NEXT PAGE pushbuttons steps the display through the next seven pages. Each page shows one of the seven colors. For Training Purposes Only Line 6L shows the INDEX prompt. This selects the CDU MAINT BITE INDEX page. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 132 Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) CD U MAI N T B737-600/700/800 34-61 B I T E I NDE X S W OP T I ON S > < FAUL TS < KEY < C OL O R TEST < DI S P L A Y < C ON F I G < EXI T P/ S> TEST T E MP > L I GH T > TE ST L A MP TEST> C A L I B RA T I ON> - - - - CD U - D S P L Y - T E S T - - 1 / X > > For Training Purposes Only #& 0123456 789 ! ” F % \ ’ ( ) * +, - . / 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 : ; <= > ? A B C D E F G H I J K L MN O P Q R S T U V A B C D E F G H I J K L MN O P WX Y Z [ ] Q R S T U V WX Y Z # & ! F ” \ ] % C’ ( ) * + , - . / : ; < = > ? [ < I ND E X - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - FMCS - TRAINING INFORMATION POINT - CDU BITE PAGES - DISPLAY TEST Figure 62 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMCS BITE PAGES - LCD CDU DISPLAY TEST FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 133 Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - LCDU BITE PAGES: CONFIG General To see the CDU CONFIGURATION page, select CONFIG on LSK 5L from the CDU MAINT BITE INDEX page. Configuration Page The CDU CONFIGURATION page shows this information: S Software part number S Operating mode (CDU, MCDU, or FANS MCDU) S Location (left or right) S Elapsed time indicator S CDU serial number. For Training Purposes Only Line 6L shows the INDEX prompt. This selects the CDU MAINT BITE INDEX page. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 134 Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) MA I N T C DU B737-600/700/800 34-61 BI T E SW < F A UL T S < KEY OP T I ON S > P/ S> T EST < C OL O R TEST < DI SP L A Y < C ONF I G < EXI T I NDE X T E MP > L I GH T > TEST L A MP TEST> CA L I BRA T I ON> CD U For Training Purposes Only S OF T 3 46 3 CDU MC D U CDU RI GHT ETI 1 2 9 SERI 0 91 7 C ON F I G U R A T I O N WA R E P / N S MI - 0 0 1 - 0 2 MODE L OCA T I ON HRS . 6 A L NO < I NDE X Figure 63 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMCS BITE PAGES - LCD CDU CONFIG FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 135 Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - LCDU BITE PAGES: SW OPTIONS General To see the software options page, select SW OPTIONS on LSK 1R from the CDU MAINT BITE INDEX page. Software Options Page The software option page shows the status of the options that are in the CDU software options database. The software option code is an eight-digit hexadecimal number. These option codes are available: S No option code - 00000000 S Switching mode - 00000001 S ARINC 739 color usage - 00000002 S Switching mode & ARINC 739 color usage - 00000003. The enabled options show at line 3L. If there are no option codes enabled, NONE shows. For Training Purposes Only Line 6L shows the INDEX prompt. This selects the CDU MAINT BITE INDEX page. Line 6R allows the entry of the word ARM. This is a necessary entry to enable software option entry on this page. After you enter ARM and push LSK 6R, you may enter the new software option into the scratch pad and line select it to the option code (LSK 1R). NOTE: When you enter an option code, all eight digits must be entered. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 136 Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 CDU SW OPT I ONS 1/ 1 OP T I ON CODE 00 0 00 00 0 CDU MAI NT BI TE I NDEX SW OPT I ONS > < FAUL TS < KEY TE ST ENA B L E D OP T I ONS P/ S > < COL OR T EST NONE T EMP > < DI S P L A Y T E ST L I GHT > L A MP T EST > < CONF I G < EXI T < I NDEX CAL I BRAT I ON> -- - OR CDU SW OPT I ONS CDU SW OPT I ONS CDU SW OPT I ONS E NA B L ED OP T I ONS E NA B L ED OP T I ONS E NA B L E D OPT I ONS For Training Purposes Only S WI T CHI NG MODE < I NDE X - -- Figure 64 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM 1/ 1 OPT I ON CODE 0 000 0 0 03 1/ 1 OP T I ON CODE 0 0 00 00 0 2 1/ 1 OP T I ON CODE 00000001 A RI NC 7 3 9 CO L OR U S AGE S WI T CHI NG MOD E A RI NC 7 3 9 COL OR US AGE < I NDE X < I N DE X - - - - -- FMCS BITE PAGES - LCD CDU SW OPTIONS FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 137 Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - LCDU BITE PAGES: POWER SUPPLY General To see the CDU power supply page, select P/S on LSK 2R from the CDU MAINT BITE INDEX page. Power Supply Page This page shows the voltage levels from the MCDU power supply. These voltages come the power supply: S +5v dc S +12v dc S -12v dc S +26v dc S +28v dc S Switched +28v dc S Annunciator +5v dc. NOTE: The switched 28v dc power supply is only active when the CDU heater is on and the voltage will be displayed. If the heater is off, the data field will be blank. For Training Purposes Only Line 6L shows the INDEX prompt. This selects the CDU MAINT BITE INDEX page. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 138 Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) CD U MA I N T 34-61 BI T E I NDE X SW OP T I ON S > < FAUL TS < KEY B737-600/700/800 P/ S> TEST < C OL O R TEST < DI S P L A Y T E MP > L I GHT > T E ST < C ON F I G < EXI T L A MP T EST > CA L I B RA T I ON> P/ S S E N S O RS S E N S OR For Training Purposes Only + + + + S A 5 1 2 1 2 2 6 2 8 W_ 2 8 NNUN VA L UE XX XX XX XX XX XX XX . . . . . . . X X X X X X X X X X X X X X V V V V V V V < I NDEX Figure 65 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMCS BITE PAGES - LCD CDU PWR SUPPLY FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 139 Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - LCDU BITE PAGES: TEMP SENSORS General To see the CDU TEMP SENSORS page, select TEMP on LSK 3R from the CDU MAINT BITE INDEX page. Temperature Sensors Page This page shows the temperature values from the sensors in the LCD module and the backlight assembly. It also shows the operational status of the thermal electric coolers (TEC) and the heater. For Training Purposes Only Line 6L shows the INDEX prompt. This selects the CDU MAINT BITE INDEX page. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 140 Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) CDU MA I N T BI T E SW < F AUL T S < KEY B737-600/700/800 34-61 I NDEX OP T I ON S > P/ S> TEST < COL O R T EST < DI S P L A Y T E MP > L I GH T > T E ST < CON F I G < EXI T L A MP T EST > CA L I B RA T I ON> For Training Purposes Only T E MP S EN S OR S S E NS OR L C D _ T E MP _ R L C D _ T E MP _ C VAL UE O | XX . XX C O | XX . XX C BK BK O | XX . XX C O | XX . XX C L I GHT L I GHT R H T E C MO D E T E C C MD HEAT ER < I NDE X Figure 66 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM COOL XXX OF F FMCS BITE PAGES - LCD CDU TEMP SENSORS FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 141 Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - LCDU BITE PAGES: LIGHT SENSORS General To see the CDU LIGHT SENSORS page, select LIGHT on LSK 4R from the CDU MAINT BITE INDEX page. Light Sensors Page This page shows the voltage levels from the MCDU light sensors. For Training Purposes Only Line 6L shows the INDEX prompt. This selects the CDU MAINT BITE INDEX page. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 142 Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) CD U MA I N T 34-61 BI T E INDEX SW OP T I ON S > < F AUL T S < KEY B737-600/700/800 T EST < C OL O R P/ S> T EST < DI S P L AY T E MP > L I GHT > T E ST < C ON F I G < EXI T L A MP T EST > CA L I BRA T I ON> L I GHT S E N S OR S S E NS OR V AL UE XXXX . XF C XXX . X% For Training Purposes Only A MB I E N T L T D I MME R P OT D S A A E P R R S L UM OT BRT C HI GH C L OW X X X X X X X X . X X X X X X X ( ( ( ( F F H H T T E E X X L ) L ) ) ) < INDE X Figure 67 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMCS BITE PAGES - LCD CDU LIGHT SENSORS FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 143 Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - LCDU BITE PAGES: LAMP TEST General To see the CDU lamp test page, select LAMP TEST on LSK 5R from the CDU MAINT BITE INDEX page. Lamp Test Page This page does a test of the MCDU annunciators. The message ANNUNCIATORS ALL LT shows on the CDU and these annunciators come on: S CALL S FAIL S MSG S OFST S EXEC. For Training Purposes Only Line 6L shows the INDEX prompt. This selects the CDU MAINT BITE INDEX page and the annunciators go out. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 144 Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) MA I N T CDU BI T E SW < F AUL T S < KEY B737-600/700/800 34-61 I N DE X OP T I ON S > T EST < COL O R P/ S> T ES T < DI SP L AY T E MP > L I GHT > T E ST < CONF I G < EXI T L A MP T E S T > CAL I BRA T I ON> For Training Purposes Only CDU L A MP T ES T A NN U NC I A T O RS AL L L I T < I N DE X Figure 68 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMCS BITE PAGES - LCD CDU LAMP TEST FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 145 Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 FMCS - LCDU BITE PAGES: CALIBRATION General To see the CDU calibration page, select CALIBRATION on line select key (LSK) 6R from the CDU MAINT BITE INDEX page. Calibration Page This page shows the current deflection voltages and calibration factors for the LCD module. It also shows the light sensor bias level and the scale factor used. The scratchpad shows the source of the currently used data. If the software uses calibrated data, then CALIBRATED will be shown. If it uses hardcoded defaults, then DEFAULTS will be shown. For Training Purposes Only Line select key 6L shows the INDEX prompt. This selects the CDU MAINT BITE INDEX page. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 146 Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) C DU MA I N T BI T E SW < F A UL T S < KEY B737-600/700/800 34-61 I NDEX OP T I ON S > T E ST < COL O R P/ S> T ES T < DI SP L A Y T E MP > L I GH T > T E ST < C ONF I G < EXI T L A MP T ES T > CAL I BRA T I ON> For Training Purposes Only CDU C A L I B RAT I O N GS DE F L T RI M OO 1 6 3 2 4 8 6 3 VC V E X. X. X. X. X. X. X. X. X. X. X. X. X. X. X X X X X X X V V V V V V V X X X X X X X V V V V V V V L T SE NS B I A S X X X X MV SCA L E FA CT OR X . X X X < I NDE X C A L I B R A T ED Figure 69 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FMCS BITE PAGES - LCD CDU CALIBRATION FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 147 B737-600/700/800 34-61 THE FOLLOWING PAGE IS FOR REFERENCE ONLY! For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 148 Lufthansa Technical Training NAVIGATION FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM (FMS) B737-600/700/800 34-61 115V AC BUS 1 BUS 2 BUS 4 BUS 5 BUS 6 BUS 7 BUS 8 115V AC VOR 2 DME 1 VOR/MB ILS 2 DME 1 2 4 5 6 7 8 BUS 1 28V DC UPLINK XFER RLY DISCRETE CLOCK 1 C BUS 7 BUS 8 B DEU 2 FCC A GPWC DEU 1 FDAU A ADR 4 CLOCK BUS 4 BUS 6 BUS 2 BUS 5 BUS 6 GPS 1/2 MMR A/T COMP BUS 2 XFR RLY 1 SMYD 1 FMC 1/2 IR 3 ADIRU HGS (OPTION) FAIL WARN DME 1 115V AC DEU-FMC CDU 1 FAIL WARN A/T COMP ELT (OPTION) 115V AC A/T 1 DEU CAP NAV C/P B MCP 3 FQPU CDU 1 DFCS MCP ACARS MU FQPU 5 FQPU DIU (OPTION) BUS 1 CDU 2 DLDR 1 XFER RLY DISCRETE LOAD ENABLE C DATA LOADER CONTROL PANEL For Training Purposes Only ENG 2 BLEED AIR SWITCH ENGINE 2 ANTICE SW RIGHT PACK VALVE RIGHT PACK A/C RELAY FCC B FDAU BUS 2 1 BUS 1 2 BUS 2 ENG 1 BLEED AIR SWITCH ON/OFF ENGINE 1 ANTICE SW ON/OFF LEFT PACK VALVE OPEN/CLOSE LEFT PACK A/C RELAY WING ANTICE A/C ISOL VALVE ON/OFF SMYD 2 28V DC ON/OFF DME 2 OPEN/CLOSE OFF/HIGH/ CDU 1 OR AUTO PORTABLE OFF/HIGH/ AUTO BUS 9 ON/OFF FMC MESSAGE FMC FAIL OPEN/CLOSE PROG SW MOD PROG SW MOD FMC 2 FMC 1 Figure 70 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM XFR RLY 2 F/O NAV C/P DEU 2 FMC MESSAGE FMC FAIL FMC FAIL FMC MESSAGE RESET A PORTABLE CDU DEU 1 FMC CONFIG OPTIONS IFSAU INTERSYSTEM BUS 28V DC OPTIONS BITE PRINTER RECEPTACLE FMC WARN RESET CAPT ASA 28V DC FMC WARN RESET F/O ASA FMCS - SYSTEM SUMMARY FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 149 Lufthansa Technical Training For Training Purposes Only AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM B737-600/700/800 22-23 22-23 YAW DAMPER SYSTEM ABBREVIATIONS AND ACRONYMS AC ADR ADIRU AOA ARINC BITE CAA CDS CPU DC DEU DFCS EHSV FAA FMC IR I/O LRU LVDT MCP N1 NN PCU SMYD V WTRIS YDS — alternating current — air data reference — air data inertial reference unit — angle of attack — Aeronautical Radio Incorporated — built in test equipment — Civil Aviation Authority — common display system — central processing unit — direct current — display electronic unit — digital flight control system — electrohydraulic servo valve — Federal Aviation Administration — flight management computer — inertial reference — input/output — line replaceable unit — linear variable differential transformer — mode control panel — Low pressure rotor speed — a number from 01 to 99 — power control unit — stall management yaw damper — volts — wheel to rudder interconnect system — yaw damper system Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM YAW DAMPER SYSTEM (YDS) - INTRODUCTION Purpose The yaw damper system keeps the airplane stable around the yaw axis. When in flight, the yaw damper commands rudder movement in proportion to, and opposite to, the yawing moment. This keeps dutch roll to a minimum and makes the flight smoother. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 150 B737-600/700/800 22-23 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM Figure 71 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM YAW DAMPER (YD) INTRODUCTION FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 151 Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM B737-600/700/800 22-23 YDS - GENERAL DESCRIPTION General The yaw damper system moves the rudder to oppose dutch roll. The system is available for the full flight. The yaw damper system consists of these components: S Yaw damper engage switch S Yaw damper disengage light S Stall management yaw dampers (SMYD 1 + 2) S Yaw damper indicator S Solenoid valve (main rudder PCU) S Electrohydraulic servo valve (main rudder PCU) S LVDT (main rudder PCU). ADIRU The air data inertial reference units send airspeed and inertial reference data to the SMYD. Yaw Damper Engage Switch and Disengage Light You engage the yaw damper system with a switch on the flight control panel. When you engage the yaw damper, the B-Hydraulic system should be ON. This is not a precondition for holding the Yaw Damper switch in the ON position. The disengage warning light is above the switch. The light shows if the yaw damper is not engaged while power is on the airplane. For Training Purposes Only Stall Management Yaw Damper The SMYD 1 controls the primary yaw damping function and the stall management function. SMYD 1 receives data from both ADIRUs and sends commands to the main rudder PCU. Yaw Damper Indicator The yaw damper indicator, on the P2 panel, shows rudder movement due to the yaw damper Main Rudder PCU The main rudder power control unit (PCU) is a hydraulic component that moves the rudder. It receives commands from the SMYD 1 to decrease unwanted yaw motion. Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 152 Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM B737-600/700/800 22-23 HYDRAULIK SYSTEM A For Training Purposes Only HYDRAULIK SYSTEM B Figure 72 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM YD GENERAL DESCRIPTION FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 153 Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM B737-600/700/800 22-23 YDS - COCKPIT COMPONENT LOCATIONS Engage Switch and Disengage Light The yaw damper engage switch and the disengage light are on the flight control panel (P5 forward overhead panel) For Training Purposes Only Yaw Damper Indicator The yaw damper indicator is on the P2 panel Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 154 B737-600/700/800 22-23 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM Figure 73 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM YD COMPONENT LOCATION FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 155 B737-600/700/800 22-23 YDS - E+E COMPARTMENT COMP. LOCATIONS Stall Management Yaw Damper The SMYD 1 is on the E3—2 shelf in the electronic equipment compartment. For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 156 B737-600/700/800 22-23 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM Figure 74 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM YD COMPONENT LOCATION FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 157 B737-600/700/800 22-23 YDS - VERTICAL STABILIZER COMP. LOCATIONS Solenoid and Electrohydraulic Servo Valve The YPS has two LRUs in the vertical stabilizer. The yaw damper solenoid valve and the electrohydraulic servo valve (EHSV) are mounted on the main rudder PCU. In addition to the LRUs, there is a linear variable differential transformer (LVDT) that is mounted on the main PCU. The LVDT is not an LRU. You access these components from the right side of the vertical stabilizer For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 158 B737-600/700/800 22-23 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM Figure 75 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM YD COMPONENT LOCATION FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 159 Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM B737-600/700/800 22-23 SMYD 1 - YDS: INTERFACES Power The SMYD 1 gets 28v dc from electrical bus 1 and 28v ac from transfer bus 1. 28v dc power goes from SMYD 1 to the engage switch. The yaw damper indicator gets 115v ac from transfer bus 1. The LVDT gets 28v ac from the same circuit as the SMYD 1. For Training Purposes Only Digital Data The SMYD 1 gets this data from the ADIRUs: S Airspeed (ADIRU 1 only) S Impact pressure (ADIRU 1 only) S Lateral acceleration S Roll angle S Roll rate S Yaw rate. Analog Signals The SMYD 1 sends yaw damper commands to the main rudder PCU. The LVDT on the main rudder PCU sends rudder position feedback, due to yaw damping, to the yaw damper indicator and the SMYD 1. The trailing edge flap limit switch sends flap position data to the SMYD 1. The AOA sensor sends angle of attack information to the SMYD 1. When you close the yaw damper engage switch, it sends an engage signal through SMYD 1 to the actuator solenoid on the main rudder PCU. Power goes from the DC power and dim control to the yaw damper disengage light. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 160 Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM B737-600/700/800 22-23 115V AC XFER BUS 1 YAW DAMPER 28V AC XFER BUS 1 LVDT-Y AW DAMPER YAW DAMPER 28V DC ELEX BUS 1 RUDDER POSITION RUDDER FEEDBACK ELECTROHYDRAULIC SERVO VALVE YAW DAMPER COMMAND SIGNAL P18 CIRCUIT BREAKER PANEL AIRSPEED IMPACT PRESSURE LATERAL ACC ROLL ANGLE ROLL RATE YAW RATE LATERAL ACC ROLL ANGLE ROLL RATE YAW RATE 28 V DC POWER ENGAGE COMMAND SOLENOID VALVE YAW DAMPER INDICATOR MAIN RUDDER PCU ADIRU 1 ENGAGE ENABLE ENGAGE SWITCH SOLENOID POWER ENGAGE SIGNAL ENGAGE REQUEST - - - - - - - - - - YD DISENGAGE LIGHT POWER GROSS WEIGHT FLIGHT CONTROL PANEL DC POWER AND DIM CONTROL ADIRU 2 FMC For Training Purposes Only ANGLE OF AIRFLOW SMYD CROSSCHANNEL BUS LEFT AOA SENSOR FLAPS UP SMYD 2 SMYD 1 NOTE: THE SHADOWED AREAS ARE NOT FOR YAW DAMPING ! TRAILING EDGE FLAPS UP LIMIT SWITCH NOTE: THIS DIAGRAM ONLY SHOWS INTERFACES FOR PRIMARY YAW DAMPING Figure 76 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM YD INTERFACES FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 161 Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM B737-600/700/800 22-23 SYMD 2: YD - INTERFACES Power SMYD 2 gets 28v dc from DC bus 1 and 28v ac from transfer bus 1. 28v dc power goes from SMYD 2 to the yaw damper engage switch. The linear variable differential transformer (LVDT) on the standby rudder PCU gets 28v ac from the same circuit as SMYD 2. For Training Purposes Only Digital Data SMYD 2 receives airplane gross weight from the FMC. SMYD 2 receives these air data from the right ADIRU: S Airspeed S Impact pressure. SMYD 2 receives these inertial data from the left and right ADIRUs: - Lateral acceleration - Roll angle - Roll rate - Yaw rate. Analog Signals SMYD 2 sends commands to the standby rudder PCU to assist turns during flight control manual reversion, and for standby yaw damping/turn coordination. The LVDT on the standby rudder PCU sends rudder position data to SMYD 2 about rudder movement. The trailing edge flaps up limit switches send flaps up/not up data to SMYD 2 to limit rudder movement when the flaps are up. Power goes from the DC power and dim control to the yaw damper disengage light. During standby hydraulic operations, when you turn ON the yaw damper engage switch, an engage signal goes through SMYD 2 to the yaw damper solenoid valve on the standby rudder PCU to engage the yaw damper. SMYD 2 commands rudder movement using the standby EHSV. The flight control panel switches for system A and B must be in the OFF or STBY RUD position to enable SMYD 2 for WTRIS and standby yaw damping. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 162 Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM B737-600/700/800 22-23 28V AC XFR BUS 1 YAW DAMPER CONTROL WHEEL POSITION 28V DC BUS 1 YAW DAMPER CAPT CONTROL WHEEL POSITION SENSOR P6-1 CB PANEL AIRSPEED IMPACT PRESSURE RUDDER FEEDBACK LATERAL ACC ROLL ANGLE ROLL RATE YAW RATE COMMAND SIGNALS LATERAL ACC ROLL ANGLE ROLL RATE YAW RATE RIGHT ADIRU 28V DC POWER ENGAGE COMMAND LVDT YAW DAMPER RUDDER POSITION EHSV SOLENOID VALVE STANDBY RUDDER PCU LEFT ADIRU ENGAGE ENABLE ENGAGE SIGNAL GROSS WEIGHT For Training Purposes Only FMC FLAP POSITION LEFT FLAP POSITION XMTR POWER FLAPS UP SMYD 2 NOTE: THE SHADOWED INPUTS ARE NOT FOR YAW DAMPING TRAILING EDGE FLAPS UP LIMIT SWITCHES Figure 77 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM YD ENGAGE REQUEST - - - - - - - - - YD DISENGAGE LIGHT FLIGHT CONTROL PANEL ANGLE-OF-AIRFLOW RIGHT AOA SENSOR SWITCH SOLENOID POWER NOTE: THIS DIAGRAM ONLY SHOWS INTERFACES FOR PRIMARY YAW DAMPING DC POWER AND DIM CONTROL SMYD 2 - YD INTERFACES FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 163 Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM B737-600/700/800 22-23 YDS - OPERATIONS General There is only one control for the dual yaw damper system. This is the ON/OFF switch on the flight control panel in the flight compartment. There are two displays for the yaw damper system: - the yaw damper warning light and - the yaw damper indicator. The yaw damper warning light is on the flight control panel above the yaw damper ON/OFF switch. The yaw damper indicator shows yaw damper movement. For Training Purposes Only Engage Switch and Warning Light With the B hydraulic system ON, you engage the yaw damper system No.1 with the ON / OFF switch on the flight control panel. To engage the YDS, put the switch in the ON position. If there are no faults, two seconds later the yaw damper warning light will go out. The switch is held in the ON position electronically. Put the switch in the OFF position to disengage the YDS. The yaw damper warning light will come on. The warning light comes on anytime the system disengages. Yaw Damper Indicator The yaw damper indicator shows yaw damper movement The yaw damper moves the rudder a maximum of 2 degrees with flaps up, and 2 1/2 degrees with flaps down, in each direction to reduce dutch roll. The yaw damper indicator shows this rudder motion, but the rudder pedals do not move. Moving the rudder by pressing the rudder pedals does not move the indicator. To test the indicator and the yaw damper system, do the servo test described on the SMYD BITE — GROUND TEST pageset at the end of this section. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 164 B737-600/700/800 22-23 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM Figure 78 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM YD OPERATIONS FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 165 Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM B737-600/700/800 22-23 YDS - OPERATIONS: ENGAGE INTERLOCKS General There are two SMYDs on the airplane. SMYD 1 controls primary yaw damping and turn coordination during normal operation. SMYD 2 operates WTRIS and standby yaw damping, and is discussed in the WTRIS section.(AMM PART 1, 27-24) These functions in SMYD 2 are activated by pin programming at the E/E shelf. SMYDs The two SMYDs are the same. They both do stall management and yaw damper functions. For stall management functions, both SMYDs operate together. If one function fails, the other SMYD will continue to do stall management functions. For Training Purposes Only Only one SMYD does yaw damping at a time. SMYD 1 does only primary yaw damping during normal operations. SMYD 2 does standby yaw damping during standby operations. This is controlled by the FLT CONTROL A and B switches on the flight control panel. SMYD 1 uses the main rudder PCU to move the rudder for the primary yaw damper function. For primary yaw damping, SMYD 1 compares its yaw damping calculations with SMYD 2 before it sends a command to the main rudder PCU. If the SMYD 2 calculations disagree or if SMYD 2 fails, the yaw damper function in SMYD 1 disengages even though SMYD 2 is not used for primary yaw damping. When the SMYD is in the number 2 position it uses the standby rudder PCU for standby yaw damper functions. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM SMYD 1: YD Engage Switch and Warning Light You engage the primary yaw damper system (YDS) with the yaw damper engage switch on the flight control panel and with the FLT CONTROL B switch in the ON position. The SMYD does a self check and two seconds later the yaw damper warning light goes out to show that you have yaw damper operation. The switch is held in the ON position electronically with power from the SMYD. Put the switch in the OFF position to disengage the YDS. After you put the switch to the OFF position, the yaw damper warning light comes on. The warning light comes on anytime the system disengages. SMYD 2: YD Engage Switch and Warning Light You engage the standby yaw damper system (YDS) with the - yaw damper engage switch on the flight control panel in the ON position and - with both FLT CONTROL switches not in ON position and at least one in the STANDBY position. The SMYD does a self check and two seconds later the yaw damper warning light goes out to show that you have yaw damper operation. The switch is held in the ON position electronically with power from the SMYD. Put the switch in the OFF position to disengage the YDS. After you put the switch to the OFF position, the yaw damper warning light comes on. The warning light comes on anytime the system disengages. Training Information Point The electrical ground for the disengage light is connected in series through both SMYDs. For normal operation, it is necessary to have both SMYDs installed on the airplane. The light test can be done with the master dim and test system. The WTRIS and standby yaw damping functions of SMYD 2 can only be engaged when standby hydraulics is ON and both systems A and B are OFF. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 166 Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM B737-600/700/800 22-23 DC POWER 28V DC BUS 1 POWER SUPPLY YAW DAMPER 1 A A 2 SEC YAW DAMPER 2 MASTER WARNING SYSTEM DISENGAGE LIGHT P18 CIRCUIT BREAKER PANEL 2 SEC FLIGHT CONTROL MODULE YD CHANNEL OK YAW DAMPER SWITCH NC PROGRAM PINS 2 SEC YAW DAMPER ACTUATOR SOLENOID SMYD 1 OFF/STANDBY MAIN RUDDER PCU POWER SUPPLY 2 SEC ON For Training Purposes Only FLT CONT B 2 SEC OFF/STANDBY ON FLT CONT A FLIGHT CONTROL PANEL YAW DAMPER ACTUATOR SOLENOID YD CHANNEL OK NC PROGRAM PINS 2 SEC STANDBY RUDDER PCU SMYD 2 Figure 79 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM YD ENGAGE INTERLOCK FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 167 Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM B737-600/700/800 22-23 YDS - SMYD BITE General The SMYD has these BITE functions: S Continuous monitors S BITE tests. The BITE tests on the front of the SMYD test those items that the continuous monitor cannot test. Continuous Monitor Continuous monitors test the SMYD for proper operation. When the SMYD has a failure, a fault is put in fault history. Some faults cause no SMYD outputs. BITE Tests BITE tests have these functions: S A quick system test S Check SMYD operation after replacement S A series of tests to show all functions are within specifications S Support fault isolation. Six push—button switches and a two row 8 character display are on the front of the SMYD for BITE tests. BITE - Operation Push the ON/OFF switch to start BITE tests. Push the up arrow to see the previous menu item. Push the down arrow or NO key to see the next menu item. Push the YES key to move down into the menu on the display. Push the MENU key to move back up one level. In some lists, TOP OF LIST and END OF LIST show for one second when you move to the top or bottom of the list. To operate BITE, the airplane must have the flaps up and VCAS < 60 knots or engine not running to start the test. Engines not running means that the on—side engine N1 < 15% and the off— side engine N1 < 50%. Main Menu These are the BITE main menu selections: S EXISTING FAULTS S FAULTS HISTORY S GROUND TESTS S OTHER FUNCTIONS. For Training Purposes Only You push the YES key to enter any of these menu selections. Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA USE NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 168 Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM B737-600/700/800 22-23 ON STATIC SENSITIVE ”BITE INSTRUCTIONS” ON/OFF:START OR STOP BITE MENU : TO DISPLAY MENU YES/NO: IN RESPONSE TO QUESTION (?) :TO SCROLL THROUGH OR MENU OR RESULTS OFF 1 INTO EXISTING FAULTS YES EXISTING FAULTS? NO MENU For Training Purposes Only YES ON OFF XXXXXXXXXXX YES ON-SIDE ENG N1 < 15% FAULTS HISTORY? OFF-SIDE ENG N2 < 50% FLAPS UP AIRSPEED < 60 KNOTS INTO GROUND TESTS YES GROUND TESTS? NO MOD INTO OTHER FUNCTIONS YES OTHER FUNCTNS? NO 2 Figure 80 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA USE NM BITE ENABLE NO NO STALL MANAGEMENT YAW DAMPER P/N 65-52822-XX S/N XXXXXXXXXXXX XXXXXXXXXXXX INTO FAULTS HISTORY 1 SHOWS TOP OF LIST FOR 1 SECOND 2 SHOWS END OF LIST FOR 1 SECOND SMYD - BITE FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 169 Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM B737-600/700/800 22-23 YDS - SMYD BITE: EXISTING FAULTS Existing Faults The existing faults test does a check of the interfaces to the SMYD. To do the existing faults test, do these steps: S Go to the main menu S Use the up or down arrow switches until you see EXISTING FAULTS? in the BITE display S Push the YES switch. If the test passes, then the display shows NO FAULTS. If the test fails, then the display shows a fault message. You can use the switches on the BITE panel to see more information about the fault message. You can also see if there are other fault messages. For Training Purposes Only More Details MORE DETAILS? shows: S The message number S Flight deck effect for the SWS, YD, and autoslat S The most likely LRU causing the fault S Whether the fault is latched or not. Reset Latches Note: There are faults in the memory which disable the SMYD-Test. They are not automatically reset after replacing the faulty component(s). You have to do the RESET LATCHES procedure on the SMYDs front. To reset the latched faults, push the YES switch. The RESET IN PROGRESS display with show while the latched faults are being reset. Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA USE NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 170 B737-600/700/800 22-23 NOTE: IF YOU ENTER THE MSG NO. IN THE PMAs „MAINTENANCE MSG“ FIELD, THE PMA WILL SHOW THE FIM TASK FOR REPAIR !! For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM Figure 81 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA USE NM YDS BITE, EXISTING FAULTS FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 171 Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM B737-600/700/800 22-23 YDS - SMYD BITE: FAULT HISTORY Fault History The fault history selection shows fault information that is in the non—volatile memory (NVM) in the SMYD. Monitors in the SMYD put data in the NVM during these conditions: S System tests using the SMYD BITE S Continuous monitoring S Power up tests. The NVM keeps data for the last 64 flight legs and a maximum of 256 failures. Only flight legs that have faults are displayed in fault history. The flight leg changes when the airplane goes from the ground to the air, except during touch and go operations. Flight leg 0 is the most recent flight. To find fault information, do these steps: S Go to the main menu S Use the up or down arrow switches until you see FAULT HISTORY? in the BITE display S Push the YES switch S Use the up or down arrow switches until you see the flight leg that you want S Push the YES switch. For Training Purposes Only The information for MORE DETAILS? is the same as for the existing faults test. Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA USE NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 172 B737-600/700/800 22-23 NOTE: IF YOU ENTER THE MSG NO. IN THE PMAs „MAINTENANCE MSG“ FIELD, THE PMA WILL SHOW THE FIM TASK FOR REPAIR !! For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM Figure 82 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA USE NM YDS BITE, FAULT HISTORY FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 173 Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM B737-600/700/800 22-23 YDS - SMYD BITE: GROUND TESTS Ground Test GROUND TEST has these menus: S SELF TESTS? S DISCRETE INPUTS? S ARINC 429 INPUTS? S ANALOG INPUTS? S SERVO TEST? S DISPLAY TEST?. To start one of these tests, do these steps: S Go to the main menu S Use the up or down arrow switches until you see GROUND TESTS? in the BITE display S Push the YES switch S Use the up or down arrow switches until you see the test that you want S Push the YES switch. If the test passes, then the display shows TEST PASSED. If the test fails, then the display shows a fault message. The information for MORE DETAILS? is the same as for the existing faults test. For Training Purposes Only Self Test The self test checks the SMYD for faults. When you push YES, the display shows TEST IN PROGRESS until the test is finished. If the SMYD passes the test, the display shows SMYD LRU OK. If the SMYD does not pass the test, the display shows SMYD LRU FAIL for 2 seconds, then shows the first fault. Discrete Inputs You check the status of the discrete inputs from the DISCRETE INPUTS? menu. Push the YES switch to see the list of discrete inputs. Use the up (previous), and down (next) arrows to move through the list. ARINC 429 Test You can check the ARINC 429 buses from the ARINC 429 INPUT? You can check the activity status of these buses: S On side IR bus Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA USE NM S Off side IR bus S On side ADR bus S CDS DEU bus S FMC bus S DFCS MCP bus S Cross channel bus. Push the YES switch to see if the bus is active or inactive. Use the up and down arrows to move through the list. Analog Inputs You check the status of these sensors from the ANALOG INPUTS? menu. Push the YES switch to select a sensor. Use the up (previous) and down (next) arrows to move through the list. These sensors can be checked: S AOA sensor S Flap sensor S Wheel sensor S YD LVDT. Push the YES switch to select a sensor. Use the up (previous), and down (next) arrows to move through the list. Servo Test You test the yaw damper components on the rudder PCU, as well as the interface between the SMYD and the PCU, with the SERVO TEST. You can test these components S Yaw damper EHSV S Yaw damper engage solenoid. S Yaw damper LVDT. Display Test You test the display on the SMYD by pushing the YES switch when the DISPLAY TEST? prompt shows. The test takes about 10 seconds. All the LEDs on the left half of the top line will come on first. Then all the LEDs on the right half will come on. Next all the LEDs on the left half of the bottom line will come on, and finally all the LEDs on the right half will come on. When the test is complete, DISPLAY TEST? will show on the display. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 174 B737-600/700/800 22-23 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM Figure 83 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA USE NM YDS BITE, GROUND TESTS FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 175 Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM B737-600/700/800 22-23 YDS - SMYD BITE: SERVO TEST General The servo test consists of these two tests: S ZERO COMMAND S SWEEP TEST. Zero Command The main rudder PCU is commanded to the zero position. The signal from the LVDT is compared to the servo command. For Training Purposes Only Sweep Test The main rudder PCU is commanded to the left, right and center position. The signal from the LVDT is compared to the servo command to pass or fail the test. If the test passes, the ZERO COMMAND menu shows after the TEST EXISTING? display. If the test fails, the faults are listed the same as for the existing faults test. Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA USE NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 176 B737-600/700/800 22-23 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM Figure 84 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA USE NM YDS BITE, SERVO TEST FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 177 Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM B737-600/700/800 22-23 YDS - SMYD BITE: OTHER FUNCTIONS General OTHER FUNCTIONS has these menus: S SYSTEM CONFIG? S I/O MONITOR. To enter these sections you must push the YES key. System Configuration In the system configuration section you verify these attributes: S Part number S Software Level Position (1 or 2) S Airplane type S FAA or CAA/FAA. For Training Purposes Only I/O Monitor In the I/O Monitor section you verify these inputs and outputs: S ARINC 429 inputs S ARINC 429 low speed outputs S ARINC 429 high speed outputs Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA USE NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 178 B737-600/700/800 22-23 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM Figure 85 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA USE NM YDS BITE, OTHER FUNCTIONS FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 179 Lufthansa Technical Training For Training Purposes Only FLIGHT CONTROLS WHEEL TO RUDDER INTERCONNECT SYSTEM (WTRIS) 27-24 B737-600/700/800 27-24 WHEEL TO RUDDER INTERCONNECT SYSTEM ABBREVIATIONS AND ACRONYMS AC ADR ADIRU AOA ARINC ATR BITE CAA CDS CPU DC DEU DFCS EHSV FAA FMC IR I/O LRU LVDT MCP N1 NN PCU SMYD V WTRIS YDS WTRIS - INTRODUCTION — alternating current — air data reference — air data inertial reference unit — angle of attack — Aeronautical Radio Incorporated — Austin Trumbull Radio — built in test equipment — Civil Aviation Authority — common display system — central processing unit — direct current — display electronic unit — digital flight control system — electrohydraulic servo valve — Federal Aviation Administration — flight management computer — inertial reference — input/output — line replaceable unit — Linear variable differential transformer — mode control panel — Low pressure rotor speed — a number from 01 to 99 — power control unit — stall management yaw damper — volts — wheel to rudder interconnect system — yaw damper system Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM Purpose The wheel to rudder interconnect system (WTRIS) assists manual reversion turns when both hydraulic systems A and B are OFF, and the standby system is ON. The WTRIS commands a small amount of rudder movement as a function of the capt’s control wheel aileron input. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 180 Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CONTROLS WHEEL TO RUDDER INTERCONNECT SYSTEM (WTRIS) B737-600/700/800 27-24 For Training Purposes Only YAW DAMPER COMPONENTS ON STANDBY RUDDER PCU SMYD 2 (E/E BAY) CONTROL WHEEL POSITION SENSOR (CAPT SIDE) Figure 86 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM WTRIS INTRODUCTION FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 181 Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CONTROLS WHEEL TO RUDDER INTERCONNECT SYSTEM (WTRIS) B737-600/700/800 27-24 WTRIS - GENERAL DESCRIPTION General The wheel-to-rudder interconnect system (WTRIS) moves the rudder to help turns during flight control manual reversion when on standby hydraulics. For the WTRIS function, SMYD 2 has interfaces with these components: - Control wheel position sensor (captain) - Yaw damper engage switch - Yaw damper disengage light - Flight control panel switches - Standby yaw damper solenoid valve - Standby EHSV - Standby LVDT - FMC - Trailing edge flaps up limit switches - Left flap position transmitter. - Stall Management Yaw Damper For Training Purposes Only SMYD 2 commands rudder movement for WTRIS and standby yaw damping and turn coordination during flight control manual reversion when on standby hydraulics. SMYD 2 receives data from airplane sensors, switches and components, and uses the data to calculate and send commands to the standby rudder PCU to move the rudder. Standby Rudder PCU The standby rudder PCU is a hydraulic actuator that moves the rudder in response to pilot rudder inputs when on standby hydraulic pressure. During standby operation, SMYD 2 sends commands to the yaw damper components on the standby rudder PCU. ADIRU The air data inertial reference units (ADIRUs) send data to the SMYDs. The data includes airspeed, attitude, and yaw and roll rates and accelerations. FMC The FMC provides airplane gross weight to the SMYDs. Trailing Edge Flaps Up Limit Switches The trailing edge flaps up limit switches send data to the SMYD to limit rudder travel when flaps are up. Left Flap Position Transmitter The left flap position transmitter sends data to SMYD 2. Control Wheel Position Sensor The captain control wheel (CW) position sensor senses pilot aileron input and sends an analog signal to the SMYD 2 to calculate a command for left/right rudder movement for WTRIS. Yaw Damper Engage Switch and Disengage Light You engage WTRIS and standby yaw damping with the yaw damper switch on the flight control panel. The disengage warning light is above the switch. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 182 Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CONTROLS WHEEL TO RUDDER INTERCONNECT SYSTEM (WTRIS) STBY RUD OFF A ON B737-600/700/800 27-24 FLT CONTROL A B STBY RUD OFF B ON CONTROL WHEEL POSITION SENSOR (CAPT SIDE) FWD YAW DAMPER OTHER SENSORS FMC RIGHT AOA SENSOR TE FLAPS UP LIMIT SWITCHES LEFT FLAP POSITION TRANSMITTER YAW DAMPER OFF ON For Training Purposes Only FLIGHT CONTROL PANEL SMYD 2 STANDBY RUDDER PCU RUDDER ADIRU (2) Figure 87 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM WTRIS - GENERAL FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 183 Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CONTROLS WHEEL TO RUDDER INTERCONNECT SYSTEM (WTRIS) B737-600/700/800 27-24 WTRIS - COMPONENT LOCATIONS Flight Compartment The yaw damper engage switch and the disengage light are on the flight control panel. For Training Purposes Only Forward Nose Compartment The control wheel position sensor is at the bottom of the captain’s control column, below the floor. Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 184 B737-600/700/800 27-24 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CONTROLS WHEEL TO RUDDER INTERCONNECT SYSTEM (WTRIS) Figure 88 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM WTRIS - COMPONENT LOCATION FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 185 B737-600/700/800 27-24 Stall Management Yaw Damper The SMYD 2 is on the E3—2 shelf in the electronic equipment bay. For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CONTROLS WHEEL TO RUDDER INTERCONNECT SYSTEM (WTRIS) Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 186 B737-600/700/800 27-24 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CONTROLS WHEEL TO RUDDER INTERCONNECT SYSTEM (WTRIS) Figure 89 Aug 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM WTRIS COMPONENT LOCATION FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 187 Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CONTROLS WHEEL TO RUDDER INTERCONNECT SYSTEM (WTRIS) B737-600/700/800 27-24 SMYD 2 WTRIS - INTERFACES Power The SMYD 2 gets 28v dc from electrical bus 1 and 28v ac from transfer bus 1. 28v dc power goes from SMYD 2 to the engage switch. The linear variable differential transformer (LVDT) gets 28v ac from the same circuit as the SMYD 2. Digital Data: SMYD 2 receives airplane gross weight from the FMC. SMYD 2 receives these air data from the right ADIRU: S Airspeed S Impact pressure. Operation During standby hydraulic operations, when you turn ON the yaw damper engage switch, an engage signal goes through SMYD 2 to the yaw damper solenoid valve on the standby rudder PCU to engage the yaw damper. SMYD 2 commands rudder movement using the standby EHSV. The flight control panel switches for system A and B must be in the OFF or STBY RUD position to enable SMYD 2 for WTRIS and standby yaw damping. For Training Purposes Only SMYD 2 receives these inertial data from the left and right ADIRUs: - Lateral acceleration - Roll angle - Roll rate - Yaw rate. Analog Signals: SMYD 2 sends commands to the standby rudder PCU to assist turns during flight control manual reversion, and for standby yaw damping/turn coordination. The LVDT on the standby rudder PCU sends rudder position data to SMYD 2 about rudder movement. The trailing edge flaps up limit switches send flaps up/not up data to SMYD 2 to limit rudder movement when the flaps are up. The left flap position transmitter sends flap position data to SMYD 2 to use in stall warning, WTRIS and yaw damping command calculation. Power goes from the DC power and dim control to the yaw damper disengage light. The captain control wheel (CW) position sensor sends control wheel aileron input information to SMYD 2 for the WTRIS function. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 188 Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CONTROLS WHEEL TO RUDDER INTERCONNECT SYSTEM (WTRIS) B737-600/700/800 27-24 28V AC XFR BUS 1 YAW DAMPER CONTROL WHEEL POSITION 28V DC BUS 1 YAW DAMPER CAPT CONTROL WHEEL POSITION SENSOR P6-1 CB PANEL AIRSPEED IMPACT PRESSURE LVDT YAW DAMPER RUDDER POSITION RUDDER FEEDBACK LATERAL ACC ROLL ANGLE ROLL RATE YAW RATE COMMAND SIGNALS LATERAL ACC ROLL ANGLE ROLL RATE YAW RATE RIGHT ADIRU EHSV 28V DC POWER ENGAGE COMMAND SOLENOID VALVE STANDBY RUDDER PCU LEFT ADIRU For Training Purposes Only FMC FLAP POSITION LEFT FLAP POSITION XMTR POWER FLAPS UP DC POWER AND DIM CONTROL SMYD 2 NOTE: THE SHADOWED INPUTS ARE NOT FOR WTRIS !! TRAILING EDGE FLAPS UP LIMIT SWITCHES Figure 90 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM YD ENGAGE REQUEST - - - - - - - - - YD DISENGAGE LIGHT FLIGHT CONTROL PANEL ANGLE-OF-AIRFLOW RIGHT AOA SENSOR SWITCH SOLENOID POWER ENGAGE ENABLE ENGAGE SIGNAL GROSS WEIGHT NOTE: THIS DIAGRAM ONLY SHOWS INTERFACES FORWTRIS SMYD 2 - WTRIS INTERFACES FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 189 Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM B737-600/700/800 22-23 SYMD 2 - WTRIS: OPERATIONS General The yaw damper engage switch on the flight control panel is used to turn ON the WTRIS and standby yaw damper. The yaw damper disengage warning light is above the engage switch. For Training Purposes Only Engage Switch and Warning Light To turn on the WTRIS and standby yaw damper (SMYD 2 ), do these steps on the flight control panel: - Place both FLT CONT A and B switches to OFF - Place at least one of these switches to STBY RUD - Engage the yaw damper switch to ON. The flight control A and B switches to OFF sends a signal to enable SMYD 2 for WTRIS and standby yaw damping. One or both of these switches to the STBY RUD position provides standby hydraulic pressure to the standby rudder PCU to move the rudder. After you turn on the WTRIS and the standby yaw damper, and after a twosecond delay, the yaw damper engage light will go off to show these systems are operating. If there is a system fault, SMYD 2 will remove power from the engage solenoid valve on the standby rudder PCU to shut off hydraulic fluid to the EHSV. SMYD 2 also removes power from the yaw damper engage switch on the flight control panel. After a two-second delay, the engage switch moves to OFF and the yaw damper disengage light comes ON to show the system has disengaged. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 190 Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM B737-600/700/800 22-23 FLT CONTROL FLT CONTROL A AND B SWITCHES A STANDBY HYD B STBY RUD STBY RUD OFF OFF A ON B ON LOW QUANTITY LOW PRESSURE ALTERNATE FLAPS OFF UP LOW LOW PRESSURE PRESSURE OFF SPOILER A B For Training Purposes Only DISENGAGE WARNING LIGHT ARM OFF OFF ON ON YAW DAMPER YAW DAMPER YAW DAMPER ENGAGE SWITCH DOWN SPEED TRIM FAIL FEEL DIFF FAIL MACH TRIM FAIL AUTO SLAT FAIL OFF ON FLIGHT CONTROL PANEL Figure 91 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM SMYD 2 - YD/WTRIS OPS FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 191 Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM B737-600/700/800 22-23 SMYD 2 - WTRIS OPERATIONS: ENGAGE INTERLOCKS General SMYD 2 operates the wheel to rudder interconnect system (WTRIS) and standby yaw damping during standby operations. For WTRIS and standby yaw damping, SMYD 2 requires that both flight control A and B hydraulic switches be OFF, with at least one switch in STBY RUD to provide standby hydraulic pressure to the standby rudder PCU. Engage Switch and Warning Light To engage the WTRIS and standby yaw damping, you put the yaw damper engage switch on the flight control panel to the ON position. Two seconds later, the yaw damper warning light goes out to show these systems are operating. The switch is held in the ON position with power from SMYD 2. For Training Purposes Only Put the switch in the OFF position to disengage the WTRIS and standby yaw damping. The yaw damper warning light comes on. The warning light comes on anytime the system is disengaged. During a system fault and after disengagement, the SMYD 2 removes power from the engage switch solenoid so that the switch moves to the OFF position. Training Information Point The electrical ground for the disengage light is connected in series through both SMYDs. For normal operation, both SMYDs are necessary on the airplane. You can do a test of the light with the master dim and test system. SMYD When a SMYD computer is in the number 2 position, it operates the WTRIS and standby yaw damping. This is when flight control hydraulic system A and B are OFF and the standby system is ON. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 192 Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM B737-600/700/800 22-23 DC POWER A A 28V DC BUS 1 POWER SUPPLY YAW DAMPER 1 2 SEC YAW DAMPER 2 MASTER WARNING SYSTEM DISENGAGE LIGHT P18 CIRCUIT BREAKER PANEL FLIGHT CONTROL PANEL 2 SEC YD CHANNEL OK YAW DAMPER SWITCH NC OFF/ STANDBY PROGRAM PINS YAW DAMPER ACTUATOR SOLENOID 2 SEC MAIN RUDDER PCU SMYD 1 NOTE: THE SHADOWED COMPONENTS ARE NOT FOR WTRIS !! POWER SUPPLY For Training Purposes Only ON FLT CONT B 2 SEC 2 SEC OFF/ STANDBY ON FLT CONT A FLIGHT CONTROL PANEL YD CHANNEL OK NC PROGRAM PINS YAW DAMPER ACTUATOR SOLENOID 2 SEC STANDBY RUDDER PCU SMYD 2 WTRIS - OPERATIONS - ENGAGE INTERLOCKS Figure 92 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM SMYD 2 - WTRIS ENGAGE FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 193 Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM B737-600/700/800 22-23 SMYD 2 - WTRIS: FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION General SMYD 2 uses analog and digital data inputs to calculate rudder commands for WTRIS and standby yaw damping/turn coordination. For Training Purposes Only Engage Interlock SMYD 2 supplies 28v dc to the yaw damper solenoid valve on the standby rudder PCU. When this solenoid valve is energized it supplies hydraulic fluid to the EHSV to operate the yaw damper actuator on the standby rudder PCU to move the rudder for WTRIS and standby yaw damping. WTRIS The WTRIS function of SMYD 2 uses control wheel aileron inputs from the captain control wheel position sensor to command small amounts of rudder movement. This helps turn the airplane during flight control manual reversion when operating on standby hydraulics. The SMYD central processing unit (CPU) operates the control law software. For SMYD 2, the software calculations are based on inputs from these components: - Captain control wheel position sensor - ADIRUs (inertial and air data) - Right AOA sensor - FMC - Standby rudder PCU LVDT - Trailing edge flap up limit switches. The standby LVDT sends yaw damper actuator position data about rudder movement to SMYD 2. WTRIS only operates at Mach < 0.4. The gain schedule changes from 1 (full gain) at Mach < 0.3 to zero gain at Mach > 0.4. For WTRIS and standby yaw damping, these are the limits for rudder commands: S 2 degrees with flaps up S 2.5 degrees with flaps not up. BITE The SMYD has BITE test and continuous BITE. It stores failures in fault history. The keypad is for operator interface. The display shows test results and prompts for input. SMYD 2 receives inertial data from the ADIRU to calculate commands for standby yaw damping and turn coordination. These commands go to the yaw damper EHSV on the standby rudder PCU to move the rudder. The EHSV applies hydraulic pressure to the yaw damper actuator and the actuator makes a mechanical summing input to the rudder PCU to move the rudder to assist turns and to reduce unwanted yaw. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 194 Lufthansa Technical Training AUTO FLIGHT YAW DAMPER SYSTEM B737-600/700/800 22-23 28V AC 28V DC POWER 28V DC YAW DAMPER ENGAGE SWITCH R AOA SENSOR L FLAP POS TRANSMITTER ANALOG INPUTS TE FLAP UP LIMIT SWITCH ANALOG OUTPUT CW SENSOR STBY RUDDER PCU EHSV LVDT ON STBY RUDDER PCU SOFTWARE CALCULATIONS R ADIRU IR CPU R ADIRU ADR WTRIS YAW DAMPING ARINC 429 INPUT L ADIRU IR FMC GW ARINC 429 OUTPUT For Training Purposes Only SMYD 1 FAULT HISTORY KEYPAD BITE DISPLAY SMYD 2 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE STALL MGT YAW DAMPER 1 CROSS CHANNEL BUS NOTE: ONLY INTERFACES FOR WTRIS AND STBY YAW DAMPING ARE SHOWN ON THIS DIAGRAM. Figure 93 FRA US/E NM STBY RUDDER PCU SOLENOID VALVE SMYD 2 - FUNCTIONAL DESCR. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 195 Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CONTROLS WHEEL TO RUDDER INTERCONNECT SYSTEM (WTRIS) B737-600/700/800 27-24 SMYD 2 - WTRIS: BITE General The SMYD has these BITE functions: S Continuous monitors S BITE tests. BITE tests on the front of the SMYD test items that the continuous monitor cannot. Continuous Monitor Continuous monitors test the SMYD for proper operation. When the SMYD has a failure a fault is put in fault history. Some faults cause no SMYD outputs. For Training Purposes Only Display The SMYD has two amber eight character alphanumeric displays. These displays show messages and instructions while operating BITE. Keypad The keypad has these keys: S MENU S YES S Up arrow (PREVIOUS) S Down arrow (NEXT) S ON/OFF S NO. You use these keys to interact with the SMYD while operating BITE. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA USE NM BITE Tests BITE tests have these functions: S A quick system test S SMYD self test S Component tests S A series of tests to show all functions are within specifications S Support fault isolation. Six push—button switches and a two row 8 character display are on the front of the SMYD for BITE tests. BITE Operation Push the ON/OFF switch to start BITE tests. Push the up arrow to see the previous menu item. Push the Down arrow or NO key to see the next menu item. Push the YES key to move down into the menu on the display. Push the MENU key to move back up one level. In some lists, TOP OF LIST and END OF LIST show for a second when you move to the top or bottom of the list. To operate BITE the airplane must have the flaps up and airspeed < 60 knots or engine not running. Engines not running means that the on—side engine N1 is less than 15% and the off—side engine N1 is less than 50%. Main Menu These are the BITE main menu selections: S EXISTING FAULTS S FAULTS HISTORY S GROUND TESTS S OTHER FUNCTIONS. You press the YES key to enter any of these menu selections. See the yaw damper system section 22—23 for more information about the SMYD BITE operation. (AMM PART 1, 22—23) FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 196 Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CONTROLS WHEEL TO RUDDER INTERCONNECT SYSTEM (WTRIS) B737-600/700/800 27-24 ON STATIC SENSITIVE ”BITE INSTRUCTIONS” ON/OFF:START OR STOP BITE MENU : TO DISPLAY MENU YES/NO: IN RESPONSE TO QUESTION (?) :TO SCROLL THROUGH OR MENU OR RESULTS OFF 1 INTO EXISTING FAULTS YES EXISTING FAULTS? NO ON-SIDE ENG N1 < 15% OFF-SIDE ENG N2 < 50% MENU YES ON INTO FAULTS HISTORY OFF XXXXXXXXXXXX AIRSPEED < 60 KNOTS YES MOD GROUND TESTS? SEE NEXT PAGES !! NO INTO OTHER FUNCTIONS YES OTHER FUNCTNS? NO 2 Figure 94 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA USE NM FLAPS UP NO STALL MANAGEMENT YAW DAMPER P/N 65-52822-XX S/N XXXXXXXXXXXX XXXXXXXXXXX BITE ENABLE FAULTS HISTORY? NO INTO GROUND TESTS For Training Purposes Only YES 1 SHOWS TOP OF LIST FOR 1 SECOND 2 SHOWS END OF LIST FOR 1 SECOND SMYD - BITE FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 197 Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CONTROLS WHEEL TO RUDDER INTERCONNECT SYSTEM (WTRIS) B737-600/700/800 27-24 WTRIS - SMYD BITE: GROUND TESTS NOTE: For WTRIS troubleshooting, the maintenance manual only suggests the GROUND TEST and the SERVO TESTS of the SMYD 2. THIS FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY !! REFER TO YOUR MM-PMA FOR TROUBLESHOOTING DETAILS !! For Training Purposes Only Ground Test GROUND TEST has these menus: S SELF TESTS? S DISCRETE INPUTS? S ARINC 429 INPUTS? S ANALOG INPUTS? S SERVO TEST? S DISPLAY TEST? To start one of these tests, do these steps: S Go to the main menu S Use the up or down arrow switches until you see GROUND TESTS? in the BITE display S Push the YES switch S Use the up or down arrow switches until you see the test that you want S Push the YES switch. If the test passes, then the display shows TEST PASSED. If the test fails, then the display shows a fault message. The information for MORE DETAILS? is the same as for the existing faults test. Servo Test You use the SERVO TEST to test the yaw damper components on the rudder PC, and to test the interface between the SMYD and the PCU. You can test these components: S Yaw damper EHSV S Yaw damper engage solenoid S Yaw damper LVDT Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA USE NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 198 B737-600/700/800 27-24 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CONTROLS WHEEL TO RUDDER INTERCONNECT SYSTEM (WTRIS) Figure 95 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA USE NM SMYD WTRIS BITE GROUND TESTS FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 199 Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CONTROLS WHEEL TO RUDDER INTERCONNECT SYSTEM (WTRIS) B737-600/700/800 27-24 WTRIS - SMYD BITE: SERVO TEST General The servo test consists of these two tests: S ZERO COMMAND S SWEEP TEST. Zero Command The standby rudder PCU is commanded to the zero position. The signal from the LVDT is compared to the servo command. For Training Purposes Only Sweep Test The standby rudder PCU is commanded to the left, right and center position. The signal from the LVDT is compared to the servo command to pass or fail the test. If the test passes, the ZERO COMMAND menu shows after the TEST EXITING? display. If the test fails, the faults are listed the same as for the existing faults test. Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA USE NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 200 B737-600/700/800 27-24 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CONTROLS WHEEL TO RUDDER INTERCONNECT SYSTEM (WTRIS) Figure 96 Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA USE NM SMYD WTRIS SERVO TEST FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 201 B737-600/700/800 27-24 THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CONTROLS WHEEL TO RUDDER INTERCONNECT SYSTEM (WTRIS) Nov. 2001 REFRESHER COURSE FRA USE NM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Page: Ltd. 202 Training Manual B 737-600/700/800 ATA 35 Oxygen Level 2 Lufthansa Technical Training GmbH Lufthansa Base REFRESHER COURSE FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Issue: June 1999 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa 1995 AMET Ltd. For training purposes and internal use only. Copyright by Lufthansa Technical Training GmbH. All rights reserved. No parts of this training manual may be sold or reproduced in any form without permission of: Lufthansa Technical Training GmbH Lufthansa Base Frankfurt D-60546 Frankfurt/Main Tel. +49 69 / 696 41 78 Fax +49 69 / 696 63 84 Lufthansa Base Hamburg Weg beim Jäger 193 D-22335 Hamburg Tel. +49 40 / 5070 24 13 Fax +49 40 / 5070 47 46 REFRESHER COURSE FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Ltd. Inhaltsverzeichnis ATA OXYGEN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 35-00 OXYGEN SYSTEMS — INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 35-10 FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN — GENERAL DESCRIPTION . . INTERFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . OXYGEN CYLINDER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . OXYGEN CYLINDER - FUNCTIONAL DESRIPTION . . . DISCHARGE INDICATION DISK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . THERMAL COMPENSATOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PRESSURE TRANSDUCER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PRESSURE REDUCING REGULATOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SYSTEM SHUTOFF VALVE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . MASK WITH GOGGLES — GENERAL DESCRIPTION . MASK WITH GOGGLES — FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION AND OPERATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 35-20 PASSENGER OXYGEN — INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . OXYGEN GENERATOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PASSENGER OXYGEN MASK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DOOR LATCH ACTUATOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DOOR LATCH ACTUATOR CIRCUIT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DOOR TEST / RESET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 28 30 32 34 38 35-30 PORTABLE OXYGEN EQUIPMENT — INTRODUCTION . 40 REFRESHER COURSE 24 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Seite: i AMET Ltd. Bildverzeichnis Figure 1 Figure 2 Figure 3 Figure 4 Figure 5 Figure 6 Figure 7 Figure 8 Figure 9 Figure 10 Figure 11 Figure 12 Figure 13 Figure 14 Figure 15 Figure 16 Figure 17 Figure 18 Figure 19 Figure 20 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . General Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Crew Oxygen Cylinder - Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Oxygen Cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Discharge Indication Disk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Thermal Compensator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pressure Transducer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pressure Reducing Regulator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . System Shutoff Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mask with Goggles - General Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mask with Goggles - Functional Description and Operation . Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Oxygen Generator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Passenger Oxygen Mask . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Door Latch Actuator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Door Latch Actuator Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pressure Switch and Relays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Door Test / Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . REFRESHER COURSE 3 5 7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23 25 27 29 31 33 35 37 39 41 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Seite: ii AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 35-00 ATA OXYGEN For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training OXYGEN SYSTEMS INTRODUCTION 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 1 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training OXYGEN SYSTEMS INTRODUCTION B737-600/700/800 35-00 35-00 OXYGEN SYSTEMS — INTRODUCTION Purpose The oxygen systems supply oxygen to the flight crew, cabin attendants, and passengers. Oxygen can be used for these reasons: - As life sustaining oxygen if the plane depressuri zes - For emergencies - For first aid. For Training Purposes Only General Description The flight crew oxygen system is independent of the other systems. It is a high pressure gaseous system. High pressure gaseous oxygen is stored in a cylinder in the EE compartment. A cylinder regulator reduces the cylinder pressure before the oxygen enters the supply line. An oxygen supply line connects the regulator to a shutoff valve on the P6 panel. The shutoff valve outputs to a supply manifold in the flight deck. The manifold supplies oxygen to the flight crew oxygen masks. The passenger oxygen system uses chemical oxygen generators. The generators are mounted in the passenger service units (PSUs). Each chemical generator is separate, and supplies only its masks. The passenger masks are connected to the chemical generators by flexible tubes. There are two portable oxygen systems: - Portable oxygen cylinders with masks - Protective breathing equipment (PBE) (when installed). Location The flight crew oxygen system components are located in flight compartment and the EE compartment. The passenger system components are located in the passenger service units (PSUs), the attendant service panels, and the lavatory service panels. Portable system components are located in the flight compartment and passenger cabin. Abbreviations and Acronyms EE — electronic equipment PBE — protective breathing equipment PSU —passenger service unit 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 2 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 35-00 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training OXYGEN SYSTEMS INTRODUCTION Figure 1 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Introduction FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 3 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN GENERAL DESCRIPTION B737-600/700/800 35-10 35-10 FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN — GENERAL DESCRIPTION Purpose The flight crew oxygen system supplies the flight crew with low pressure gaseous oxygen. For Training Purposes Only General Description High pressure gaseous oxygen is stored in a cylinder. A gauge on the cylinder shows cylinder pressure. Overpressure devices protect the cylinder. A green plastic discharge indication disk on the fuselage skin shows cylinder discharge from overpressure (when disk is missing). A temperature compensating coupling connects the cylinder to the aircraft’s distribution system. A pressure transducer on the cylinder coupling sends a signal to a gage on the P5 panel for cylinder pressure indication. A pressure regulator on the coupling reduces the oxygen pressure. This keeps oxygen in the distribution system to a lower pressure. Low pressure supply lines supply oxygen to a shutoff valve in the flight deck. The shutoff valve controls the flow of oxygen to the mask assemblies in the flight deck. The oxygen supply lines are made of seamless stainless steel tubing and use flareless fittings. The flight crew masks supply the oxygen to the crew. The masks have diluter—demand regulators and controls. The masks are modular, independently adjustable, and easy to put on. When cylinder pressure is too low for operational requirements, you replace it. These components are in the flight compartment: - P6 panel oxygen shutoff valve - Crew mask modules - P5 crew oxygen cylinder pressure gage. The green cylinder overpressure discharge disk is on the fuselage skin aft of the electronic equipment compartment external access door. Training Information Point Oxygen system maintenance requires special care and clean liness. Oxygen system maintenance personnel should know the special materials and procedures used in system servicing. Refer to chapter 12 of the maintenance manual for these materials and procedures. Keep oxygen systems clean and dry. Use approved cleaning materials. NOTE: Use only aviation grade oxygen in the flight crew oxygen system. Welding oxygen and hospital oxygen can be pure enough to breathe but contain water. The water can freeze and plug the lines, regulators, and valves of the system. NOTE: Oil, grease, flammable solvents, dust, lint, fine metal filings, or other combustible materials may ignite and result in an explosion. Contamination inside the system can cause noxious or toxic reactions. This can render the system inoperative for its intended use. NOTE: Do not tighten fittings on a pressurized oxygen system. An explosion may result. Location These system components are in the EE compartment: - A high pressure oxygen cylinder - A temperature compensator cylinder coupling - A pressure reducing regulator - A pressure transmitter - Overpressure discharge tubing. 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 4 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 35-10 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN GENERAL DESCRIPTION Figure 2 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br General Description FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 5 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN GENERAL DESCRIPTION B737-600/700/800 35-10 INTERFACE Purpose The schematic below shows the interfaces of the flight crew oxygen system. The flight crew oxygen system has these interfaces: - System supply tubing - Shutoff valves - Pressure indication - Overpressure discharge and indication - Flight crew communications systems. sed. If the cylinder shutoff valve is open, oxygen from the cylinder and the system supply tubing flows overboard. Flight Crew Communications Systems The flight crew oxygen masks have internal microphones. These microphones are part of the communications system. Refer to chapter 23 of the AMM for microphone information. System Plumbing The system plumbing has these components: - Corrosion resistant, seamless stainless steel tubing - Flareless fittings - Bayonet type quick disconnect connectors - Flexible silicon rubber hoses with braided sheathing. For Training Purposes Only Shutoff Valves A shutoff valve on the cylinder head opens or closes the cylinder to the supply system. A system shutoff valve on the P6 panel controls the flow of low pressure oxygen to the crew masks. Pressure Indication A mechanical pressure gage on the oxygen cylinder indicates the cylinder pressure. The gage shows pressure regardless of the cylinder shutoff valve position. An electrically powered gage on the P5 panel shows the pressure at the cylinder outlet coupling. A pressure transducer on the cylinder coupling supplies a signal to the gage. The system uses 28 V D.C. from the battery bus. Overpressure Discharge and Indication A frangible (breakable) disk on the oxygen cylinder protects the cylinder from overpressure. If an overpressure condition breaks this disk, the oxygen will flow overboard. This flow will blow out a green indication disk on the airplane fuselage. The cylinder discharge works with the cylinder shutoff valve open or clo24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 6 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 35-10 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN GENERAL DESCRIPTION Figure 3 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Interface FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 7 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN GENERAL DESCRIPTION B737-600/700/800 35-10 OXYGEN CYLINDER Purpose The oxygen cylinder stores the oxygen for the flight crew system. Physical Description The oxygen cylinder is made of steel and is painted green. The cylinder assembly has these features: - A slow opening shutoff valve - A cylinder pressure gage - An overpressure safety relief device. For Training Purposes Only Location The crew oxygen cylinder is located in the EE compartment, in the lower right area of the transverse rack. 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 8 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 35-10 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN GENERAL DESCRIPTION Figure 4 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Crew Oxygen Cylinder - Location FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 9 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN GENERAL DESCRIPTION B737-600/700/800 35-10 OXYGEN CYLINDER - FUNCTIONAL DESRIPTION Functional Description The crew oxygen cylinder is a pressure vessel. It is made of shatterproof mild steel. A frangible disk in the cylinder assembly protects the bottle from overpressure. A mechanical pressure gage on the bottle shows bottle pressure. The bottle is filled to 1850 psig at a temperature of 70F. The cylinder has a slow opening shutoff valve. The valve is designed to prevent high temperatures when the valve is operated. The cylinder is installed on a roller rack. Two collars hold the cylinder to the rack. Flareless pressure fittings connect the cylinder to these components: - The cylinder thermal compensator coupling - The overpressure discharge tubing. For Training Purposes Only Training Information Point Servicing the oxygen cylinder is by cylinder replacement. Access to the cylinder is from the forward cargo compartment. Refer to Chapter 12 of the AMM for complete servicing instructions. Clinder sizes vary. Make sure you use the same size cylinder for replacement. The cylinder must fit its support rack. Keep oxygen cylinder and components clean and free from any grease, oil, or other contamination. Use only approved cleaning, installation, and test materials. Bleed pressure out of the supply lines at the crew masks before uncoupling bottle connections. Do not torque line fittings when they are pressurized. Do not overtorque the cylinder shutoff valve or cylinder coupling fittings. 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 10 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 35-10 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN GENERAL DESCRIPTION Figure 5 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Oxygen Cylinder FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 11 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN GENERAL DESCRIPTION B737-600/700/800 35-10 DISCHARGE INDICATION DISK Purpose The discharge indication disk, when missing, shows the oxygen cylinder has discharged due to over pressure. Physical Description The discharge indication disk is a green plastic disk. It is backed—up by an o—ring, and held in place by a snap—ring. Location The discharge indication disk is flush—mounted to the fuselage skin, just aft of the electronic equipment compartment external access door. Functional Description A frangible disk in the crew oxygen cylinder protects the cylinder from overpressure. If cylinder pressure reaches 2600 psig the frangible disk breaks. This vents the bottle contents overboard through a high pressure line. The line outlet is covered by the discharge indication disk. The escaping oxygen blows the disk out of its seat. A missing disk indicates bottle overpressure discharge. For Training Purposes Only Operation Displays Preflight visual checks will confirm the green flight crew oxygen discharge indication disk is in place. Training Information Point The o—ring behind the discharge indication disk makes a seal for the discharge tubing. The seal prevents contamination or moisture accumulation in the discharge line. 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 12 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 35-10 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN GENERAL DESCRIPTION Figure 6 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Discharge Indication Disk FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 13 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN GENERAL DESCRIPTION B737-600/700/800 35-10 THERMAL COMPENSATOR Purpose The thermal compensator prevents excessive temperature buildup in the cylinder coupling. Physical Description The thermal compensator is a brush—like device, about three inches long. Location The thermal compensator is a permanent part of the oxygen cylinder coupling fitting. For Training Purposes Only Functional Description The thermal compensator is a heat sink and heat dissipater. High pressure oxygen flow in the cylinder coupling creates heat. The compensator absorbs and removes this heat. Training Information Point The thermal compensator is an integral part of the coupling fitting. It should not be removed from the fitting. Do not twist, pull, or push the thermal compensator while you fill the oxygen cylinder. Bristles broken off of the compensator can cause downstream components to clog. Bleed the pressure from the temperature compensator coupling before you torque the fittings. Do not use the temperature compensator coupling as a lever when you torque the coupling fittings. Use the wrenching flats on the coupling so that it cannot turn. Replace the coupling fitting and the thermal compensator as a single unit. 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 14 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 35-10 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN GENERAL DESCRIPTION Figure 7 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Thermal Compensator FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 15 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN GENERAL DESCRIPTION B737-600/700/800 35-10 PRESSURE TRANSDUCER Purpose The pressure transducer supplies a bottle pressure signal to the flight crew oxygen pressure indicator. Physical Description The pressure transducer is a small cylindrical device. It has a threaded fitting and an electrical connector for its output signal. Location The pressure transducer attaches to the temperature compensating coupling by a threaded fitting. Functional Description The pressure transducer is a solid state electronic device. It uses a piezoelectric crystal to convert the force of the gas pressure to an electrical signal. This output signal goes to the flight crew oxygen pressure indicator. For Training Purposes Only Operational Displays The output voltage of the pressure transducer goes to the flight crew oxygen pressure indicator. The indicator has internal lights and gets power from 28v dc from the battery bus. The indicator reads from 0-2000 psi. 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 16 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 35-10 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN GENERAL DESCRIPTION Figure 8 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Pressure Transducer FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 17 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN GENERAL DESCRIPTION B737-600/700/800 35-10 PRESSURE REDUCING REGULATOR Purpose The pressure reducing regulator reduces the oxygen pressure before it goes into the low pressure supply line. It protects the downstream components from high pressure. Location The pressure reducing regulator attaches to the thermal compensator coupling on the oxygen cylinder. For Training Purposes Only Functional Description These components supply force on a diaphragm in the pressure reducing regulator: - Spring pressure - Ambient pressure - Oxygen cylinder pressure. The diaphragm controls a metering valve that reduces the oxygen pressure from bottle pressure to 60 — 85 psig. The regulator has a fail safe relief valve. This relief valve opens when downstream line pressure is more than 100 psig. The relief valve bleeds into the EE compartment. The inlet of the pressure reducing regulator has a filter. The filter does not require servicing. Training Information Point There are no line adjustments for the pressure reducing regulator. Remove the valve and send it to overhaul for adjustment. 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 18 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 35-10 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN GENERAL DESCRIPTION Figure 9 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Pressure Reducing Regulator FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 19 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN GENERAL DESCRIPTION B737-600/700/800 35-10 SYSTEM SHUTOFF VALVE Purpose The crew oxygen system shutoff valve controls the flow of oxygen to the masks in the flight deck. The valve is open during flight operations. It can be closed for maintenance operations. Physical Description The system shutoff valve is installed on the P6 panel. A round, knurled knob controls the valve. The valve has two threaded fittings to attach it to the oxygen supply line. An arrow cast into the valve body shows the direction of flow. The valve has a flange with holes for four mounting screws. Location The system shutoff valve is on the outboard middle area of the P6 panel. Functional Description The system shutoff valve is a needle valve. It shuts off oxygen flow in the closed position. It allows partial flow in the partially open position. The valve allows full flow when fully opened. The valve should be positioned either fully open or fully closed. For Training Purposes Only Operational Controls Turn the valve knob clockwise (facing the valve) to close the valve. Turn the valve knob counterclockwise (facing the valve) to open the valve. Training Information Point Do not overtorque the crew oxygen system shutoff valve. Torque to finger tight only (25 pound—inches maximum). Do not use oil on any part of the valve. Oil is combustible. Even small quantities of oil, in contact with oxygen can cause a fire or explosion. 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 20 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 35-10 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN GENERAL DESCRIPTION Figure 10 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br System Shutoff Valve FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 21 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN GENERAL DESCRIPTION B737-600/700/800 35-00 MASK WITH GOGGLES — GENERAL DESCRIPTION Purpose The flight crew oxygen masks supply each crew member with an independently adjustable source of oxygen. Physical Description The flight crew oxygen masks are identical modular units. The masks have these components: - A hard—shell oronasal (mouth and nose) cup - Goggles - An inflatable harness - An armored flexible oxygen supply hose with a bayonet connection - A microphone lead with a radio jack connection. The pilot oxygen masks are in stowage boxes. The boxes have these features: - An automatic shutoff valve - An oxygen flow indicator (yellow cross) - A RESET/TEST selector. The observer oxygen masks are in stowage cups. The stowage cups do not have the features of the stowage boxes. Operational Displays Flow indicators on the stowage boxes show oxygen flow to the masks. A yellow cross shows oxygen flow. A white OXY ON flag on the box door shows when the stowage box shutoff valve is open. For Training Purposes Only Location The flight crew oxygen masks are outboard of the crew member seats. Operational Controls The flight crew oxygen masks have these control features: - Dilution or 100% oxygen - Demand or constant flow oxygen - Goggle vents for smoke clearance - Mask harness inflation. The mask stowage boxes have these control features: - Box shutoff valve tests - Box resets for mask stowage. 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 22 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 35-00 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN GENERAL DESCRIPTION Figure 11 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Mask with Goggles - General Description FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 23 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training For Training Purposes Only FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN GENERAL DESCRIPTION B737-600/700/800 35-10 MASK WITH GOGGLES — FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION AND OPERATION Functional Description and Operation To remove the masks from their stowage modules, grasp and pull on the red donning/inflation plates (ears). The elastic mask harness inflates when you push the left plate in. You can put on the mask with one hand. The harness deflates when the plates are released. The deflated harness holds the mask securely on the user’s face. As you pull the mask from the stowage box, the box shutoff valve opens, and the white OXY ON flag comes into view. The flight crew oxygen mask now supplies oxygen to the user. The crew oxygen masks are diluter/demand masks. Controls on each mask determine the mode of oxygen de livery. In the demand mode, a mask regulator supplies oxygen to the crew member only when the crew member inhales. To select continuous flow mode, move the EMERGENCY/TEST selector to EMERGENCY. In the diluter mode, ambient cabin air mixes with oxygen. An aneroid metering valve in the mask controls this function. The mix of air and oxygen is proportional to the cabin pressure altitude. To select pure oxygen, push the red normal/100% selector to the 100% position. The mask goggles have vent valves for smoke clearance. The vent valves clear smoke from the goggles when the user exhales. The pilot masks stow in special panel mounted boxes. The boxes have these features: - A shutoff valve - A RESET/TEST selector (red) - An OXY—ON flag (white) - An oxygen flow indicator (yellow cross). The box shutoff valve is closed when the mask is stowed. It opens when you remove the mask. The OXY—ON flag is in view when the shutoff valve is open. The flow indicator is a visual indication of oxygen flow to the mask. You use the RESET/TEST selector to do a test of the system and reset the shutoff valve when the mask is stowed. The observer mask stowage cups do not have the box features. 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 24 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 35-10 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN GENERAL DESCRIPTION Figure 12 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Mask with Goggles - Functional Description and Operation FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 25 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training PASSENGER OXYGEN GENERAL DESCRIPTION B737-600/700/800 35-20 35-20 PASSENGER OXYGEN — INTRODUCTION Purpose The passenger oxygen system supplies emergency oxygen to the passengers and cabin attendants. For Training Purposes Only General Description The passenger oxygen system uses chemical generators to make oxygen. Oxygen from the generators flows through flexible supply hoses to the passenger oxygen masks. Passenger oxygen masks are deployed electrically one of two ways: - Manually by the crew using a guarded toggle switch on the aft P5 panel - Automatically by activation of an aneroid switch (cabin altitude 14000 ft.). Passenger oxygen generation is initiated mechanically when the oxygen mask is pulled to the user s face. Pulling the mask releases a spring loaded firing pin on the generator. The firing pin strikes a percussion cap, which starts the reaction. Once started, the reaction goes to completion, and cannot be stopped. Operational Displays The PASS OXY ON light on the P5 panel comes on when the passenger oxygen masks are deployed. The chemical oxygen generators have a band of heat sensitive tape around them. The tape turns black when heated. A chemical oxygen generator with black tape is expended and must be replaced. WARNING: THE OXYGEN GENERATOR IS A PYROTECHNIC— ACTIVATED DEVICE. MAKE SURE THE RELEASE PIN OR A SAFETY PIN IS SECURED BEFORE HANDLING AN UNFIRED GENERATOR. IF THE GENERATOR FIRES, THE SURFACE TEMPERATURE CAN BE MORE THAN 450F (232C) AND CAUSE INJURY TO PERSONS. Location Passenger oxygen generators, masks, firing pin mechanisms, and deployment door latch actuators are located in: - The passenger service units (PSUs) - The lavatory service units - The attendant service units. A guarded toggle switch for manual deployment of the passenger oxygen masks is located on the aft P5 panel. An aneroid switch for automatic deployment, and system electrical relays are located in the EE compartment in the J23 junction box. A PASS OXY ON light on the P5 panel indicates deployment of the passenger oxygen masks. 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 26 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 35-20 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training PASSENGER OXYGEN GENERAL DESCRIPTION Figure 13 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Introduction FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 27 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training PASSENGER OXYGEN INTRODUCTION B737-600/700/800 35-20 OXYGEN GENERATOR Purpose The oxygen generators supply emergency oxygen to the passengers and flight attendants. Physical Description The oxygen generators are metal cased cylindrical devices. At one end of the generator is a spring loaded firing mechanism. At the other end is an output manifold and a relief valve. The oxygen generator output manifolds have 4,3, or 2 ports. The size of the generator determines the number of output manifold ports. For Training Purposes Only Location The oxygen generators are located in: - The passenger service units (PSUs) - The lavatory service units - The attendant service units. Operational Displays A heat sensitive indicator on the generator shows the generator condition. The indicator is a piece of tape, a painted stripe, or a band of dots around the generator. The indicator is normally orange. The heat generated during activation changes the indicator to black. A used generator cannot be recharged. Replace generators if their indicator is black. Training Information Point Safety pin the oxygen generators to prevent accidental firing during maintenance activities. The firing pins are cross—drilled to accept a safety pin. Special safety pin pliers can be used to pull the firing pin back to expose the safety pin hole. The safety pin should have a ribbon to prevent a safety pinned generator from being put into service. Functional Description The oxygen generators make oxygen by a chemical reaction. In the reaction, sodium chlorate and iron react to generate salt and gaseous oxygen. Once the reaction starts, it cannot be stopped. The reaction continues until all the sodium chlorate is used. The reaction produces heat and generator surface temperatures can reach 450F. The gaseous oxygen passes through a filtering medium and then flows out of the output manifold. The output manifold ports are connected to the passenger oxygen masks by flexible tubing. A pressure relief valve prevents over pressurization of the generator. Operational Controls The oxygen generator is activated mechanically. When a passenger pulls on an oxygen mask, a mask lanyard pulls on the firing pin release cable. The release cable pulls the release pin from the spring loaded firing pin. The firing pin then strikes the percussion cap. The percussion cap supplies the energy required to activate the generator. 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 28 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 35-20 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training PASSENGER OXYGEN INTRODUCTION Figure 14 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Oxygen Generator FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 29 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training PASSENGER OXYGEN INTRODUCTION B737-600/700/800 35-20 PASSENGER OXYGEN MASK Purpose The passenger oxygen masks supply breathing oxygen to aircraft passengers and flight attendants during emergency decompression of the aircraft. Physical Description The passenger oxygen masks have the following parts: - A bright yellow silicon rubber facepiece with breathing valves, elastic headstrap, and generator release lanyard - Flexible supply tubing and reservoir bag. For Training Purposes Only Location The passenger oxygen masks are located in the passenger service units (PSUs), the flight attendant service units, and the lavatory service units. An extra mask is in each station for an infant. Operational Displays Instructions for mask use are diagrammed on the reservoir bag. In some models the reservoir bag has a built—in flow indicator which inflates when oxygen flows into the bag. The indicator area is shaded green for easy recognition. Other configurations include an in—line flow indicator which changes color to green in the presence of oxygen. Training Information Point The length of the oxygen tube differs between the various bag and tube assemblies. Be sure to use the right length. When repitching PSUs for class configuration changes, make sure the gasper hose brackets near the PSUs do not interfere with the passenger oxygen supply tubing. If improperly spaced, the brackets can pinch or cut the supply tubing when the PSU is closed. Functional Description When stowed, the masks are packed in the service unit. When deployed, the masks hang by a mask lanyard. When the mask is pulled to the user’s face, the mask lanyard pulls on the oxygen generator firing pin release cable. This starts the oxygen generator. Oxygen from the generator manifold flows through the mask tubing to the reservoir bag. The reservoir bag stores oxygen from the constant outflow of the generator when the user is not inhaling. During inhalation, the oxygen flows through the reservoir bag and the mask inhalation valve. When the oxygen in the bag is used, the mask ambient air valve opens to allow ambient air to enter the facepiece. When the user exhales, the inhalation and ambient air valves close, and the exhalation valve opens. The exhalation valve lets the used air flow out of the mask. Operational Controls The user places the yellow facepiece over the mouth and nose. The soft silicon rubber of the mask contours to the facial features to give a good seal. The mask can be held in place by hand or by pulling the mask’s elastic headstrap over the user1s head. The headstrap can be adjusted by pulling on either of its ends. 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 30 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 35-20 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training PASSENGER OXYGEN INTRODUCTION Figure 15 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Passenger Oxygen Mask FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 31 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training PASSENGER OXYGEN INTRODUCTION B737-600/700/800 35-20 DOOR LATCH ACTUATOR Purpose The door latch actuators open the oxygen mask door panels in the passenger service units (PSUs), attendant service units, and lavatory service units. When the oxygen door panel is open, the masks fall out of their stowed position and hang in front of the user. Physical Description The door latch actuators have: - A solenoid - A spring loaded latch actuator - A latch actuator lever - A spring loaded door latch. For Training Purposes Only Location The door latch actuators are part of the upper assemblies in: - The PSUs - The attendant service units - The lavatory service units. 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 32 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 35-20 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training PASSENGER OXYGEN INTRODUCTION Figure 16 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Door Latch Actuator FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 33 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training PASSENGER OXYGEN INTRODUCTION B737-600/700/800 35-20 DOOR LATCH ACTUATOR CIRCUIT Location These components are in the J23 junction box in the EE compartment: - R323 passenger oxygen manual deployment relay - R322 passenger oxygen auto deployment relay - R324 passenger oxygen indicator relay - S813 14,000 ft. altitude pressure switch. The PASS OXYGEN switch and PASS OXY ON light are on the aft P5 panel. The passenger oxygen door latch actuators are located in: - The passenger service units (PSUs) - The lavatory service units - The flight attendant service units. Operational Displays The oxygen indicator relay is energized through the energized contacts of either of the two oxygen deployment relays. The energized contacts of the oxygen indicator relay cause: - The P5 PASS OXY ON light to come on - A relay holding circuit to be made. The holding circuit keeps the indication relay energized until power is removed from the 28 volts D.C. battery bus. For Training Purposes Only Functional Description The oxygen mask door panels are held closed by a spring loaded door latch. The passenger oxygen masks are deployed electrically. The signal is 28 volts D.C. The voltage energizes the door latch actuator solenoid. The energized solenoid releases a spring loaded latch actuator. The actuator pushes the oxygen mask door open. Operational Controls The door latch actuators receive power through the energized contacts of either of two oxygen deployment re lays: - R323 manual oxygen deploy relay - R322 auto oxygen deploy relay. The deployment relays are energized by either: - Placing the P5 PASS OXYGEN switch to ON - Actuation of the 14,000 ft. altitude pressure switch. The deployment relays have timers and remain energized for only 5 seconds. This is enough time to ensure mask deployment and conserves the airplane1s battery power. 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 34 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 35-20 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training PASSENGER OXYGEN INTRODUCTION Figure 17 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Door Latch Actuator Circuit FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 35 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 35-20 THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training PASSENGER OXYGEN INTRODUCTION 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 36 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training PASSENGER OXYGEN INTRODUCTION B737-600/700/800 35-20 PASSENGER OXYGEN SYSTEM RELAYS For Training Purposes Only EE COMPT ACCESS DOOR ALTITUDE PRESSURE SWITCH J23 BOX EE COMPARTMENT (LOOKING AFT) FWD Figure 18 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br EE COMPT ACCESS DOOR Pressure Switch and Relays FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 37 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training PASSENGER OXYGEN INTRODUCTION B737-600/700/800 35-20 DOOR TEST / RESET Purpose The passenger oxygen mask deployment doors have test/reset buttons. These buttons are used: - To make door deployment tests easier - To reset the door latch actuator. Physical Description The test/reset button is a rectangular piece on the passenger oxygen mask door. For Training Purposes Only Functional Description In the normal position, the stop is faired with the door panel. In the normal position, the stop will allow the door to fully open when the latch actuator is energi zed. In the test position, the stop is pulled out of and turned crosswise to its recess in the door panel. In this position it will block the doors from opening far enough to drop the masks. This position is used when testing the mask deployment system. To reset the door latch actuator: - Hold the oxygen mask door panel closed - Align the test/reset button to the normal position - Push on the test stop and reset button. An audible click is heard when the spring loaded latch actuator resets. Training Information Point The PSU oxygen door panels can be opened manually. This is done by inserting a 0.125 in (3.0 mm) pin punch into the door panel release hole. Then press upward against the latch release to open the door. The attendant service oxygen panel doors and lavatory service oxygen panel doors can be opened manually. This is done by inserting a flat tool (6.0 in. pokket scale) in the door edge gap. Then press upward against the latch release to open the door. 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 38 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 35-20 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training PASSENGER OXYGEN INTRODUCTION Figure 19 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Door Test / Reset FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 39 AMET Ltd. Lufthansa Technical Training For Training Purposes Only PASSENGER OXYGEN INTRODUCTION B737-600/700/800 35-30 35-30 PORTABLE OXYGEN EQUIPMENT — INTRODUCTION Purpose Portable oxygen cylinders are used for walk around First Aid and sustaining purposes. Protective breathing equipment (PBE) supplies a crew member with a smoke hood and an air system for protection against smoke or toxic fumes. The PBEs protect the user during fire fighting operations. General Description Each portable oxygen cylinder is a separate system. The cylinder stores a supply of oxygen under high pressure (1800 psig at 70F). A gage on the cylinder shows cylinder pressure (and thereby the quantity of oxygen available). A shutoff valve on the cylinder head controls the flow of the high pressure oxygen to the cylinder head assembly. Cylinder head components regulate oxygen pressure and flow to the attached mask(s). The portable oxygen cylinders have these features: - Identifying and instructional placards - A high pressure cylinder - A cylinder pressure gage - A shutoff valve - A cylinder head assembly - A mask - A carrying strap. Each PBE is a separate system. The PBEs have these features: - A vacuum sealed storage container with identifying and instructional placards - A loose fitting universal sized smoke hood with oronasal mask and breathing air system. 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Location The portable oxygen equipment is installed at easily reached locations throughout the airplane: - On the exterior walls of windscreens, lavatories, and galleys - In placarded overhead stowage bins - In placarded storage units. Interface The portable oxygen equipment is independent (separate) of the other aircraft systems. Standard outlet fittings (bayonet type) are used on the portable oxygen cylinders. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 40 AMET Ltd. B737-600/700/800 35-30 For Training Purposes Only Lufthansa Technical Training PASSENGER OXYGEN INTRODUCTION Figure 20 24 Jun 99 REFRESHER COURSE FRA US/E br Introduction FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Page: 41 AMET Ltd. REFRESHER COURSE FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ATA 24-00-00 ELECTRICAL POWER B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd CONTENTS ATA 24 – ELECTRICAL POWER ELECTRICAL POWER - POWER AND CONTROL - ..................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 GENERAL DESCRIPTION ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 6 PURPOSE ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 6 AC POWER ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 6 STANDBY POWER ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 PROTECTION AND CONTROL .................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 6 ELECTRICAL POWER - OPERATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 8 GENERAL DESCRIPTION ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 8 AC SYSTEMS, GENERATOR AND APU MODULE (P5-4) ...................................................................................................................................................................................... 10 FORWARD FLIGHT ATTENDANT’S PANEL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................ 10 EXTERNAL POWER - GENERAL DESCRIPTION ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 12 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 12 GENERAL DESCRIPTION ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 12 BUS POWER CONTROL UNIT (BPCU) .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 12 MANUAL CONTROL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 12 AUTOMATIC CONTROL (SYSTEM PROTECTION) ................................................................................................................................................................................................... 12 INDICATION.......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 12 INDICATION.......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 14 INTERFACES ......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 14 GENERATOR DRIVE - COMPONENT LOCATION ..................................................................................................................................................................................... 16 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 16 INTEGRATED DRIVE GENERATOR (IDG) .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 16 IDG AIR/OIL COOLER ......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 16 GENERATOR DRIVE AND STANDBY POWER MODULE ......................................................................................................................................................................................... 16 GENERATOR DRIVE - INTEGRATED DRIVE GENERATOR .................................................................................................................................................................. 18 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 3 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 18 PHYSICAL DESCRIPTION ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 18 PUSH-TO-VENT VALVE ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 18 CASE PRESSURE RELIEF VALVE .......................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 18 DISCONNECT RESET RING.................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 18 CHARGE OIL FILTER ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 18 SCAVENGE OIL FILTER ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 18 DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE INDICATOR .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 18 OIL LEVEL SIGHTGLASS....................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 18 DRAIN PLUG ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 18 PRESSURE FILL ADAPTER .................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 18 GENERATOR DRIVE – SERVICING ............................................................................................................................................................................................................... 20 CHARGE AND SCAVENGE OIL FILTERS ................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 20 OIL SERVICING .................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 20 OIL QUANTITY CHECK ......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 20 DRAIN PLUG ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 20 TRAINING INFORMATION POINT........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 20 AC GENERATION - APU STARTER GENERATOR ..................................................................................................................................................................................... 22 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 22 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 22 GENERAL DESCRIPTION ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 22 AC GENERATION - START CONVERTER UNIT (SCU) ............................................................................................................................................................................. 24 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 24 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 24 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 24 AC GENERATION - POWER DISTRIBUTION PANELS ............................................................................................................................................................................. 26 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 26 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 26 POWER DISTRIBUTION PANEL 1 ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 26 POWER DISTRIBUTION PANEL 2 ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 26 DC GENERATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 28 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd DISTRIBUTION AND CONTROL ..................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 28 DC GENERATION SYSTEM - MAIN BATTERY AND AUXILIARY BATTERY ..................................................................................................................................... 30 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 30 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 30 GENERAL DESCRIPTION ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 30 STANDBY POWER SYSTEM - STANDBY POWER CONTROL UNIT (SPCU) ....................................................................................................................................... 32 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 32 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 32 GENERAL DESCRIPTION ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 32 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 5 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ELECTRICAL POWER - POWER AND CONTROL - Standby Power GENERAL DESCRIPTION With the loss of normal power, the standby power system supplies a minimum of 60 minutes of AC and DC power to systems necessary to maintain safe flight. The batteries supply DC power. The static inverter uses battery power to make AC power. The SPCU controls the distribution of AC and DC standby power. Purpose The electrical power system makes and supplies AC and DC power to the airplane. The system has automatic and manual controls and protection. A standby AC and DC system gives normal and emergency power. AC Power Protection and Control The electrical power system has four main AC power sources and one standby power source. These are the main AC power sources and their supply capacity: The electrical power system uses automatic control to protect the system from source failure or load failure. These Line Replaceable Units (LRUs) supply the system with protection and control logic: - Left Integrated Drive Generator (IDG 1) (90 KVA) - Right Integrated Drive Generator (IDG 2) (90 KVA) - APU starter-generator (90 KVA below 32,000 feet/9,753 meters, and goes down to 66 KVA at 41,000 feet/12,496 meters) - External power (90 KVA) - Left Generator Control Unit (GCU 1) - Right Generator Control Unit (GCU 2) - APU Generator Control Unit (AGCU) - Bus Power Control Unit (BPCU) - Standby Power Control Unit (SPCU) - Start Converter Unit (SCU) The IDGs and APU starter-generator supply a 3 phase, 115 volts (nominal) at 400 Hz. The AC power system design prevents two sources to the same load at the same time. The static inverter supplies a one phase, 115vac output to the AC standby bus. DC Power Three Transformer Rectifier Units (TRUs) change 115vac to 28vdc. The airplane also has these DC power sources: The GCUs monitor the system to control and protect the IDGs. The APU GCU and the Starter Converter Unit (SCU) work together to control and protect the APU starter-generator. The Bus Power Control Unit (BPCU) controls and monitors the use of external power. The BPCU protects the airplane from external power whose quality is out of limits. The modules on the P5 panel give manual control and also let you monitor the status of the electrical power system. These breakers allow power to the buses: - Main battery - Main battery charger - Auxiliary battery - Auxiliary battery charger - External Power Contactor (EPC) - APU Power Breaker (APB) - Generator Control Breaker (GCB) - Bus Tie Breakers (BTBs) The batteries are the backup DC source if other sources do not operate. The Standby Power Control Unit (SPCU) controls the distribution of DC power. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 1 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 7 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ELECTRICAL POWER - OPERATION GENERAL DESCRIPTION These are the effects of the standby power switch in the other two positions: You use switches on the forward P5 overhead panel or the forward flight attendant's panel to operate the electrical system. Electrical Meters, Battery and Galley Power Module (P5-13) You put the BAT switch to the ON position to energize these buses and components with battery power: - De-energize the AC standby bus and the DC standby bus (OFF position), - Energize the AC standby bus with battery power through the static inverter - Energize the DC standby bus with battery power (BAT position) - Switched hot battery bus - Battery bus - Static inverter - AC standby bus - DC standby bus - P5-13 alphanumeric display You use the GALLEY switch to control power to all galleys. You use the DC and AC selectors and the alphanumeric display to monitor the electrical power system power sources. Generator Drive And Standby Power Module (P5-5) The generator drive disconnect switch operates the disconnect mechanism for its Integrated Drive Generator (IDG). This removes engine accessory gearbox power from the IDG. The engine start lever must be in the idle position for the disconnect function to operate. The standby power switch gives you manual control of the AC and DC standby power bus sources. In the auto position, the AC standby bus receives power from AC transfer bus 1 and the DC standby bus receives power from DC bus 1 when these sources are available. If the sources are not available, the AC standby bus receives power from the static inverter and the DC standby bus receives power from the battery. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 2 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 9 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ELECTRICAL POWER - OPERATION GENERAL DESCRIPTION pt 2 AC Systems, Generator and APU Module (P5-4) If the AC transfer buses do have power initially, then only the AC transfer bus on the same side as the APU GEN switch you operate will energize with APU power. The blue APU GEN OFF BUS light comes on when the APU is ready to supply electrical power. You use the ground power switch to control external power to the AC transfer buses. The blue GRD POWER AVAILABLE light above the switch shows if the ground source is connected and quality is good. Both AC transfer buses receive power when you put the ground power switch to the ON position. Forward Flight Attendant’s Panel Any initial power sources are removed before the transfer buses receive external power. You use the ground service switch to supply external power to ground service bus 1 and 2 with external power connected. This makes it possible to supply electrical power for cabin servicing without going into the flight compartment. The bus transfer switch gives you manual control of the BTBs and the DC bus tie relay. In the AUTO position, the BTBs and the DC bus tie relay operate automatically as necessary. In the OFF position, the BTBs open and isolate the AC transfer buses from each other. The DC bus tie relay will also open. This isolates DC bus 1 and DC bus 2 from each other. The position also resets the BTB trip circuits. You use the GEN 1 and GEN 2 switches to supply IDG power to an AC transfer bus. The AC transfer bus on that side goes to IDG power when you temporarily put the switch to the ON position. Any initial power sources are removed. You use the APU GEN switches to supply power to the AC transfer buses. There are two switches because there are two Bus Tie Breakers (BTBs) that supply power to the AC transfer buses. Both AC transfer buses will receive APU power with operation of just one APU GEN switch if both AC transfer buses do not have power initially. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 10 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 3 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 11 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd EXTERNAL POWER - GENERAL DESCRIPTION Purpose Manual Control External power is the normal source of AC power for the airplane electrical system when the airplane is on the ground. It lets you have the engines and APU power sources off. It also gives power to the battery charger to charge the battery. The ground power switch is on the AC system, generator, and APU module. You use this switch to make the AC transfer buses receive external power through the EPC and the BTBs. The BPCU closes the EPC directly. Each BTB closes after it receives a signal from the BPCU through a GCU. General Description A switch on the forward attendant's panel lets you power the AC and DC ground service buses directly from the external power source. AC power goes through the two ground service transfer relays. DC power goes through the ground service bus relay. The BPCU uses input from the forward attendant's panel to control the relays. The Bus Power Control Unit (BPCU) uses inputs and internal logic to control distribution of external power on the airplane. The BPCU has BuiltIn Test Equipment (BITE) to help you do troubleshooting of the external power system. Switches on the AC system, generator, and APU module and the forward attendant's panel give you manual control of external power. The external power panel and the AC system, generator, and APU module have external power indication. The external power panel has a receptacle for AC external power connection. Automatic Control (System Protection) The BPCU uses inputs from the external power Line Current Transformer (LCT) and feeder lines to monitor external power quality. The BPCU controls the EPC position to protect airplane systems. The BPCU also removes power to some buses (load shed) to protect the system. Bus Power Control Unit (BPCU) The BPCU controls the use of external power through these components: Indication - External Power Contactor (EPC) position - Bus Tie Breaker (BTB) positions through the Generator Control Units (GCUs) - Ground service transfer relays (power to AC ground service buses) - Ground service bus relay (power to ground service DC bus) - Indication on the AC system, generator, and APU module and the external power panel The BPCU controls external power indication at the AC systems, generator, and APU module and at the external power panel. The BPCU also interfaces with other systems. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 12 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 4 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 13 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd EXTERNAL POWER - BPCU - EXTERNAL POWER CONTACTOR CONTROL, PROTECTION, AND INDICATION (CONT.) Indication Interfaces The blue GRD POWER AVAILABLE light comes on to show the external power is connected and power quality is in limits. The BPCU supplies power for the light. The external power sensing relay (R47) energizes to supply entry way lighting to the passenger entry door areas. This relay receives power from the BPCU. The refuelling power control relay (R11) energizes to supply power to the fuelling station. This relay receives power from the BPCU. The light comes on when these conditions are true: - There is continuity through pins E and F at the external power connection - Connected external power quality is in limits The amber CONN light comes on to show that external power is connected. This light is not an indication that power quality is good. The light is neon and receives AC power directly from the external power feeder lines in PDP 2 (P92). The white NOT IS USE light comes on to show that the ground service buses and transfer buses are not receiving power from the external power source. The light comes on when these conditions are true: - There is continuity through pins E and F (external power plug connected) - The ground service relays are de-energized - The EPC is open B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 14 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 5 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 15 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd GENERATOR DRIVE - COMPONENT LOCATION General The components of the generator drive are on the engine and in the flight compartment. Integrated Drive Generator (IDG) The IDG is on the front face of the engine accessory gearbox at the 7:00 position. The IDG is immediately below the engine starter. You open the left engine fan cowl to gain access to the IDG installation. When servicing, you can gain access to the IDG through the IDG servicing door in the left fan cowl. IDG Air/Oil Cooler The air/oil cooler is on the inside, aft portion, of the fan case at the 6:30 position. You open the engine left fan cowl to get access to the air/oil cooler. Generator Drive and Standby Power Module The generator drive and standby power module is on the P5 forward overhead panel in the flight compartment. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 16 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 6 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 17 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd GENERATOR DRIVE - INTEGRATED DRIVE GENERATOR Charge Oil Filter (IDG) The charge oil filter is downstream of the IDG charge pump. Oil bypasses this filter if it becomes clogged. There is no visual indication on the IDG that this filter is in the bypass condition. You replace the charge oil filter on regular intervals. Purpose The Integrated Drive Generators (IDG) are the normal source of AC power generation in flight. There are two IDGs on the airplane. Each supplies 115vac, 400 Hz power. The IDG can supply up to 90 KVA. Scavenge Oil Filter Physical Description The scavenge oil filter is downstream of the IDG scavenge pump. Oil bypasses this filter if it becomes clogged. You replace the scavenge oil filter on regular intervals. The IDG has a constant speed drive section and a generator. The IDG weighs approximately 117 pounds (53 kgs). Differential Pressure Indicator Push-To-Vent Valve The differential pressure indicator supplies a visual indication of a clogged scavenge filter. A temperature lockout feature prevents a false differential pressure indication during engine start with cold oil. The vent valve is a spring-actuated valve that keeps constant internal pressure in the IDG case. You also push the button to release the air pressure before you service the IDG with oil or drain the oil. Oil Level Sightglass Case Pressure Relief Valve The oil level sightglass shows the relative amount of oil in the IDG. You use the sightglass to do a check of the oil quantity. The case pressure relief valve prevents the IDG case from rupture if the fuel/oil cooler leaks fuel into the oil system. The oil vents into the area between the engine accessory gearbox and the IDG. Fluid in this area drains overboard through the engine drain system. Drain Plug You remove the drain plug to drain the IDG oil. Disconnect Reset Ring Pressure Fill Adapter You use the disconnect reset ring to reconnect the IDG after a manual disconnect. The engine must not be turning when you do a reset of the IDG. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE You use the pressure fill adapter when servicing the IDG oil level. 18 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 7 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 19 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd GENERATOR DRIVE – SERVICING Charge and Scavenge Oil Filters Oil Quantity Check There are two remove-and-replace oil filters on the IDG. You check and replace both filters at scheduled intervals. You should always replace old filters with new filters. The charge oil filter is downstream of the charge pump. If this filter clogs, a differential pressure valve opens and lets oil bypass the filter. There is no indication if this filter clogs. The scavenge filter is downstream of the scavenge pump. The differential pressure indicator shows if the filter clogs. The oil level sight glass shows the relative amount of oil in the IDG. The oil level sight glass cover is black with a silver band. When the oil level is below the silver band, the IDG oil level is low and it is necessary to add oil. When the oil level is in the silver band, the IDG oil level is normal. When the oil level is above the silver band, the IDG oil level is high and you must drain oil. The same IDG is used on either the left or right engine. With wing dihedral, the oil level in the sight glass changes. You must service to the correct left or right engine marks on the sight glass. You should always vent the IDG before you do an oil quantity check. Oil Servicing Oil servicing of the IDG occurs at the pressure fill port. You should push the push-to-vent-valve to release IDG case air pressure before you add oil. The oil that you pump into the IDG flows through the scavenge filter and then through the heat exchangers and into the IDG case. Air in the circuit moves ahead of the oil to the IDG sump. Because it takes time for the oil to flow through external components, you should add oil slowly. This prevents over servicing. You pump oil into the IDG until the correct oil level shows on the oil sight glass. CAUTION: DO NOT CHECK THE OIL LEVEL OF A DISCONNECTED IDG. A DISCONNECT CAN CAUSE AN INCORRECT OIL QUANTITY INDICATION IN THE IDG. TOO MUCH OR NOT ENOUGH OIL CAN CAUSE DAMAGE TO THE IDG DURING CONTINUED OPERATION WARNING: SERVICE TO THE PROPER LEVEL. OPERATION OF THE IDG WITH TOO MUCH OIL OR WITHOUT ENOUGH OIL CAUSES DAMAGE TO THE IDG. Training Information Point Drain Plug There is a drain plug at the bottom of the IDG. You use it to drain the oil from the IDG. The IDG has two servicing placards. The small placard below the sightglass reminds you to vent the IDG before you do an oil quantity check. Your check may not be accurate if you do not vent the IDG. WARNING: FAILURE TO PUSH THE CAP OF THE VENT VALVE TO RELIEVE THE INTERNAL IDG PRESSURE COULD CAUSE HOT OIL TO SPRAY OUT. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE The large placard has a warning and the IDG servicing instructions. You should always vent the IDG before and after you service it. 20 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 8 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 21 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd AC GENERATION - APU STARTER GENERATOR Purpose The APU starter-generator has two functions. First, the starter-generator makes AC power for ground operations. The starter generator can supply electrical power during flight as backup to the IDGs. The starter-generator also starts the APU. It uses AC power from the Start Converter Unit (SCU) to turn the APU during the start sequence. Location The starter-generator is on the right side of the APU gear box. It attaches to the gearbox with 8 nuts. You replace the starter-generator without removal of the APU. General Description The APU starter-generator is an oil cooled, three phase, brushless, rotating rectifier machine. It operates at 12,000 rpm. The generator includes these components: - An exciter - A main generator - A Permanent Magnet Generator (PMG) The PMG supplies power for start-up, and voltage control of the APU channel. The starter-generator supplies 3 phase, 115 volts (nominal) power at 400Hz. The starter-generator supplies up to 90 KVA below 32,000 feet (9753 meters). The starter-generator can supply 66 KVA at 41,000 feet (12,496 meters). B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 22 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 9 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 23 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd AC GENERATION - START CONVERTER UNIT (SCU) Purpose The start converter unit (SCU) has two functions: - Regulate the APU starter-generator electrical power output - Turn the APU during an APU start Location The SCU is on the E2 rack in the EE compartment. General The SCU operates with the APU Generator Control Unit (AGCU) to control and regulate APU starter-generator power. The APU Generator Control Relay (AGCR) and the starter-generator voltage regulator are inside the SCU. The SCU also makes the starter-generator function like a motor to turn the APU during starting. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 24 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 10 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 25 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd AC GENERATION - POWER DISTRIBUTION PANELS Power Distribution Panel 2 General The Power Distribution Panel 2 (PDP 2 or P92), have these components: The Power Distribution Panels (PDPs) contain the breakers and many of the electrical buses. Each PDP has a door on the front of it that is usually closed. The front of each door has circuit breakers. - AC transfer bus 2 - Ground service bus 2 - DC bus 2 - GCB 2 - External Power Contactor (EPC) - BTB 2 Location PDP 1 (P91) is on the left side of the E/E compartment. PDP 2 (P92) is on the right side of the E/E compartment. There are four red lights on the forward and aft face of the Power Distribution Panel. You can see the lights on the aft face when you are in the forward cargo compartment. These lights come on to warn you that electrical power is active inside the panel. Power Distribution Panel 1 The Power Distribution Panel 1 (PDP 1 or P91), have these components: The lights have these names and come on with these conditions: - AC transfer bus 1 - Ground service bus 1 - DC bus 1 - Generator Control Breaker 1 (GCB 1) - Auxiliary Power Breaker (APB) - Bus Tie Breaker 1 (BTB 1) - GEN 2 (on when IDG 2 supplies power) - TIE BUS (on where there is power at the bus tie breakers) - XFR BUS (on when AC transfer bus 2 has power) - EXT PWR (on when external power supplies power) There are four red lights on the forward and aft face of the Power Distribution Panel. These lights come on to warn you that electrical power is active inside the panel. You can see the lights on the aft face when you are in the forward cargo compartment. The lights have these names and come on with these conditions: - GEN 1 (on when IDG 1 supplies power) - TIE BUS (on where there is power at the bus tie breakers) - APU PWR (on when the starter-generator supplies power) - EXT PWR (on when external power supplies power) B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 26 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 11 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 27 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd DC GENERATION DISTRIBUTION AND CONTROL The auxiliary battery charger receives power from ground service bus 1. Control These switches and components control the relays in the DC distribution: - Standby Power Control Unit (SPCU) - Bus Power Control Unit (BPCU) - Battery switch - Standby power switch The DC power system is a two wire system that operates at 28 volts (nominal). The DC system has these power sources: - Three Transformer Rectifiers Units (TRUs) - Battery charger - Battery The TRUs are the normal power source for the DC power system. The TRUs change 115vac, 3 phase power to unregulated 28vdc. Each TRU can supply up to 75 amps when airplane cooling air is available. The TRUs are connected in parallel to provide back-up to each other. TRU 1 receives power from the AC transfer bus 1. TRU 1 output connects directly to DC bus 1. TRU 2 receives power from the AC transfer bus 2. TRU 2 output connects directly to DC bus 2. TRU 3 usually receives power from AC transfer bus 2. AC transfer bus 1 supplies back up power through R662 if normal power is lost. The primary use of TRU 3 is as a power source for the battery bus. The main battery charger receives power from the AC ground service bus 2. Ground service bus 2 gets power from AC transfer bus 2. The main battery charger is the primary power supply for the hot and switched hot battery bus. The auxiliary battery and its charger connect in parallel when the dual battery Remote Control Circuit Breaker (RCCB) is closed. This happens only during conditions when the main battery must supply standby AC and DC power. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 28 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 12 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 29 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd DC GENERATION SYSTEM - MAIN BATTERY AND AUXILIARY BATTERY Purpose The main battery has these functions: - Supply power to critical airplane systems (AC and DC standby buses) if the normal power sources are not available - Backup power supply for the AC system control and protection - Power supply for APU start The auxiliary battery helps the main battery supply power to the critical airplane systems (AC and DC standby buses). Location The batteries are in the E/E compartment, under the E3 rack. The auxiliary battery is forward of the main battery. You remove an access panel in the forward cargo compartment to gain access to the batteries. You must remove the main battery before you can remove the auxiliary battery. General Description Each battery is a 20 cell nickel-cadmium battery with a 48 amp-hour capacity. With full charge, the batteries supply a minimum of 60 minutes of standby AC and DC power. Each battery has an internal thermal sensor. The battery's charger uses this sensor to measure internal battery temperature. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 30 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 13 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 31 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd STANDBY POWER SYSTEM - STANDBY POWER CONTROL UNIT (SPCU) Purpose The Standby Power Control Unit (SPCU) gives manual and automatic power source selection control of the battery and standby buses. The SPCU supplies DC system failure data to the electrical meters, battery and galley power module (P5-13). The SPCU also controls some power distribution relays in the electrical system. Location The SPCU is in the P6 panel. The P6 panel is in the flight compartment, behind the first officer's seat. General Description The SPCU monitors the position of the battery and standby power switches. It also monitors AC, DC and battery buses to control the connection of the battery bus, switched hot battery bus, AC and DC standby buses to the correct power source. B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 32 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd Figure 14 B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 33 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK B737 NG GEN FAM REFRESHER COURSE 34 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ATA 26-00-00 FIRE PROTECTION B737 NG GEN FAM FIRE PROTECTION Version 1 REFRESHER COURSE 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 26-00-00 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd CONTENTS ATA 26 – FIRE PROTECTION FIRE PROTECTION – INTRODUCTION .......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 4 PURPOSE ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 4 FIRE/OVERHEAT DETECTION ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 4 EXTINGUISHING ..................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 4 ENGINE FIRE DETECTION - GENERAL DESCRIPTION ............................................................................................................................................................................ 6 PHYSICAL DESCRIPTION ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 6 GENERAL DESCRIPTION.......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 ENGINE FIRE EXTINGUISHING - OVERHEAT/FIRE .................................................................................................................................................................................. 8 PROTECTION PANEL ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 8 PURPOSE ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 8 LOCATION .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 8 ENGINE FIRE DETECTION - ENGINE AND APU FIRE ............................................................................................................................................................................. 10 DETECTION CONTROL MODULE ................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 10 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 10 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 10 ENGINE FIRE EXTINGUISHING - EXTINGUISHER BOTTLE ................................................................................................................................................................. 12 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 12 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 12 APU FIRE EXTINGUISHING - APU GROUND CONTROL PANEL .......................................................................................................................................................... 14 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 14 PHYSICAL DESCRIPTION ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 14 OPERATION .......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 14 B737 NG GEN FAM FIRE PROTECTION Version 1 REFRESHER COURSE 2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 26-00-00 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd WING AND BODY OVERHEAT DETECTION – INTRODUCTION .......................................................................................................................................................... 16 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 16 LAVATORY SMOKE DETECTION - GENERAL DESCRIPTION ............................................................................................................................................................. 18 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 18 GENERAL DESCRIPTION ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 18 B737 NG GEN FAM FIRE PROTECTION Version 1 REFRESHER COURSE 3 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 26-00-00 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd FIRE PROTECTION – INTRODUCTION Purpose The fire protection systems monitor the airplane for these conditions: - Fire - Smoke - Overheat - Pneumatic duct leaks Fire/Overheat Detection The airplane has these fire/overheat detection systems: - Lavatory smoke detection - Engine fire detection - APU fire detection - Wheel well fire detection - Wing/Body overheat detection Extinguishing The airplane has these fire extinguishing systems: - Lavatory fire extinguishing bottles - Engine fire extinguishing bottles - APU fire extinguishing bottle - Portable fire extinguishers B737 NG GEN FAM FIRE PROTECTION Version 1 REFRESHER COURSE 4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 26-00-00 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM FIRE PROTECTION Version 1 REFRESHER COURSE 5 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 26-00-00 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ENGINE FIRE DETECTION - GENERAL DESCRIPTION Physical Description These are the major components of the engine fire detection system: - Engine overheat/fire detectors - Engine and APU fire detection control module (M279) - Overheat/fire protection panel General description The engine fire detection system uses dual overheat/fire detector loops. The loops are identified as loop A and loop B. The detector loops on the engine supply overheat and fire signals to the engine and APU fire detection control module. This module uses the signals to set the related alarm indications in the flight compartment. B737 NG GEN FAM FIRE PROTECTION Version 1 REFRESHER COURSE 6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 26-00-00 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM FIRE PROTECTION Version 1 REFRESHER COURSE 7 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 26-00-00 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ENGINE FIRE EXTINGUISHING - OVERHEAT/FIRE PROTECTION PANEL Purpose The overheat/fire protection panel monitors the fire protection system for these conditions: - Engine overheat - Engine fire - APU fire - Wheel well fire - L bottle discharge - R bottle discharge - APU bottle discharge - Engine fire protection fault conditions - APU fire protection fault conditions The overheat/fire protection panel lets you do these functions: - Set the mode of operation (single or dual loop operation) - Discharge the fire extinguisher bottles - Do a test of the fire extinguisher bottle squibs - Do a test of the fire protection system - Do a test of the fault detection circuits - Stop the fire alarm bell Location The overheat/fire protection panel is on the P8 panel. B737 NG GEN FAM FIRE PROTECTION Version 1 REFRESHER COURSE 8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 26-00-00 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM FIRE PROTECTION Version 1 REFRESHER COURSE 9 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 26-00-00 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ENGINE FIRE DETECTION - ENGINE AND APU FIRE DETECTION CONTROL MODULE Purpose The engine and APU fire detection control module monitors detector elements for overheat and fire conditions in the engine and APU areas. Location The engine and APU fire detection control module is in the electronic equipment compartment rack E2-2. B737 NG GEN FAM FIRE PROTECTION Version 1 REFRESHER COURSE 10 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 26-00-00 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM FIRE PROTECTION Version 1 REFRESHER COURSE 11 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 26-00-00 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ENGINE FIRE EXTINGUISHING - EXTINGUISHER BOTTLE Purpose The engine fire extinguisher bottles contain the halon gas that extinguishes an engine fire. Location The two engine fire extinguisher bottles are in the upper aft left corner of the left main wheel well. B737 NG GEN FAM FIRE PROTECTION Version 1 REFRESHER COURSE 12 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 26-00-00 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM FIRE PROTECTION Version 1 REFRESHER COURSE 13 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 26-00-00 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd APU FIRE EXTINGUISHING - APU GROUND CONTROL PANEL Purpose On the ground, the APU ground control panel gives you visual and aural indications of an APU fire. The control panel also lets you extinguish an APU fire. Physical Description The APU ground control panel has these components: - Red fire warning light - Fire horn - Horn cut-out switch - APU fire control handle - Bottle discharge switch Operation When there is a fire in the APU, the horn and light operates alternately and the APU stops. When you push the horn cut-out button the horn sound stops and the red light stays on continuously. When you pull the APU fire control handle, the APU system stops and isolates the APU from other systems. When you pull down the APU fire control handle, you also arm the bottle discharge toggle switch. You push the toggle switch to cause the APU bottle squib explosion. B737 NG GEN FAM FIRE PROTECTION Version 1 REFRESHER COURSE 14 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 26-00-00 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM FIRE PROTECTION Version 1 REFRESHER COURSE 15 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 26-00-00 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd WING AND BODY OVERHEAT DETECTION – INTRODUCTION Purpose The wing and body overheat detection system monitors for overheat conditions caused by pneumatic duct leaks. When its detectors sense this condition, they are shown in the flight compartment on the P5 and P7 panels. B737 NG GEN FAM FIRE PROTECTION Version 1 REFRESHER COURSE 16 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 26-00-00 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM FIRE PROTECTION Version 1 REFRESHER COURSE 17 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 26-00-00 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd LAVATORY SMOKE DETECTION - GENERAL DESCRIPTION Purpose The lavatory smoke detection system monitors for smoke in the lavatories. General Description When there is smoke in a lavatory, the detector gives these alarm indications: - Detector alarm indicator light comes on - Detector gives a horn sound B737 NG GEN FAM FIRE PROTECTION Version 1 REFRESHER COURSE 18 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 26-00-00 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM FIRE PROTECTION Version 1 REFRESHER COURSE 19 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 26-00-00 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK B737 NG GEN FAM FIRE PROTECTION Version 1 REFRESHER COURSE 20 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 26-00-00 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ATA 27-00-00 FLYING CONTROLS B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd CONTENTS ATA 27 – FLYING CONTROLS FLIGHT CONTROLS – INTRODUCTION ........................................................................................................................................................................................................ 6 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 PRIMARY FLIGHT CONTROL SYSTEM ..................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 SECONDARY FLIGHT CONTROLS ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 6 FLIGHT CONTROLS - FLIGHT COMPARTMENT CONTROLS AND INDICATIONS .......................................................................................................................... 8 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 8 AILERON ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 8 ELEVATOR ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 8 RUDDER ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 8 FLAPS AND SLATS .................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 8 SPOILERS AND SPEEDBRAKES ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 8 HORIZONTAL STABILIZER ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 8 STALL WARNING ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 8 FLIGHT CONTROLS - FLIGHT COMPARTMENT CONTROLS AND INDICATIONS PT 2 ............................................................................................................... 10 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 10 AILERON .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 10 RUDDER ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 10 FLAPS AND SLATS ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 10 SPOILERS AND SPEEDBRAKES .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 10 HORIZONTAL STABILIZER .................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 10 AILERON AND AILERON TRIM CONTROL SYSTEM - CABLE ............................................................................................................................................................. 12 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 12 PHYSICAL DESCRIPTION ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 12 FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION – NORMAL................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 12 FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION – MANUAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................... 12 B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 3 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd AILERON AND AILERON TRIM CONTROL SYSTEM - AILERON ........................................................................................................................................................ 14 PCU LINKAGE ..................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 14 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 14 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 14 PHYSICAL DESCRIPTION ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 14 FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION.................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 14 AILERON AND AILERON TRIM CONTROL SYSTEM - ............................................................................................................................................................................ 16 BALANCE PANEL AND TAB ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 16 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 16 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 16 PHYSICAL DESCRIPTION ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 16 FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION.................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 16 FLIGHT SPOILER CONTROL SYSTEM – INTRODUCTION .................................................................................................................................................................... 18 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 18 ROLL CONTROL ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 18 SPEEDBRAKE CONTROL ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 18 AUTO SPEEDBRAKE CONTROL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 18 FLIGHT SPOILER CONTROL SYSTEM – FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION ............................................................................................................................................. 20 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 20 PHYSICAL DESCRIPTION ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 20 FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION - ROLL CONTROL ..................................................................................................................................................................................................... 20 FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION - SPEEDBRAKE CONTROL ......................................................................................................................................................................................... 20 RUDDER AND RUDDER TRIM CONTROL SYSTEM – GENERAL DESCRIPTION ............................................................................................................................. 22 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 22 MANUAL OPERATION - RUDDER PEDALS ............................................................................................................................................................................................................ 22 MANUAL OPERATION - RUDDER TRIM ................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 22 YAW DAMPER ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 22 WHEEL-TO-RUDDER INTERCONNECT SYSTEM (WTRIS) .................................................................................................................................................................................... 22 AUTHORITY LIMITER ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 22 B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ELEVATOR AND TAB CONTROL SYSTEM – GENERAL DESCRIPTION ............................................................................................................................................ 24 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 24 CONTROL COLUMNS ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 24 ELEVATOR FORWARD CONTROL QUADRANTS .................................................................................................................................................................................................... 24 ELEVATOR CONTROL CABLES ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 24 ELEVATORS ......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 24 ELEVATOR FEEL AND CENTRING UNIT ................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 24 ELEVATOR NEUTRAL SHIFT - STABILIZER INPUT ................................................................................................................................................................................................. 24 HORIZONTAL STABILIZER TRIM CONTROL SYSTEM ......................................................................................................................................................................... 26 GENERAL DESCRIPTION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 26 MANUAL OPERATION - STABILIZER TRIM SWITCHES .......................................................................................................................................................................................... 26 MANUAL OPERATION - STABILIZER TRIM WHEELS ............................................................................................................................................................................................. 26 DFCS OPERATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 26 COLUMN CUT-OUT SWITCHES ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 26 STABILIZER TRIM OVERRIDE SWITCH.................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 26 STABILIZER TRIM CUT-OUT SWITCHES ................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 26 FLAPS UP SWITCH ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 26 STABILIZER TRIM LIMIT SWITCHES ..................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 26 TE FLAP SYSTEM - GENERAL DESCRIPTION ........................................................................................................................................................................................... 28 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 28 NORMAL OPERATION ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 28 ALTERNATE OPERATION ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 28 TE FLAP SYSTEM - FLAP POWER DRIVE UNIT ........................................................................................................................................................................................ 30 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 30 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 30 LE FLAP AND SLAT CONTROL SYSTEM .................................................................................................................................................................................................... 32 GENERAL DESCRIPTION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 32 NORMAL OPERATION ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 32 ALTERNATE OPERATION ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 32 B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 5 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd FLIGHT CONTROLS – INTRODUCTION General The flight controls keep the airplane at the necessary attitude during flight. They have movable surfaces on the wing and the empennage. These are the two types of flight control systems: - Primary - Secondary Primary Flight Control System The primary flight control system moves the airplane about three axes: lateral, longitudinal, and vertical. The primary flight control system has these components: - Aileron (2) - Elevator (2) - Rudder Secondary Flight Controls The secondary flight controls improve the lift and handling properties of the airplane. The secondary flight control system has these components: - Leading edge devices (12) - Trailing edge flaps (4) - Spoilers and speedbrakes (12) - Horizontal stabilizer B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 7 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd FLIGHT CONTROLS - FLIGHT COMPARTMENT CONTROLS AND INDICATIONS Spoilers and Speedbrakes General A green SPEED BRAKE ARM light and amber SPEED BRAKE DO NOT ARM light are on the P1 panel. The SPEEDBRAKES EXTENDED light is on the P3 panel. The flight control indication and control components are in the flight compartment. Aileron Horizontal Stabilizer The aileron control wheel is on the top of the elevator control column. The aileron trim indication is on the top of the control wheel. The electric trim switches are on the outboard side of each control wheel. Stall Warning Elevator The stall warning test switches are on the P5 aft overhead panel. The elevator control columns are forward of the pilot seats. Rudder The rudder pedals are forward of the pilot seats. Flaps and Slats The alternate flap switches are on the flight control panel on the P5 forward overhead panel. The indication for the leading edge devices is on the P5 aft overhead panel. The trailing edge flaps indication is on the P2 centre instrument panel. B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 9 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd FLIGHT CONTROLS - FLIGHT COMPARTMENT CONTROLS AND INDICATIONS Pt 2 Horizontal Stabilizer General Some of the flight control indication and control components in the flight compartment are on the control stand. These controls and indications for the horizontal stabilizer are on the P10control stand: Aileron - Captain and first officer stabilizer trim wheels - Stabilizer trim indicator - Stabilizer trim cut-out switches The aileron trim switches are on the aileron/rudder trim panel on the P8 aft electronic panel. A stabilizer override switch is on the P8 aft electronic panel. Rudder The rudder trim control and the rudder trim indicator are on the aileron/rudder trim panel on the P8 aft electronic panel. Flaps and Slats The flap lever is on the P10 control stand. Spoilers and Speedbrakes The speedbrake lever is on the P10 control stand. B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 10 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 11 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd AILERON AND AILERON TRIM CONTROL SYSTEM - CABLE General The aileron control system and the flight spoilers use cable force input from the control wheels. Physical Description The aileron control system has these cables: - Bus drum cables - Left and right body cables - Left and right wing cables Two spring mechanisms isolate the aileron system from the flight spoilers. They are the transfer mechanism and the aileron spring cartridge. Functional Description – Normal When the control wheels move, the left body cables move and control the PCUs. The PCU housing moves and controls the aileron wing cables. When the PCU housing moves, it also controls the right body cables and completes the loop to the right control column. It also controls the spoiler wing cables through the spoiler mixer. This controls the flight spoiler actuators to move after some control wheel movement. Functional Description – Manual Manual operation is almost the same as normal operation with one difference. There is three degrees of control wheel movement at the aileron PCUs before the input crank meets the mechanical stops. Then the PCU housing moves, but the pilot supplies the force. B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 12 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 13 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd AILERON AND AILERON TRIM CONTROL SYSTEM - AILERON PCU LINKAGE Purpose The aileron PCU linkage sends the aileron inputs to the aileron PCUs. Location The aileron PCU linkage is on the left forward bulkhead of the main landing gear wheel well. Physical Description The aileron PCU linkage includes these components: - Control quadrant - Autopilot input rod - Aileron trim actuator - Aileron feel and centring unit · Input shaft - Input pogo cranks (4) - Input pogo (4) Functional Description The aileron input shaft receives inputs from the: - Pilot through the aileron control quadrant - Autopilot through the aileron autopilot input rod - Trim switches through the aileron trim actuator When the shaft moves, it moves the input pogo cranks. This moves the input pogos which control the aileron PCUs B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 14 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 15 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd AILERON AND AILERON TRIM CONTROL SYSTEM BALANCE PANEL AND TAB Purpose The aileron balance panels and tab decrease the force necessary to move the aileron in flight. Location The balance panels are in the number one through four aileron bays. Physical Description The forward edge of the balance panel attaches to the wing structure through an idler hinge. The aft edge attaches to the aileron. Seals connect the hinge assemblies along the two sides of the balance panel. This makes two separate chambers. The upper chamber vents to the airstream over the wing and the lower to the airstream under the wing. Functional Description When there is no lateral input, pressure forces occur across the balance panel and keep the aileron in the neutral position. When the aileron moves, it causes a differential pressure. This moves the balance panel in the opposite direction of the aileron movement. As the balance tab moves, differential forces occur at the tail of the aileron. They help the power source that moves the aileron. These forces are always applied but they are most useful during manual control. B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 16 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 17 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd FLIGHT SPOILER CONTROL SYSTEM – INTRODUCTION General The spoilers help the ailerons control airplane roll about the longitudinal axis. They also supply speedbrake control to reduce lift and increase drag during landing and refused takeoff. There are six spoilers on each wing. There is one spoiler inboard of each engine strut, and five spoilers outboard of each engine strut. Each spoiler has a number, 1 through 12 (from left to right). The ground spoilers are the most outboard and the most inboard spoiler on each wing. All the other spoilers are flight spoilers. The flight crew uses the control wheels and speedbrake lever to manually move the flight spoilers. The autopilot controls them during autoland. Roll Control During roll control, the flight spoilers on one wing move up and all the other spoilers stay down. The pilots manually control roll with the control wheels. When the autopilot is in autoland, the autopilot commands the flight spoilers. Speedbrake Control During speedbrake control, the spoilers on both wings move symmetrically. The pilots manually command speedbrake control with a speedbrake lever on the aisle stand. The autopilot does not control the speedbrake function. Auto Speedbrake Control The auto speedbrake function supplies automatic extension or retraction of all the spoilers during landing and refused takeoff. B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 18 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 19 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd FLIGHT SPOILER CONTROL SYSTEM – FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION Functional Description - Speedbrake Control General When the pilot moves the speedbrake lever, the speedbrake lever cables move a quadrant in the spoiler ratio changer. The spoiler ratio changer moves the spoiler wing cables. The flight spoilers start to move up after 5 degrees of speedbrake lever movement. The flight spoilers on each wing move symmetrically. The pilot uses the control wheels and speedbrake lever to manually move the flight spoilers. The autopilot automatically controls them. Physical Description When the speedbrake lever moves more, the flight spoilers on both wings moves more. The lateral control system has these spoiler cables: - Right body cables - Spoiler wing cables - Speedbrake lever cables Two spring mechanisms isolate the aileron system from the flight spoilers. They are the transfer mechanism and the aileron spring cartridge. Functional Description - Roll Control When the control wheels move, the left body cables move and control the aileron PCUs. The PCU moves the body quadrant, which moves the left and right aileron wing cables. The aileron spring cartridge connects the body quadrant to the spoiler control quadrant. The spoiler control quadrant supplies the control wheel inputs to the spoiler ratio changer and mixer. The spoiler ratio changer moves the spoiler wing cables. The flight spoilers start to move up after 11 degrees of control wheel movement. When the pilot turns the control wheel 11 degrees clockwise, the flight spoilers on the right wing start to move up. When the control wheel turns more, the flight spoilers on the right wing move more. There is no manual reversion for the spoilers. B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 20 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 21 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd RUDDER AND RUDDER TRIM CONTROL SYSTEM – GENERAL DESCRIPTION Wheel-To-Rudder Interconnect System (WTRIS) General The WTRIS system assists lateral control during manual reversion turns. The WTRIS system provides a small amount of rudder movement in response to control wheel inputs. When engaged, the WTRIS system gives input to the standby PCU. The pilot uses the rudder pedals or the rudder trim control knob to control the rudder. The Yaw Damper and Wheel To Rudder Interconnect System (WTRIS) automatically control the rudder. Manual Operation - Rudder Pedals Authority Limiter The flight crew uses the rudder pedals to control the rudder through the cables and the hydraulic PCUs. The authority limiter reduces the maximum rudder movement. At specified air speeds, the FSEU opens the main rudder PCU authority limiter solenoid valve. This limits hydraulic system A pressure to the PCU, which limits the rudder authority. Manual Operation - Rudder Trim The rudder trim control knob and the trim actuator permit the flight crew to trim out unwanted rudder pedal forces. When the pilots move the rudder trim control knob on the aisle stand, the control sends a signal to the rudder trim actuator. The rudder trim actuator moves the feel and centring unit. This also back drives the rudder pedals. This movement creates an input to the rudder PCU. Rudder PCU movement mechanically moves the rudder. Yaw Damper The yaw damper keeps the airplane stable around the vertical axis. When engaged, the yaw damper system gives input to the main or the standby PCU. During normal operation, the Stall Management Yaw Damp (SMYD) 1 controls yaw damping with the main rudder PCU. During manual reversion, SMYD 2 controls yaw damping with the standby rudder PCU. B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 22 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 23 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ELEVATOR AND TAB CONTROL SYSTEM – GENERAL DESCRIPTION General Elevator Control Cables These are the components of the elevator and tab control system: - Control columns (2) - Elevator forward control quadrants (2) - EA and EB; left and right body cables - Elevator aft control quadrants (2) - Elevator input torque tube - Elevator power control units (2) - Elevator output torque tube - Elevators (2) - Elevator feel computer - Elevator feel and centring unit - Balance panels (6) and tabs (2) - Elevator tab control mechanism - Neutral shift rods (2) The elevator left and right body control cables move the elevator aft control quadrant, which provides an input to the elevator input torque tube. Elevators The elevators attach to the rear spar of the horizontal stabilizer. They control the pitch attitude of the airplane by up or down movement. Elevator Feel and Centring Unit The control columns move the elevator forward quadrant and the elevator control cables Feel force is provided by the feel and centring unit and the dual feel actuator. Inputs to the feel and centring unit are provided by the stabilizer, the flight control computers, and elevator feel computer. The stabilizer inputs go through the elevator neutral shift rods. The flight control computer inputs go through the mach trim actuator. The elevator feel computer inputs go through the dual feel actuator. The dual feel actuator adds a variable feel force to the spring force in the feel and centring unit. Elevator Forward Control Quadrants Elevator Neutral Shift - Stabilizer Input The elevator forward control quadrants connect to the control columns and transmit pilot forces through control cables to the elevator input torque tube. The stabilizer moves two elevator neutral shift rods. The neutral shift rods provide an input to the elevators through the mach trim actuator, the feel and centring unit, and the elevator input torque tube to the PCUs. When the elevator input torque tube moves, it also back drives the control cables which move the control columns to their new neutral position. Control Columns B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 24 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 25 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd HORIZONTAL STABILIZER TRIM CONTROL SYSTEM GENERAL DESCRIPTION Stabilizer Trim Cut-out Switches The pilots control the horizontal stabilizer manually. The autopilot controls it automatically. The pilots use the stabilizer trim cut-out switches to stop the stabilizer trim actuator. Manual Operation - Stabilizer Trim Switches Flaps up Switch The pilots operate two stabilizer trim switches for main electric pitch trim control. The switches are on the outboard side of each control wheel. This gives electric input to the stabilizer trim actuator. The motor operates and drives the gearbox and stabilizer jackscrew. The flap up switch controls the speed of the stabilizer trim actuator. Stabilizer Trim Limit Switches Manual Operation - Stabilizer Trim Wheels The stabilizer trim limit switches limit the range of stabilizer motion. The pilots use the stabilizer trim wheels. The wheels are on each side of the control stand. DFCS Operation The Digital Flight Control System (DFCS) gives electric input to the stabilizer trim actuator. During autopilot operation, the actuator operates the same as during manual electric operation. Column Cut-out Switches The column cut-out switches stop the stabilizer trim when the pilot moves the control column in a direction opposite the trim direction. Stabilizer Trim Override Switch The pilots use the stabilizer trim override switch to bypass the column cutout switches. B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 26 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 27 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd TE FLAP SYSTEM - GENERAL DESCRIPTION General For normal operation of the TE flaps, the flap lever makes the command to the flaps and hydraulic power moves them. If hydraulic power is not available, you can manually select alternate operation. During alternate operation, the alternate flaps switch makes the command to the flaps and electrical power moves them. Normal Operation Hydraulic system B power goes through a priority valve and a flow limiter to the flap control unit. The priority valve gives priority of hydraulic system B power to the LE devices over the TE flaps. The flow limiter limits the speed of movement of the TE flaps. During normal operation, the flap lever makes the commands to the TE flaps to move. The flap lever moves a cable system that supplies a mechanical input to a flap control valve in the flap control unit. The flap control valve sends system B hydraulic power through the bypass valve to the flap Power Drive Unit (PDU). The PDU moves the flap drive system to move the TE flaps. The PDU supplies a mechanical feedback to the flap control valve as the flap drive system moves. The flap PDU also supplies a mechanical input to the slat control valve and the flap limit switches in the flap control unit. Alternate Operation During alternate operation, the alternate flaps switch sends a signal to move the bypass valve to the bypass position. The bypass valve prevents a hydraulic lock on the PDU. The alternate flaps switch also energizes the alternate flap relays. These relays supply electrical power to an electric motor on the flap PDU. The PDU moves the flap drive system to move the TE flaps. B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE TE FLAP SYSTEM INTRODUCTION 28 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 29 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd TE FLAP SYSTEM - FLAP POWER DRIVE UNIT Purpose The TE flap power drive unit (PDU) uses hydraulic or electric power to turn the TE flap torque tubes and the follow-up cables. Location The flap PDU is on the aft bulkhead of the MLG wheel well. Physical Description The flap PDU has these components: - Gearbox - Hydraulic motor - Electric motor The gearbox transfers power from the hydraulic and electric motors to the flap torque tubes. As the torque tubes turn, the gearbox moves the followup cables that attach to the flap control unit. B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 30 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 31 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd LE FLAP AND SLAT CONTROL SYSTEM GENERAL DESCRIPTION The LE flaps and slats use hydraulic power to move. For the normal operation, hydraulic system B supplies hydraulic power. The commands for the LE flaps and slats come from the TE flap system. During the alternate operation, the standby hydraulic system supplies hydraulic power. The commands come from the alternate flaps switches. Normal Operation The TE flap system sends inputs to the LE flap and slat control valve during normal operation. The LE flap and slat control valve sends hydraulic power through the autoslat control valve to the LE flap and slat actuators. These actuators move the LE flaps and slats. The LE flap and slat proximity sensors send signals to the flap/slat electronics unit (FSEU). The FSEU sends this data to the LE devices annunciator panel and the LE flaps lights in the flight deck. If the airplane gets near a stall condition, the Stall Management Yaw Damper (SMYD) computers send signals to the autoslat control valve. The autoslat control valve sends hydraulic power to the LE slat actuators to fully extend the LE slats. Alternate Operation During the alternate operation, the alternate flaps switch sends a signal to the LE standby shutoff valve and to the standby hydraulic system. The LE standby shutoff valve sends hydraulic power to the LE flap and slat actuators to extend the LE flaps and slats. Hydraulic power from the LE standby shutoff valve has priority over the hydraulic power from the LE flap and slat control valve. During the alternate operation, the LE flaps and slats can not retract. B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 32 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 33 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK B737 NG GEN FAM FLYING CONTROLS REFRESHER COURSE 34 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 27-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ATA 28-00-00 FUEL B737 NG GEN FAM FUEL REFRESHER COURSE 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 28-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK B737 NG GEN FAM FUEL REFRESHER COURSE 2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 28-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd CONTENTS ATA 28 – FUEL FUEL STORAGE .................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 4 GENERAL DESCRIPTION .................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 4 FUEL TANK ARRANGEMENT ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 4 COMPONENT LOCATION ......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 4 CAPACITY ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 4 PRESSURE FUELING SYSTEM - GENERAL DESCRIPTION ...................................................................................................................................................................... 6 GENERAL ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 6 CONTROL................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 6 INDICATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 6 PRESSURE FUELING SYSTEM - FUELING PANEL (P15) ............................................................................................................................................................................ 8 GENERAL ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 8 FUELING VALVE OPEN LIGHTS .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 8 FUELING VALVE CONTROL SWITCH ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 8 PRESSURE FUELING SYSTEM – OPERATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................... 8 GENERAL ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 8 ENGINE FUEL FEED - GENERAL DESCRIPTION ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 10 GENERAL .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 10 APU FUEL FEED - GENERAL DESCRIPTION ............................................................................................................................................................................................... 10 GENERAL .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 10 FUEL INDICATING - GENERAL DESCRIPTION ......................................................................................................................................................................................... 12 GENERAL .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 12 OPERATION .......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 12 B737 NG GEN FAM FUEL REFRESHER COURSE 3 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 28-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd FUEL STORAGE GENERAL DESCRIPTION Fuel Tank Arrangement There are three fuel tanks: - Main tank No. 1 - Main tank No. 2 - Centre tank Surge tanks collect fuel overflow only. The fuel overflow in the left wing surge tank drains to main tank number one. The fuel overflow in the right wing surge tank drains to main tank number two. If the fuel level is high enough in the surge tank fuel drains out the vent scoop. Component Location Main tank number one is in the wing box of the left wing. Main tank number two is in the wing box of the right wing. The centre tank is in the fuselage and the left and right wing root. Capacity The nominal capacity of main tank number one is 3,867 kgs. The nominal capacity of main tank number two is 3,867 kgs. The nominal capacity of the centre tank is 12,802 kgs). Fuel tank capacity does not include surge tanks. B737 NG GEN FAM FUEL REFRESHER COURSE 4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 28-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM FUEL REFRESHER COURSE 5 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 28-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd PRESSURE FUELING SYSTEM - GENERAL DESCRIPTION General The three tanks fill from a fuelling station on the right wing. The fuelling station has these components : - Fuelling panel - Fuelling manifold - Fuelling receptacle The fuelling panel controls the pressure fuelling system. Each tank fills from the single fuelling receptacle. The fuelling manifold divides fuel from the fuelling receptacle to the fuelling valves. A float switch removes power to the fuelling valves when the fuel quantity in the tank is full. Control The fuelling station permits automatic and manual control of fuelling valves. The fuelling station receives electrical power from the 28vdc hot battery bus. You use the fuelling indication test switch as an alternative switch to supply power to the fuelling station. An override switch on each fuelling valve allows manual operation. Indication Three valve position lights show that there is power to the fuelling valves. Three fuelling indicators show fuel quantity in each tank. B737 NG GEN FAM FUEL REFRESHER COURSE 6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 28-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM FUEL REFRESHER COURSE 7 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 28-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd PRESSURE FUELING SYSTEM - FUELING PANEL (P15) General The fueling panel (P15) has these components: - Fueling valve open lights - Fueling indication test switch - Fueling valve control switch - Fuel indicators - Fueling power control switch Fueling Valve Open Lights The blue valve position lights come on when the fueling shutoff valve solenoids have power. Fueling Valve Control Switch The fueling valve control switch is a two position switch. In the OPEN position, the switch commands the fueling valve to open. In the CLOSED position, the switch commands the fueling valve to close. PRESSURE FUELING SYSTEM – OPERATION General Fueling placards, with instructions for fueling, are on the fueling station door. Use these placards when fueling the aircraft. The fueling station receives power when the fueling station door opens. B737 NG GEN FAM FUEL REFRESHER COURSE 8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 28-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM FUEL REFRESHER COURSE 9 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 28-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ENGINE FUEL FEED - GENERAL DESCRIPTION General The engine fuel feed system controls and supplies fuel to the engines. It uses these inputs: - Fuel system panel (P5-2) - Engine start switches - Engine fire switches The engine fuel feed system uses these components to supply fuel to the engines: - Centre tank boost pumps - Forward boost pumps - Aft boost pumps - Bypass valve - Cross feed valve - Engine fuel spar valve APU FUEL FEED - GENERAL DESCRIPTION General The APU fuel feed system supplies fuel from any tank to the APU. APU Fuel Feed The centre tank boost pumps or the boost pumps in main tank No. 1 and main tank No. 2 supply fuel to the APU. If the boost pumps are off, the APU suctions fuel from main tank No. 1. B737 NG GEN FAM FUEL REFRESHER COURSE 10 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 28-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM FUEL REFRESHER COURSE 11 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 28-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd FUEL INDICATING - GENERAL DESCRIPTION General The Fuel Quantity Indicating System (FQIS) measures the fuel volume in the fuel tanks. The FQIS also calculates the fuel weight in the fuel tanks. These are the FQIS components: - Fuel quantity processor unit - Tank units - Compensators - Wiring harnesses Operation The fuel quantity processor unit excites and receives signals from the tank units and compensators. The fuel quantity processor unit uses these signals to calculate fuel quantity in each tank. The fuel quantity processer unit sends an individual fuel tank weight signal to the common display system and the refuel panel. The fuel quantity processor unit sends a total fuel weight signal to the flight management computers. B737 NG GEN FAM FUEL REFRESHER COURSE 12 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 28-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM FUEL REFRESHER COURSE 13 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 28-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK B737 NG GEN FAM FUEL REFRESHER COURSE 14 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 28-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ATA 29-00-00 HYDRAULIC POWER B737 NG GEN FAM HYDRAULIC POWER REFRESHER COURSE 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 29-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK B737 NG GEN FAM HYDRAULIC POWER REFRESHER COURSE 2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 29-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd CONTENTS ATA 29 – HYDRAULIC POWER HYDRAULIC POWER - GENERAL DESCRIPTION ...................................................................................................................................................................................... 4 HYDRAULIC SYSTEM A .......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 4 HYDRAULIC SYSTEM B .......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 4 STANDBY HYDRAULIC SYSTEM ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 4 POWER TRANSFER UNIT ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 4 PRESSURIZATION ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 4 MAIN HYDRAULIC SYSTEMS - CONTROLS AND INDICATIONS ........................................................................................................................................................... 6 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 EDP AND EMDP PUMP CONTROLS ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 ENGINE FIRE SWITCHES ......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 TRAINING INFORMATION POINT............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 6 STANDBY HYDRAULIC SYSTEM - CONTROLS AND ................................................................................................................................................................................. 8 INDICATIONS ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 8 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 8 CONTROLS ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 8 INDICATIONS .......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 8 STANDBY HYDRAULIC SYSTEM ................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 10 PHYSICAL DESCRIPTION ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 10 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 10 FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION.................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 10 STANDBY HYDRAULIC SYSTEM PUMP ..................................................................................................................................................................................................... 10 PHYSICAL DESCRIPTION ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 10 MAIN HYDRAULIC SYSTEMS - GROUND SERVICING SYSTEM .......................................................................................................................................................... 12 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 12 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 12 PHYSICAL DESCRIPTION ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 12 OPERATION .......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 12 B737 NG GEN FAM HYDRAULIC POWER REFRESHER COURSE 3 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 29-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd HYDRAULIC POWER - GENERAL DESCRIPTION Hydraulic System A Standby Hydraulic System Hydraulic system A supplies pressure to these airplane systems: The standby hydraulic system supplies alternative hydraulic pressure to these airplane systems: - Standby rudder - Both thrust reversers - Leading edge flaps and slats - Aileron - Autopilot A - Elevator - Rudder - Elevator feel - Flight spoilers - Ground spoilers - Left thrust reverser - Alternate brakes - Nose wheel steering - Landing gear extension and retraction - Power transfer unit motor Power Transfer Unit The Power Transfer Unit (PTU) is a hydraulic motor-pump that supplies alternative pressure to leading edge flaps and slats. Pressurization Air pressure from the reservoir pressurization system maintains head pressure on hydraulic system A, system B, and the standby hydraulic system reservoirs. The pressurized reservoirs supply a constant flow of fluid to the hydraulic pumps. Hydraulic System B Hydraulic system B supplies pressure to these airplane systems: - Aileron - Autopilot B - Elevator - Rudder - Elevator feel - Flight spoilers - Right thrust reverser - Normal brakes - Alternate nose wheel steering - Alternate landing gear retraction - Trailing edge flaps - Leading edge flaps and slats B737 NG GEN FAM HYDRAULIC POWER REFRESHER COURSE 4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 29-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM HYDRAULIC POWER REFRESHER COURSE 5 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 29-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd MAIN HYDRAULIC SYSTEMS - CONTROLS AND INDICATIONS General The controls for the main hydraulic system pumps are on the hydraulic panel. This panel is on the P5 forward overhead panel. The engine fire switches on the P8 aft electronics panel control the fluid supply to the EDPs. EDP and EMDP Pump Controls The EDP and the EMDP each have a switch on the hydraulic panel. The switches have two positions, ON and OFF. The ENG 1 hydraulic pump switch controls the EDP for system A. The ELEC 2 hydraulic pump switch controls the EMDP for system A The ENG 2 switch controls the EDP for system B. The ELEC 1 switch controls the EMDP for system B. There is an amber low pressure light for each pump above each pump switch. Each EMDP also has an amber overheat light above the switch. Engine Fire Switches The engine fire switches isolate the engine if there is an engine fire. When you operate one of the fire switches, the pump low pressure light is disarmed and the hydraulic fluid supply to the related EDP stops. Training Information Point Because the EDP depressurization solenoid gets electrical power when the EDP control switch is OFF, you normally keep the switch in the ON position. While you do maintenance, if the switch is in the OFF position for a long time, you should open the circuit breaker for the EDP solenoid. B737 NG GEN FAM HYDRAULIC POWER REFRESHER COURSE 6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 29-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM HYDRAULIC POWER REFRESHER COURSE 7 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 29-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd STANDBY HYDRAULIC SYSTEM CONTROLS AND INDICATIONS General The controls and indications for the standby hydraulic system are on the flight control panel. The flight control panel is on the P5 forward overhead panel in the flight compartment. Controls These switches operate components in the standby hydraulic system: - FLT CONTROL A and B switches - ALTERNATE FLAPS arming switch Move one of the two FLT CONTROL A or B switches to the STBY RUD position to start the standby hydraulic system EMDP and open the standby rudder shutoff valve in the standby system module. Move the ALTERNATE FLAPS arming switch to the ARM position to start the standby hydraulic system EMDP. Indications There are two caution indications on the flight control panel for the standby hydraulic system: - Standby hydraulic low quantity light. - Standby hydraulic low pressure light. B737 NG GEN FAM HYDRAULIC POWER REFRESHER COURSE 8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 29-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM HYDRAULIC POWER REFRESHER COURSE 9 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 29-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd STANDBY HYDRAULIC SYSTEM Physical Description The standby hydraulic system reservoir supplies hydraulic fluid under pressure to the standby hydraulic system EMDP. The EMDP has an electric motor that mechanically connects to a hydraulic pump. The standby hydraulic system EMDP is in the right aft wing to body fairing, inboard of the brake accumulator. Physical Description The standby hydraulic system reservoir contains 3.6 gallons (13.3 liters) of hydraulic fluid. Location The standby hydraulic system reservoir is on the keel beam in the main landing gear wheel well. Functional Description The fill connection permits fluid servicing from the ground servicing system to the standby and system B reservoirs. The fill and balance connection connects the standby reservoir to the hydraulic system B reservoir. The fill and balance line does these functions: - Overfill from the servicing system to the system B reservoir - Thermal expansion of the standby hydraulic system reservoir - Supply pressure from the hydraulic system B reservoir STANDBY HYDRAULIC SYSTEM PUMP The standby hydraulic system electric motor-driven pump (EMDP) supplies hydraulic pressure to the standby hydraulic system. B737 NG GEN FAM HYDRAULIC POWER REFRESHER COURSE 10 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 29-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM HYDRAULIC POWER REFRESHER COURSE 11 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 29-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd MAIN HYDRAULIC SYSTEMS - GROUND SERVICING SYSTEM General The ground servicing system fills all hydraulic reservoirs from one central location. Location The system components are in the right main gear wheel well on the lower outboard area of the forward bulkhead. Physical Description These are the hydraulic servicing components: - Fill selector valve - Fill filter module - Manual fill pump - Pressure fill connection Operation You set the three position fill selector valve to send hydraulic fluid to the system A or the system B and standby reservoirs. Move the valve to the closed position after servicing. The fill filter module cleans the fluid that goes into the hydraulic systems. The manual fill pump lets you fill the hydraulic system reservoirs manually. You use the manual pump suction hose during the manual fill operation. One end of the hose connects to the manual fill pump. The other end of the hose goes in the hydraulic fluid container. When not in use, you put the end of the suction hose in a protective cover. B737 NG GEN FAM HYDRAULIC POWER REFRESHER COURSE 12 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 29-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM HYDRAULIC POWER REFRESHER COURSE 13 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 29-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK B737 NG GEN FAM HYDRAULIC POWER REFRESHER COURSE 14 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 29-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ATA 30-00-00 ICE AND RAIN B737 NG GEN FAM ICE AND RAIN REFRESHER COURSE 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 30-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK B737 NG GEN FAM ICE AND RAIN REFRESHER COURSE 2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 30-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd CONTENTS ATA 30 – ICE AND RAIN ICE AND RAIN PROTECTION - GENERAL DESCRIPTION ....................................................................................................................................................................... 4 CONTROL PANEL ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 4 WING AND ENGINE THERMAL ANTI-ICE SYSTEMS ................................................................................................................................................................................................ 4 PROBE HEAT .......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 4 FLIGHT DECK WINDOWS ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 4 DRAIN AND WATER LINE HEATING........................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 4 WING THERMAL ANTI-ICING SYSTEM – INTRODUCTION .................................................................................................................................................................... 6 PURPOSE ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 6 GENERAL DESCRIPTION ......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 PITOT AND STATIC – INTRODUCTION ......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 8 PURPOSE ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 8 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 8 CONTROL CABIN WINDOW ANTI-ICING SYSTEM -INTRODUCTION ............................................................................................................................................... 10 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 10 GENERAL DESCRIPTION ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 10 B737 NG GEN FAM ICE AND RAIN REFRESHER COURSE 3 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 30-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ICE AND RAIN PROTECTION - GENERAL DESCRIPTION Drain and Water line Heating Control Panel Electric heaters prevent freezing in the water and waste systems components. The controls and indications for the ice and rain protection system are on the P-5 panel. Wing and Engine Thermal Anti-ice Systems The wing thermal anti-ice and the engine inlet cowl thermal anti-ice systems use hot engine bleed air to prevent ice formation. Probe Heat The air data probes use electric heat to prevent ice. Flight Deck Windows Flight deck windows use electric heat to do these things: - Prevent ice formation on the windows - Prevent fog on the windows - Improve windshield impact strength The windshields have these features to improve forward vision in heavy rain: - Windshield wipers - Hydrophobic (rain repellent) coatings B737 NG GEN FAM ICE AND RAIN REFRESHER COURSE 4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 30-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM ICE AND RAIN REFRESHER COURSE 5 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 30-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd WING THERMAL ANTI-ICING SYSTEM – INTRODUCTION Purpose The Wing Thermal Anti-Ice system (WTAI) keeps ice from forming on the leading edge of the wing. General Description The WTAI system uses hot air from the pneumatic system to heat the 3 inboard leading edge slats of the wing. Switches in the flight deck control the operation of the WTAI system. The WTAI system may operate in flight or on the ground. The controls and indicators are on the P-5 panel. B737 NG GEN FAM ICE AND RAIN REFRESHER COURSE 6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 30-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM ICE AND RAIN REFRESHER COURSE 7 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 30-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd PITOT AND STATIC – INTRODUCTION Purpose The pitot and static anti-icing system keeps ice off the air data probes. This prevents false air data signals that ice causes. General The air data probes use electric power for heat. The probes have integral heaters. The pitot and static anti-icing system supplies heat to these probes: - Alpha vanes (2) - Total air temperature probe (1) - Pitot probes (5) The static system sense ports are not part of the probe heat system. These ports are flush with the fuselage and heat is not necessary. You control the air data probe heat from the control module on the P-5 panel. B737 NG GEN FAM ICE AND RAIN REFRESHER COURSE 8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 30-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM ICE AND RAIN REFRESHER COURSE 9 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 30-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd CONTROL CABIN WINDOW ANTI-ICING SYSTEM -INTRODUCTION Purpose The control cabin window anti-icing system improves window impact strength and prevents ice formation on the flight compartment windows. General Description The control cabin anti-icing system uses electrical power to heat the flight compartment windows. The controls and indications for the control cabin window anti-icing system are on the P5-9 panel. Window heat control units (WHCUs) are part of the control cabin window ant-icing system. B737 NG GEN FAM ICE AND RAIN REFRESHER COURSE 10 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 30-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM ICE AND RAIN REFRESHER COURSE 11 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 30-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK B737 NG GEN FAM ICE AND RAIN REFRESHER COURSE 12 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 30-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ATA 31-00-00 INDICATING & RECORDING B737 NG GEN FAM INDICATING & RECORDING REFRESHER COURSE 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 31-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK B737 NG GEN FAM INDICATING & RECORDING REFRESHER COURSE 2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 31-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd CONTENTS ATA 31 – INDICATING AND RECORDING CDS - FLIGHT COMPARTMENT COMPONENT LOCATIONS .................................................................................................................................................................. 4 COMPONENT LOCATION ......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 4 DISPLAY UNITS ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 4 CDS - ENGINE DISPLAY – INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................................................................................................. 6 ENGINE DISPLAY ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 MASTER CAUTION SYSTEM - COMPONENT LOCATION ........................................................................................................................................................................ 8 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 8 MASTER CAUTION SYSTEM COMPONENTS ............................................................................................................................................................................................................ 8 INPUT COMPONENTS .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 8 MASTER CAUTION SYSTEM – INTERFACES ............................................................................................................................................................................................. 10 CONTROL OF THE SYSTEM ANNUNCIATOR LIGHTS .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 10 RESETS................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 10 AURAL WARNING SYSTEM - GENERAL DESCRIPTION ........................................................................................................................................................................ 12 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 12 TAKEOFF AND LANDING WARNINGS – OPERATION ............................................................................................................................................................................ 14 TAKEOFF .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 14 B737 NG GEN FAM INDICATING & RECORDING REFRESHER COURSE 3 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 31-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd CDS - FLIGHT COMPARTMENT COMPONENT LOCATIONS Component location These are the CDS components in the flight compartment: - Left outboard DU - Left inboard DU - Right outboard DU - Right inboard DU - Upper centre DU - Lower centre DU - Captain's EFIS control panel - First Officer's EFIS control panel - Captain's display select panel - First Officer's display select panel - Engine display control panel - Left remote light sensor - Right remote light sensor - Captain's brightness controls - First Officer's brightness controls - Display source selectors DISPLAY UNITS The common display system uses six identical flat panel Liquid Crystal Display (LCD) units. The Display Units (DU’s) show this type of information: - Primary flight information - Navigation information - Engine information B737 NG GEN FAM INDICATING & RECORDING REFRESHER COURSE 4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 31-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM INDICATING & RECORDING REFRESHER COURSE 5 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 31-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd CDS - ENGINE DISPLAY – INTRODUCTION Engine Display The engine display shows engine data. These are the major indications that show: - Autothrottle limit message, thrust mode and TAT - N1 - EGT - N2 - Fuel flow/fuel used, and fuel quantity - Crew alert messages - Oil pressure, temperature and quantity - Engine vibration B737 NG GEN FAM INDICATING & RECORDING REFRESHER COURSE 6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 31-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM INDICATING & RECORDING REFRESHER COURSE 7 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 31-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd MASTER CAUTION SYSTEM - COMPONENT LOCATION General The overheat/fire protection panel is on the P8 aft electronic panel. The components for the master caution system are in the flight compartment. Master Caution System Components These are the master caution system components on the P7 glareshield panel: - Master caution lights - Left system annunciator lights - Right system annunciator lights Input Components Many systems provide discrete inputs to the master caution system. These are the components on the P5 aft overhead panel: - IRS mode select unit - Engine panel - Flight recorder/Mach airspeed warning panel These are the components on the P5 forward overhead panel: - Flight control panel - Fuel control panel - Generator drive and standby power panel - APU indicator panel - Window heat panel - Probe heat panel - Hydraulic panel - System annunciators - Air conditioning/bleed air controls panel B737 NG GEN FAM INDICATING & RECORDING REFRESHER COURSE 8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 31-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM INDICATING & RECORDING REFRESHER COURSE 9 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 31-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd MASTER CAUTION SYSTEM – INTERFACES Control of the System Annunciator Lights The control of the left system annunciator lights come from these components: - Flight control panel (FLT CONT) - IRS master caution unit (IRS) - Flight control panel (FUEL) - Generator drive and standby power panel (ELEC) - APU indicator panel (APU) - Overheat/fire protection panel (OVHT/DET) The control of the right system annunciator lights come from these components: - Window heat panel (ANTI-ICE) - Hydraulic panel (HYD) - System annunciators (DOORS) - Engine panel (ENG) - Flight recorder/Mach airspeed warning panel (OVERHEAD) - Air conditioning/bleed air control panel (AIR COND) Resets When you push the master caution light, you remove power to all the master caution circuits. This causes the circuits to reset the master caution annunciation. If a fault condition remains, the component warning light remains on. When you push the system annunciator lights, the recall signal goes to all the components which cause the system annunciator lights to come on. All the lights in the system annunciator come on while you push the lights. When you release the lights, the system annunciator lights show which systems have faults. B737 NG GEN FAM INDICATING & RECORDING REFRESHER COURSE 10 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 31-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd MASTER CAUTION INTERFACES B737 NG GEN FAM INDICATING & RECORDING REFRESHER COURSE 11 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 31-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd AURAL WARNING SYSTEM - GENERAL DESCRIPTION General The aural warning module is the only component in aural warning system. System monitor circuits detect incorrect system conditions and flight crew alerts. The monitor circuits supply discrete signals to the aural warning module. These are the discrete inputs to the aural warning system: - Unsafe landing warning - Unsafe takeoff warning - Cabin pressure warning - Autopilot disengage - Overspeed warning - Fire warning - SELCAL - Crew call The aural warning module gives these sounds in the flight compartment: - Fire bells - Chimes - Overspeed clackers - Wailer - Continuous horn - Intermittent horn B737 NG GEN FAM INDICATING & RECORDING REFRESHER COURSE 12 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 31-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM INDICATING & RECORDING REFRESHER COURSE 13 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 31-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd TAKEOFF AND LANDING WARNINGS – OPERATION Functional Description The takeoff warning function is in the Proximity Switch Electronics Unit (PSEU). The aural warning module gives the sound of an intermittent horn for a takeoff warning. Takeoff The airplane must be on the ground and you must move either thrust lever to takeoff power (thrust resolver angle more than 53 degrees) before the aural warning system gives the takeoff warning sound. The takeoff warning occurs if any of these conditions occur: - The stabilizer is out of the green band - The TE flaps are not in a takeoff position - The TE flaps are in a skew or asymmetry condition - The TE flaps have an Uncommanded Motion (UCM) - The LE flaps and slats are not extended - The LE flaps and slats have an Uncommanded Motion (UCM) - The ground spoilers have pressure - The speedbrake lever is not down - The parking brake is set B737 NG GEN FAM INDICATING & RECORDING REFRESHER COURSE 14 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 31-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM INDICATING & RECORDING REFRESHER COURSE 15 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 31-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK B737 NG GEN FAM INDICATING & RECORDING REFRESHER COURSE 16 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 31-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ATA 32-00-00 LANDING GEAR B737 NG GEN FAM LANDING GEAR REFRESHER COURSE 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 32-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd CONTENTS ATA 32 – LANDING GEAR MAIN / NOSE LANDING GEAR AND DOORS – INTRODUCTION ............................................................................................................................................................. 4 PURPOSE (MAIN LANDING GEAR) ......................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 4 MAIN LANDING GEAR ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 4 MAIN LANDING GEAR SHOCK STRUT DOORS ........................................................................................................................................................................................................ 4 TRAINING INFORMATION POINT............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 4 PURPOSE (NOSE LANDING GEAR) .......................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 4 NOSE LANDING GEAR ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 4 NOSE LANDING GEAR DOORS................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 4 LANDING GEAR CONTROL SYSTEM - LEVER ASSEMBLY ..................................................................................................................................................................... 6 PURPOSE ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 6 PHYSICAL DESCRIPTION ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 6 LOCATION .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 6 FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION.................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 HYDRAULIC BRAKE SYSTEM - BRAKE ASSEMBLY ................................................................................................................................................................................. 8 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 8 PHYSICAL DESCRIPTION ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 8 PARKING BRAKE SYSTEM – LINKAGE ....................................................................................................................................................................................................... 10 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 10 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 10 FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION.................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 10 ANTISKID/AUTOBRAKE SYSTEM - ANTISKID GENERAL DESCRIPTION ........................................................................................................................................ 12 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 12 ANTISKID VALVES ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 12 TRANSDUCER ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 12 B737 NG GEN FAM LANDING GEAR REFRESHER COURSE 2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 32-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd LANDING GEAR - DOWNLOCK PIN - MAIN LANDING GEAR ............................................................................................................................................................... 14 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 14 LANDING GEAR - DOWNLOCK PIN - NOSE LANDING GEAR ............................................................................................................................................................... 16 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 16 NOSE WHEEL STEERING SYSTEM - GENERAL DESCRIPTION ........................................................................................................................................................... 18 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 18 GENERAL DESCRIPTION ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 18 NOSE WHEEL STEERING SYSTEM - STEERING METERING VALVE MODULE .............................................................................................................................. 20 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 20 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 20 PHYSICAL DESCRIPTION ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 20 B737 NG GEN FAM LANDING GEAR REFRESHER COURSE 3 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 32-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd MAIN / NOSE LANDING GEAR AND DOORS – INTRODUCTION Training Information Point Purpose (Main Landing Gear) Be careful when you move around the inner door. The sharp point on the inner door can cause injury to persons. The two Main Landing Gear (MLG) absorb landing forces and hold most of the airplane weight when the airplane makes a landing. The main landing gear also transmits the braking forces to the airplane structure. These are the landing gear structural systems: Purpose (Nose Landing Gear) - The main landing gear (MLG) and doors - The nose landing gear (NLG) and doors The nose landing gear absorbs landing forces and holds the forward part of the airplane weight when the airplane makes a landing. The nose landing gear doors open to permit gear operation. They close to aerodynamically seal the nose landing gear wheel well. The landing gear extension and retraction systems extend and retract the landing gear. Nose Landing Gear Main Landing Gear Each main landing gear has two wheels. The side strut holds the main landing gear in the extended position. The side strut has an upper and a lower part. A downlock strut moves to an over-centre position to lock the main landing gear in the down position. A jack pad is on the bottom of the shock strut. The jack pad permits the inner cylinder to be moved up for wheel and tire replacement. The nose landing gear is a conventional two wheel gear. A drag strut holds the nose gear in the extended or retracted position. The drag strut has a upper and lower part. A lock link moves to an over-centre position to lock the drag strut in both up and down positions. A tow fitting is between the nose landing gear tires. A jack pad is on the bottom of the shock strut. You can disconnect the torsion links to permit the nose landing gear to move more than the normal steering limits (78 degrees). Main Landing Gear Shock Strut Doors Nose Landing Gear Doors The MLG shock strut doors open to let the main landing gear extend and retract. The doors aerodynamically seal the opening in the lower surface of the wing and the wing to body fairing. There are no wheel well doors. The outboard surface of the outboard wheels operates as aerodynamic covers for the main gear wheel well when the main landing gear retracts. The wheel well seal system supplies an aerodynamic seal around the outboard tire. Two doors aerodynamically seal the nose landing gear wheel well to decrease drag. The doors attach to the outboard edges of the nose landing gear wheel well. The doors connect to the shock strut and move mechanically when the nose landing gear extends or retracts. B737 NG GEN FAM LANDING GEAR REFRESHER COURSE 4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 32-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM LANDING GEAR REFRESHER COURSE 5 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 32-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd LANDING GEAR CONTROL SYSTEM - LEVER ASSEMBLY When the airplane takes off, the solenoid gets electrical power and releases the lever lock. Purpose The landing gear control lever assembly operates the landing gear selector valve through the landing gear control cables. Physical Description The control lever assembly has these components: - Control lever - Position switch (4) - Lock mechanism - Lever lock solenoid Location The landing gear control lever is on the P2 centre forward panel in the flight compartment. Functional Description The landing gear control lever has these three positions with detents: - UP - OFF - DOWN You must first pull the control lever out before you can move the lever. The lever operates a push-pull cable which moves the forward quadrant. The forward quadrant is below the flight compartment floor. The control lever assembly has a lever lock mechanism operated by a lever lock solenoid. The lever lock prevents accidental movement of the landing gear lever to the up position when the airplane is on the ground. B737 NG GEN FAM LANDING GEAR REFRESHER COURSE 6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 32-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM LANDING GEAR REFRESHER COURSE 7 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 32-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd HYDRAULIC BRAKE SYSTEM - BRAKE ASSEMBLY General A torque takeout slot on the brake assembly aligns with a torque pin on the bottom of the main landing gear inner cylinder. The main landing gear wheel brakes use hydraulic pressure to slow or stop the airplane during landing and taxi. Each main landing gear wheel brake has these components: The slot and pin transmit brake torque to the main landing gear strut. - Stators· Rotors - Pressure plate - Piston/adjusters (6) - Axle bushings - Wear indicator pins (2) - Brake hose connection/hydraulic bleed port Physical Description The brake assembly is a rotor-stator unit that operates using hydraulic pressure. The assembly uses multiple steel discs as rotors and stators. Piston/adjuster assemblies apply brake system hydraulic pressure to the pressure plate. The pressure plate forces the stators and rotors together in the brake housing. This slows or stops the wheel. The pistons automatically adjust for brake wear. Two indicator pins on the inboard side of the brake housing show brake wear. You must apply the brakes to check the wear indicator pins. The brake assembly has bushings. These bushings attach to replaceable sleeves on the landing gear axle. A retention cable connects both brakes together on each main landing gear. The cable keeps the brake on the axle if the wheel falls off the airplane. B737 NG GEN FAM LANDING GEAR REFRESHER COURSE 8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 32-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM LANDING GEAR REFRESHER COURSE 9 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 32-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd PARKING BRAKE SYSTEM – LINKAGE Purpose The parking brake linkage mechanically locks the brake pedals in the applied position. These are the parking brake linkage components: - Parking brake lever - Parking brake switch - Latch pawls (2) - Return spring Location The parking brake linkage is in the forward equipment compartment below the captains brake pedals. The parking brake switch is on the parking brake linkage. Functional Description When you push the brake pedals and pull the parking brake lever up, these things occur: - The brake pedals move the vertical control rods down - The vertical control rods move the pawl stop down - The parking brake lever moves the linkage and the bellcrank - The bellcrank turns the latch pawl - The latch pawl holds the pawl stop down when the brake pedals are released - The parking brake switch moves to the closed position - You can then release the parking brake lever - This keeps the captains and first officers brake pedals in the applied position. To release the parking brakes, momentarily push on the brake pedals. This moves the pawl stop down and the return spring turns the latch pawl. When you release the pedals, the pedals move to the brakes off position. B737 NG GEN FAM LANDING GEAR REFRESHER COURSE 10 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 32-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM LANDING GEAR REFRESHER COURSE 11 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 32-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ANTISKID/AUTOBRAKE SYSTEM - ANTISKID GENERAL DESCRIPTION Purpose The antiskid system controls the metered brake pressure from the hydraulic brake system or the autobrake pressure from the autobrake system to prevent wheel skid. This gives maximum brake force to stop the airplane with any runway condition. These are the antiskid components: - Antiskid valves (6) - Transducers (4) - Landing gear lever up switch - Alternate brake pressure switch - Antiskid/Autobrake Control Unit (AACU) - Antiskid inoperative amber light Antiskid Valves Four antiskid valves in the normal hydraulic brake system control brake pressure to each wheel brake. Two antiskid valves in the alternate hydraulic brake system control brake pressure to the wheel brakes on each main landing gear. Transducer A transducer in each main landing gear wheel axle supplies wheel speed data to the AACU. B737 NG GEN FAM LANDING GEAR REFRESHER COURSE 12 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 32-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM LANDING GEAR REFRESHER COURSE 13 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 32-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd LANDING GEAR - DOWNLOCK PIN - MAIN LANDING GEAR General You install a downlock pin into the main landing gear to make sure an outside force does not unlock the main landing gear. There is one main landing gear downlock pin for each main landing gear. The downlock pin installs in the MLG downlock strut. WARNING: YOU MUST CAREFULLY INSTALL THE GROUND LOCKS IN ALL LANDING GEAR. AN ACCIDENTAL RETRACTION OF THE LANDING GEAR CAN CAUSE INJURY TO PERSONS AND DAMAGE TO EQUIPMENT. B737 NG GEN FAM LANDING GEAR REFRESHER COURSE 14 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 32-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM LANDING GEAR REFRESHER COURSE 15 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 32-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd LANDING GEAR - DOWNLOCK PIN - NOSE LANDING GEAR General You install a downlock pin into the nose landing gear to make sure an outside force does not unlock the nose landing gear. There is one nose landing gear downlock pin for the nose landing gear. The nose landing gear downlock pin installs in the NLG downlock pin hole. WARNING: YOU MUST CAREFULLY INSTALL THE GROUND LOCKS IN ALL LANDING GEAR. AN ACCIDENTAL RETRACTION OF THE LANDING GEAR CAN CAUSE INJURY TO PERSONS AND DAMAGE TO EQUIPMENT. B737 NG GEN FAM LANDING GEAR REFRESHER COURSE 16 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 32-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM LANDING GEAR REFRESHER COURSE 17 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 32-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd NOSE WHEEL STEERING SYSTEM - GENERAL DESCRIPTION Purpose The landing gear transfer valve changes the pressure supply of nose wheel steering from hydraulic system A to hydraulic system B. You manually control the landing gear transfer valve with the alternate nose wheel steering switch in the flight compartment. The nose wheel steering system supplies the ground directional control of the airplane. General Description These conditions cause the manual operation of the landing gear transfer valve: Steering inputs are from the steering wheel or the rudder pedals. When you move the steering wheel full travel, the nose wheels turn a maximum of 78 degrees in the left or right direction. When you move the rudder pedals full travel on the ground, the nose wheels turn a maximum of 7 degrees in the left or right direction. Steering inputs from the steering wheel or rudder pedals go to the metering valve through a cable loop. * Alternate nose wheel steering switch to the alternate position * Normal quantity in system B reservoir * Nose air/ground system in ground mode. The steering metering valve supplies right turn or left turn pressure to the steering actuators. The rotary actuator disconnects the rudder pedal input in the air. CAUTION: DO NOT OPERATE THE STEERING WHEEL WITH THE SHOCK STRUT FULLY EXTENDED AND THE TORSION LINKS CONNECTED. DAMAGE TO THE CENTERING CAMS OF THE SHOCK STRUT CAN OCCUR. IF IT IS NECESSARY TO OPERATE THE STEERING SYSTEM, MAKE SURE THAT YOU COMPRESS THE SHOCK STRUT TO 2.10 INCHES OR MORE. MAKE SURE THAT THE DISTANCE BETWEEN THE BOTTOM SURFACE OF THE LOWER STEERING PLATE AND THE TOP SURFACE OF THE TOWING LUG IS LESS THAN 21.90 INCHES. Hydraulic system A usually supplies pressure to extend and retract the main landing gear. The extend pressure from the landing gear extension and retraction system supplies pressure for nose wheel steering. B737 NG GEN FAM LANDING GEAR REFRESHER COURSE 18 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 32-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM LANDING GEAR REFRESHER COURSE 19 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 32-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd NOSE WHEEL STEERING SYSTEM - STEERING METERING VALVE MODULE General The steering metering valve module controls the flow of hydraulic pressure to the steering actuators. Location The steering metering valve is on the upper steering plate on the front of the nose landing gear. Physical Description A towing lever on the steering metering valve module controls a towing shutoff valve. The towing lever lets you depressurize the nose wheel steering system. Because of this, you do not have to depressurize hydraulic system A to tow the airplane. B737 NG GEN FAM LANDING GEAR REFRESHER COURSE 20 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 32-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM LANDING GEAR REFRESHER COURSE 21 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 32-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK B737 NG GEN FAM LANDING GEAR REFRESHER COURSE 22 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 32-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ATA 36-00-00 PNEUMATICS B737 NG GEN FAM PNEUMATICS REFRESHER COURSE 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 36-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK B737 NG GEN FAM PNEUMATICS REFRESHER COURSE 2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 36-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd CONTENTS ATA 36 – PNEUMATICS PNEUMATIC – INTRODUCTION ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 4 PURPOSE ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 4 GENERAL DESCRIPTION ......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 4 PNEUMATIC - FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION ............................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 ENGINE BLEED AIR ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 6 ENGINE BLEED AIR PRECOOLER SYSTEM .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 6 APU BLEED AIR .................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 PNEUMATIC MANIFOLD ......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 B737 NG GEN FAM PNEUMATICS REFRESHER COURSE 3 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 36-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd PNEUMATIC – INTRODUCTION Purpose The pneumatic system supplies compressed air to the airplane user systems. The controls and indications use these types of electric power: General Description - 28vdc - 115vac These are the sources of pneumatic power: CAUTION: The air in the pneumatic system is hot and under great pressure. Make sure you depressurize the pneumatic system before you work on it. - Engine 1 bleed air system - Engine 2 bleed air system - Auxiliary Power Unit (APU) bleed air system - Pneumatic ground air connection The pneumatic manifold collects the compressed air from the sources and supplies it to the user systems. Valves in the manifold do these things: - Control the flow of bleed air into the manifold - Isolate the manifold into left and right sides - Control the flow of manifold air into the user systems These are the airplane systems that use pneumatic power: - Engine start systems - Air conditioning and pressurization systems - Engine inlet cowl anti-ice systems - Wing thermal anti-ice systems - Water tank pressurization system - Hydraulic reservoir pressurization system The pneumatic system controls and indications are on the P5-10 panel. B737 NG GEN FAM PNEUMATICS REFRESHER COURSE 4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 36-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM PNEUMATICS REFRESHER COURSE 5 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 36-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd PNEUMATIC - FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION General Engine Bleed Air Precooler System The pneumatic system supplies hot, high pressure air to the systems on the airplane that use air. These are the sources of pneumatic power: The precooler system controls the engine bleed air temperature. The precooler system cools the engine bleed air with engine fan air. The precooler system operation is automatic and uses pneumatic control. APU Bleed Air - Engine bleed air - APU load compressor - Ground source The APU load compressor supplies compressed air to the pneumatic manifold. The load compressor inlet guide vane and surge valve systems control the flow and pressure of the air. The APU Bleed Air Valve (BAV) controls the flow of air from the load compressor to the pneumatic manifold. The APU BAV operates from pneumatic pressure. It gets electrical control from the APU ECU. The APU ECU gets signals from these sources: Engine Bleed Air There is one bleed air system for each engine. The engine bleed system controls bleed air temperature and pressure. Engine bleed air comes from the 5th and 9th stages of the high pressure compressor. A high stage valve system controls the flow of 9th stage bleed air. The high stage system is pneumatic and has no electric controls. The Pressure Regulator and Shutoff Valve (PRSOV) controls the flow and pressure of the engine bleed air. Control pressure from the Bleed Air Regulator (BAR) operates the PRSOV. The Air Conditioning Accessory Unit (ACAU) electrically controls the BAR. The ACAU receives signals from these components: - The P5-10 APU BLEED switch - APU sensors and switches - Airplane logic Pneumatic Manifold The pneumatic manifold gets high pressure air from the source systems and supplies it to the user systems. The pneumatic manifold has these features: - P8-1 fire control panel engine FIRE switch - P5-10 air conditioning panel engine BLEED switch - 490F (254C) over temperature and 220 psi overpressure switches (BLEED TRIP OFF protection) - The Display Electronics Unit (DEU) (engine start reverse flow protection) B737 NG GEN FAM PNEUMATICS REFRESHER COURSE - An isolation valve that can separate the manifold into left and right sides - Two duct pressure transmitters (for left and right manifold pressure indication) - A ground pneumatic connector with a check valve (for an external source of pneumatic power) - Pressure taps and interfaces for user system valves. 6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 36-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM PNEUMATICS REFRESHER COURSE 7 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 36-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK B737 NG GEN FAM PNEUMATICS REFRESHER COURSE 8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 36-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ATA 49-00-00 APU B737 NG GEN FAM APU REFRESHER COURSE 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 49-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK B737 NG GEN FAM APU REFRESHER COURSE 2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 49-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd CONTENTS ATA 49 – APU AIRBORNE AUXILIARY POWER – INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................................................................................. 4 PURPOSE ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 4 ALTITUDE OPERATIONAL LIMITS........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 4 APU ENGINE – INTRODUCTION ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 PURPOSE ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 6 GENERAL DESCRIPTION ......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 AIRBORNE AUXILIARY POWER - APU COOLING ..................................................................................................................................................................................... 8 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 8 COMPARTMENT COOLING ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 8 MISCELLANEOUS EXTERIOR SERVICE DOORS – APU ACCESS DOOR ............................................................................................................................................ 10 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 10 DOOR FRAME AND STRUCTURE ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 10 HINGES ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 10 LATCHES .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 10 DOOR SUPPORT RODS .......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 10 FLUID DRAIN SYSTEM ......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 10 LOWER APU FIRE DETECTION ELEMENT ............................................................................................................................................................................................................ 10 APU POWER PLANT - AIR INLET DOOR COMPONENTS ....................................................................................................................................................................... 12 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 12 AIR INLET DOOR ACTUATOR ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 12 AIR INLET DOOR SWITCH .................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 12 TRAINING INFORMATION POINT........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 12 APU CONTROLS – INTRODUCTION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 14 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 14 FLIGHT COMPARTMENT CONTROLS AND PANELS ................................................................................................................................................................................................ 14 OTHER CONTROL COMPONENTS .......................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 14 B737 NG GEN FAM APU REFRESHER COURSE 3 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 49-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd AIRBORNE AUXILIARY POWER – INTRODUCTION Purpose The AlliedSignal 131-9(B) Auxiliary Power Unit (APU) supplies electrical and pneumatic power to other airplane systems. This permits airplane systems to operate without the use of ground power sources or the engines. The APU can also supply electrical and pneumatic power in the air. Altitude Operational Limits The APU generator can supply 90 KVA electrical power up to 32,000 feet (9,754 meters) and 66 KVA to 41,000 feet (12,500 meters). Electrical and pneumatic power is available at the same time up to 10,000 feet (3,048 meters). Pneumatic power alone is available up to 17,000 feet (5,183 meters). The APU can be started at 41,000 feet or below. B737 NG GEN FAM APU REFRESHER COURSE 4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 49-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM APU REFRESHER COURSE 5 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 49-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd APU ENGINE – INTRODUCTION Purpose The APU engine supplies power to operate the load compressor and the APU starter-generator. General Description The APU engine has these main sections: - Accessory gear box - Single stage load compressor - Single stage engine compressor - Combustor chamber - Two stage axial flow turbine All the components in the engine that turn are on a common shaft. The shaft turns the accessory gearbox and the load compressor. The accessory gear box turns the APU generator and other components. The engine operates at a constant speed to provide 400 Hz generator output. The APU engine also supplies air for airplane systems. An inlet screen prevents Foreign Object Damage (FOD) to the APU compressors. B737 NG GEN FAM APU REFRESHER COURSE 6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 49-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM APU REFRESHER COURSE 7 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 49-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd AIRBORNE AUXILIARY POWER - APU COOLING General The APU cooling air system cools the APU compartment and the APU engine oil. Compartment Cooling APU compartment cooling uses an eductor to pull outside air through the APU compartment. The high speed flow of the APU exhaust forms a low pressure area. This low pressure pulls outside air through the eductor inlet duct to the APU compartment. The cooling air then goes through the oil cooler and out the APU exhaust duct. B737 NG GEN FAM APU REFRESHER COURSE 8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 49-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM APU REFRESHER COURSE 9 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 49-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd MISCELLANEOUS EXTERIOR SERVICE DOORS – APU ACCESS DOOR Latches Purpose Three push-button latches hold the door closed. Moderate pressure on the push-button trigger will cause the latch to open. They are a fail-safe design. Failure of the trigger return mechanism will not cause the latch to open. When the latch is secure, the outer surface is similar in colour to adjacent structure. The other surfaces of the latch are a bright red fluorescent colour. This allows rapid visual detection of an unsecure latch. The APU access door gives access to the APU and its accessories. Location The APU access door is part of the lower surface of the fuselage. It is under the horizontal stabilizer. General Description Door Support Rods The APU access door has hinges on the right side. Three latches on the left side hold the door closed. The door swings downward as it opens. The APU access door has these parts: Door support rods hold the door in the open position. You deploy and stow the support rods manually. - Door frame and structure - Hinges - Latches - Door support rods - Fluid drain system - Lower APU fire detection element - Fire resistant liner and insulation Fluid Drain System A fluid drain system drains fluids from the APU compartment. Fluid collects in drain cups and flows in drain lines to the drain mast. The fluids then drain overboard through the mast. The drain mast has been relocated to an area forward of the APU access door. Door Frame and Structure Lower APU Fire Detection Element The door frame and structure is aluminium alloy extrusions and clad aluminium alloy sheet. The door does not hold pressure. The lower APU fire detection element is on the inner door liner. Hinges Fire Resistant Liner and Insulation Two hinges give the door a pivot axis. You remove the hinge pins to remove the door. B737 NG GEN FAM APU REFRESHER COURSE The inner surface of the door is fire resistant. The inside surface is covered with an insulating blanket and a titanium fire wall liner. 10 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 49-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM APU REFRESHER COURSE 11 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 49-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd APU POWER PLANT - AIR INLET DOOR COMPONENTS Purpose The air inlet door opens to let air into the engine and load compressor. The air inlet door closes at shutdown. The air inlet door is on the right forward side of the aft fuselage. Air Inlet Door Actuator The air inlet door actuator is a rotary electric actuator that opens and closes the air inlet door. The air inlet door actuator is on the inboard side of the inlet door housing forward of the APU compartment. Air Inlet Door Switch The air inlet door switch supplies a door open and door not open signal to the ECU. The switch is on the inboard side of the inlet door housing. Training Information Point You can open the air inlet door without a start cycle on the APU. To open the door, put the APU switch to the ON position. The air inlet door does not fully close. This prevents APU rotation during flight when the APU air inlet door is in the closed position. The air inlet door and actuator are adjustable. B737 NG GEN FAM APU REFRESHER COURSE 12 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 49-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM APU REFRESHER COURSE 13 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 49-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd APU CONTROLS – INTRODUCTION Purpose The APU controls provide control for the APU for all operating conditions. Flight Compartment Controls and Panels These are the APU controls and panels in the flight compartment: - APU switch (P5) - APU bleed air switch (P5) - APU generator switch (P5) - APU fire warning switch (P8) Other Control Components The P28 APU remote control panel is on the right wheel well aft bulkhead. The Electronic Control Unit (ECU) controls the APU operation when the ECU receives a signal from the controls in the flight compartment. The ECU is in the aft cargo compartment right side. The ECU also uses signals from certain APU and airplane systems for correct operation of the APU. B737 NG GEN FAM APU REFRESHER COURSE 14 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 49-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM APU REFRESHER COURSE 15 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 49-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK B737 NG GEN FAM APU REFRESHER COURSE 16 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 49-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ATA 52-00-00 DOORS B737 NG GEN FAM DOORS REFRESHER COURSE 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 52-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd CONTENTS ATA 52 – DOORS DOORS – INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 4 PURPOSE ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 4 GENERAL DESCRIPTION ......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 4 LOCATION .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 4 TRAINING INFORMATION POINT............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 4 FORWARD ENTRY DOOR .................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 6 PURPOSE ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 6 GENERAL DESCRIPTION ......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 DOOR CONTROL MECHANISMS .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 6 DOOR SUPPORT ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 DOOR SEALS .......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 DOOR DRAINS ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 6 DOOR WARNING .................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 TRAINING INFORMATION POINT............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 6 ENTRY AND SERVICE DOOR - ESCAPE SLIDES ......................................................................................................................................................................................... 8 PURPOSE ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 8 PHYSICAL DESCRIPTION ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 8 LOCATION .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 8 TRAINING INFORMATION POINT............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 8 ENTRY AND SERVICE DOOR - ESCAPE SLIDE OPERATION ................................................................................................................................................................ 10 OPERATION .......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 10 EMERGENCY EXIT DOOR – INTRODUCTION ........................................................................................................................................................................................... 12 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 12 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 12 GENERAL DESCRIPTION ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 12 B737 NG GEN FAM DOORS REFRESHER COURSE 2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 52-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd DOORS - CARGO - INTRODUCTION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 14 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 14 GENERAL DESCRIPTION ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 14 DOOR WARNING .................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 14 DOORS - FORWARD AIRSTAIR AND DOOR – AIRSTAIR ........................................................................................................................................................................ 16 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 16 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 16 PHYSICAL DESCRIPTION ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 16 GENERAL DESCRIPTION ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 16 OPERATIONAL DISPLAYS ..................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 16 TRAINING INFORMATION POINT........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 16 B737 NG GEN FAM DOORS REFRESHER COURSE 3 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 52-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd DOORS – INTRODUCTION Purpose Training Information Point The doors are removable units that give access to the airplane compartments. You can open and close entry, galley service, and cargo doors in winds up to 40 knots without structural damage. You can let these doors stay latched open in winds up to 65 knots without structural damage. If a door is left open for a long time, a protective cover should be put over the door frame. This prevents bad weather damage to the airplane. General Description These are the types of doors on the airplane: - Forward and aft entry doors - Forward and aft galley service doors - Emergency exit hatches (including pilots’ sliding windows) - Cargo doors - Interior doors (crew door and lavatory doors) - Miscellaneous access doors A door warning system shows the crew that pressure bearing doors are closed and properly latched before flight. All doors have silicon rubber seals. The seals do these things: - Seal air and light leaks - Act as acoustic and thermal barriers - Supply aerodynamic smoothness Location The entry doors are on the left side of the airplane. The galley service doors are on the right side of the airplane. The pilots’ sliding windows are in the flight compartment. The cargo doors are on the right side of the airplane. The crew door and lavatory doors are inside the airplane. The miscellaneous access doors are near the systems they serve. B737 NG GEN FAM DOORS REFRESHER COURSE 4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 52-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM DOORS REFRESHER COURSE 5 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 52-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd FORWARD ENTRY DOOR Purpose To close the door, first release the hinge lock and then do the open operations in reverse order. A guide pin on the door and a guide pin track on the door frame align the door in the door frame as it closes. The forward entry door gives access to the airplane passenger cabin. Location The forward entry door is on the left side of the upper, forward fuselage. General Description Door Support The forward entry door is the largest passenger entry door on the airplane. The door is a plug-type door. The door has these parts: When the airplane is unpressurized, the hinges support the door. When the airplane is pressurized, cabin pressure pushed the door slightly outboard. This causes the door seals to compress and the door stop pins contact the frame stop fittings. This transmits the door pressure loads to the door frame structure which unloads the door latches. - Centre door assembly - Upper gate - Lower gate Door Seals A liner covers the door’s interior surface. The centre door assembly has hard points at the bottom for the emergency escape slide installation. The centre door assembly has a window. The door has edge seals (flap and bulb type) and gate hinge seals (diaphragm type). Door Drains Door Control Mechanisms The door structure has internal drain paths. The door sections drain into the door frame threshold. The door threshold drains overboard through bladders in the lower fuselage. You can open and close the door from the interior or exterior of the airplane. You operate the door manually. Unlatch the door with the control handle. When you turn the handle in the OPEN direction, internal mechanisms do these things: Door Warning The forward entry door has an interface with the door warning system. There is a proximity switch assembly on the door frame adjacent to an upper latch track. The switch senses the position of the door latch roller. When the door is latched, it causes the P5 panel warning light to go out. - Disengage the door roller latches - Fold the door gates inward - Tilt the door’s hinge edge inward to the cocked position Then push the door through the door frame until it is fully open. Use the assist handles for this operation. A lock mechanism in the upper hinge locks the door in the fully open position. B737 NG GEN FAM DOORS REFRESHER COURSE Training Information Point The forward entry door is used as an example. All entry and galley service doors are similar in construction and operation. 6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 52-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM DOORS REFRESHER COURSE 7 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 52-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ENTRY AND SERVICE DOOR - ESCAPE SLIDES Each slide has these additional features: Purpose - Lifelines - Mooring line with a frangible link - Red handgrips Escape slides help passengers and crew evacuate the airplane in an emergency. If the airplane lands in water, you may disconnect the escape slides from the airplane and use them as flotation devices. Location Physical Description An escape slide is on the lower inboard face of each entry and service door. Escape slides are made of neoprene-coated nylon fabric. An aluminium coating provides protection from the effects of radiant heat. The sliding surface is a high strength, urethane-coated, nylon fabric. Each escape slide packs in a valise and stows inside a compartment on the aircraft exit door. Escape slides have quick-release detachable girts. This feature allows the escape slides to separate easily from the aircraft so you may use them as flotation devices in the event of a ditching. It also provides for simple girt replacement. Each escape slide installation has these parts: Training Information Point You arm and disarm the escape slide manually. When the escape slide is armed, the girt bar is secure in the escape slide floor brackets. When the escape slide is stowed (not armed), the girt bar is in the girt bar retainer hooks. Make sure the slide is not armed before you open the door. If you open the door when the slide is armed, the slide will deploy. - Escape slide compartment - Escape slide pack - Two floor brackets The escape slide compartment holds the slide pack in the stowed position and opens when you use the slide. The escape slide pack is inside the escape slide compartment. The entire assembly attaches to the lower inboard face of each entry and service door. The floor brackets are at the forward and aft ends of the doorways, inboard of the door sill. B737 NG GEN FAM DOORS REFRESHER COURSE 8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 52-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM DOORS REFRESHER COURSE 9 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 52-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ENTRY AND SERVICE DOOR - ESCAPE SLIDE OPERATION Operation To arm the escape slide, remove the girt bar from the stowage hooks on the door and install it in the floor brackets. Open the door as usual but do not hesitate until it is fully open. The girt strap will extend while you open the door. As you open the door, the girt latch assembly will let the slide pack fall out of the slide cover. As the slide pack falls, it will start the slide inflation. The escape slide will fully inflate in approximately six seconds. If the escape slide does not inflate automatically, pull the inflation handle sharply to inflate the escape slide manually. To remove the escape slide from the airplane, lift the cover flap and pull the girt release handle. The escape slide will remain connected to the airplane by the mooring line until the line is released, cut, or the frangible link breaks under load. Activation of the incandescent lighting system is automatic during inflation of the slide. B737 NG GEN FAM DOORS REFRESHER COURSE 10 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 52-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM DOORS REFRESHER COURSE 11 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 52-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd EMERGENCY EXIT DOOR – INTRODUCTION Purpose Emergency exit doors supply additional exits for the passengers in the event of an emergency. Location The emergency exit doors are above the wings. General Description There are four emergency exit doors on the 800 and two on the 700 and 600 aircraft. They all have the same construction features, but are adjusted separately to fit their fuselage frames. The doors have a window with an internal shade. An EXIT light attaches to the door cut-out lining above each door. An independent wash light fixture below the sign illuminates the hatch area. You can open the emergency exit door from inside or outside the airplane. The emergency exit doors operate with a spring loaded vent panel at the top of the hatch. The emergency exit doors connects with the door warning system. Each hatch frame has a switch on two of its latch tracks. A latch roller actuates the switch. With the hatch locked the P5 panel OVERWING EXIT warning lights goes out. B737 NG GEN FAM DOORS REFRESHER COURSE 12 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 52-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM DOORS REFRESHER COURSE 13 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 52-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd DOORS - CARGO - INTRODUCTION Door Warning Location The cargo doors have an interface with the door warning system. Each door has a switch on its latch mechanism, and a warning light on the P5 forward overhead panel. The cargo compartment doors are on the right side of the fuselage, on the lower lobe, forward and aft of the wing. General Description These are the two cargo doors: - Forward cargo door - Aft cargo door. The doors are similar in shape, design, and operation, but they are slightly different in size. The doors are plug-type. They open inward, and hinge at the top. Seals around the door edge and door handle shaft prevent pressurization loss. You operate the doors manually. This may be done from outside of the airplane or from inside the cargo compartment. A counter balance inside the door reduces the effort necessary to lift the door. An uplock detent in the counter balance mechanism holds the door in the fully open position. A door snubber makes sure the door does not fall quickly if the counter balance mechanism fails. A manual strap device in the cargo compartment ceiling can be used to hold the door in the fully open position. A bungee lanyard with a soft-grip handle on the door makes it easy to lower the door. B737 NG GEN FAM DOORS REFRESHER COURSE 14 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 52-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM DOORS REFRESHER COURSE 15 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 52-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd DOORS - FORWARD AIRSTAIR AND DOOR – AIRSTAIR Purpose The NORMAL mode uses airplane ac and dc power for operation. The STANDBY mode uses airplane dc and/or battery dc power. Battery power is locked out when there is a supply of airplane dc power. The forward airstair lets passengers and crew enter and exit the airplane without any ground support equipment. Location You can operate the airstair from inside or outside the airplane. The forward airstair is below the forward entry door. The interior control panel is on the forward attendant’s panel. The exterior control panel is aft of the airstair door on the fuselage skin. Mechanical and electrical interlocks prevent the accidental extension of the airstair in flight. The mechanical interlock is a lock pin that prevents the airstair door from opening. The electrical interlock is a circuit that disarms the interior control panel when the airplane is not on the ground. Physical Description The forward airstair has these parts: Operational Displays - Carriage - Upper ladder - Lower ladder - Handrails with extensions - Interior and exterior controls. The STAIRS OPERATING light on the interior control panel comes on during airstair operation. The light stays on as long as the airstair or airstair door is in any position other than end of extension or retraction. The airstair is part of the door warning system. The amber AIRSTAIR light comes on panel P5 when the airstair door is not closed and locked. General Description The airstair design allows for a height deviation from the airstair to the ground of 15 inches. This compensates for airplane loading and field deviations from level. The airstair is an electromechanical system and can operate in these modes: Training Information Point Do not operate the airstair when the airplane is jacked. Do not operate the airstair in any attitude that prevents the lower ladder from firm ground contact. Do not load the airstair if the lower ladder is not firmly on the ground or damage may result. - NORMAL mode when there is a supply of ac and dc power - STANDBY mode for operations when ac power is not available, or there is a failure in the normal circuits - Manually in the event of failure of all electric circuits. B737 NG GEN FAM DOORS REFRESHER COURSE 16 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 52-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM DOORS REFRESHER COURSE 17 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 52-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK B737 NG GEN FAM DOORS REFRESHER COURSE 18 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 52-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ATA 70/80-00-00 CFM56-7 ENGINE B737 NG GEN FAM ENGINE REFRESHER COURSE 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 70/80-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd CONTENTS ATA 70/80– CFM56-7 ENGINE ENGINE – INTRODUCTION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 4 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 4 ENGINE - GENERAL DESCRIPTION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 FAN AND BOOSTER / LOW PRESSURE COMPRESSOR (LPC) ................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 HIGH PRESSURE COMPRESSOR (HPC) ................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 COMBUSTOR .......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 6 POWER PLANT - ENGINE COWLING ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 8 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 8 INLET COWL .......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 8 FAN COWLS ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 8 IDG ACCESS DOOR ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 8 CHIP DETECTOR/PRESSURE RELIEF DOOR ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 8 VORTEX CONTROL DEVICE.................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 8 OIL TANK ACCESS DOOR ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 8 POWER PLANT - FAN COWL .......................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 10 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 10 FAN COWL LATCHES ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 10 FAN COWL HOLD OPEN RODS ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 10 THRUST REVERSER - TENSION LATCHES ................................................................................................................................................................................................ 12 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 12 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 12 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 12 TRAINING INFORMATION POINT........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 12 B737 NG GEN FAM ENGINE REFRESHER COURSE 2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 70/80-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd THRUST REVERSER - THRUST REVERSER OPENING ACTUATOR .................................................................................................................................................... 14 PURPOSE .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 14 LOCATION ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 14 FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION.................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 14 OPERATION .......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 14 TRAINING INFORMATION POINT........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 14 ENGINE CONTROLS - GENERAL DESCRIPTION ...................................................................................................................................................................................... 16 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 16 THRUST LEVERS .................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 16 START LEVERS ..................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 16 REVERSE THRUST INTERLOCK SOLENOIDS .......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 16 ENGINE CONTROL - ELECTRONIC ENGINE CONTROL (EEC) ............................................................................................................................................................ 18 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 18 B737 NG GEN FAM ENGINE REFRESHER COURSE 3 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 70/80-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ENGINE – INTRODUCTION General General engine data for the CFM56-7 engine is shown. These items show on the engine nameplate: - Regulatory agency data - Engine manufacture data - Engine performance data Six additional blank lines are available to show performance information if the engine thrust rating changes. This permits six different thrust rating changes before you must replace the nameplate. The nameplate also shows the thrust rating history of the engine. The engine nameplate is on the right fan case aft of the oil tank. B737 NG GEN FAM ENGINE REFRESHER COURSE 4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 70/80-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM ENGINE REFRESHER COURSE 5 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 70/80-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ENGINE - GENERAL DESCRIPTION General High Pressure Compressor (HPC) The CFM56-7 is a high bypass, dual rotor, axial flow turbofan engine. The engine fan diameter is 61 inches (1.55 meters). The bare engine weight is 5257 pounds (2385 kilograms). The engine has these sections: The HPC is a nine-stage compressor. It increases the pressure of the air from the LPC and sends it to the combustor. The HPC also supplies bleed air for the aircraft pneumatic system and the engine air system. - Fan and booster / Low Pressure Compressor (LPC) - High Pressure Compressor (HPC) - Combustor - High Pressure Turbine (HPT) - Low Pressure Turbine (LPT) - Accessory drive The combustor mixes air from the compressors and fuel from the fuel nozzles. This mixture of air and fuel burns in the combustion chamber to make hot gases. The hot gases go to the HPT. Combustor High Pressure Turbine (HPT) The HPT is a single-stage turbine. It changes the energy of the hot gases into a mechanical energy. The HPT uses this mechanical energy to turn the HPC rotor and the accessory drive. The fan and booster rotor and the LPT rotor are on the same low pressure shaft (N1). The HPC rotor and HPT rotor are on the same high pressure shaft (N2). Low Pressure Turbine (LPT) Fan and Booster / Low Pressure Compressor (LPC) The LPT is a four-stage turbine. It changes the energy of the hot gases into a mechanical energy. The LPT uses this mechanical energy to turn the fan and booster rotor. The fan and booster is a four-stage compressor. The fan increases the speed of the air. The primary air flow goes into the core of the engine. The booster increases the pressure of this air and sends it to the HPC. The secondary air flow goes in the fan duct. It supplies approximately 80 percent of the thrust during take-off. Accessory Drive The accessory drive is driven by the N2 shaft and operates the airplane accessories and the engine accessories. B737 NG GEN FAM ENGINE REFRESHER COURSE 6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 70/80-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM ENGINE REFRESHER COURSE 7 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 70/80-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd POWER PLANT - ENGINE COWLING IDG Access Door General The IDG access door permits access to the IDG for servicing. It is on the left fan cowl panel. The engine cowling gives an aerodynamically smooth surface into and over the engine. It also gives a protective area for engine components and accessories. These are the parts of the engine cowling: Chip Detector/Pressure Relief Door The chip detector access door permits access to the chip detectors. It also is a pressure relief door. It is on the left fan cowl. - Inlet cowl - Fan cowl - Thrust reverser Vortex Control Device Inlet Cowl The vortex control device smoothes airflow around the wing. It is on the inboard fan cowl. The inlet cowl sends air into the engine. The inlet cowl attaches to the engine. Oil Tank Access Door Fan Cowls The oil tank access door permits access to the oil tank for servicing. It is on the right fan cowl The fan cowls give an aerodynamically smooth surface over the fan case. The fan cowls attach to the fan cowl support beam. The fan cowls open for maintenance. These items are on the fan cowls: - IDG access door - Chip detector/pressure relief door - Vortex control device - Oil tank access door B737 NG GEN FAM ENGINE REFRESHER COURSE 8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 70/80-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM ENGINE REFRESHER COURSE 9 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 70/80-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd POWER PLANT - FAN COWL General There are two fan cowls for each engine. Each fan cowl attaches to the strut with three hinges. The fan cowls are made of aluminium. The left fan cowl weighs 80 lbs (36 kg). The right fan cowl weighs 96 lbs (44 kgs). Each fan cowl has two fan cowl hold open rods. Fan Cowl Latches Three fan cowl latches secure the left and right fan cowls together. All latches are along the bottom of the fan cowls. Fan Cowl Hold Open Rods One end of each hold open rod attaches to the fan cowl. When the cowl is closed, the other end attaches to a receiver on the fan cowl. When the cowl is open, the other end attaches to a receiver on the engine. Each hold open rod is telescopic. Each hold open rod has a collar that locks the hold open rod in place. A yellow lock indication shows when the hold open rod is in the locked position. B737 NG GEN FAM ENGINE REFRESHER COURSE 10 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 70/80-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM ENGINE REFRESHER COURSE 11 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 70/80-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd THRUST REVERSER - TENSION LATCHES Purpose The tension latches hold the T/R halves together. General There are six tension latches for each T/R. Numbers identify each latch. Latch number one is the latch most forward. Latch number six is the latch most aft. All latches are interchangeable. Location All tension latches are at the bottom of the T/R halves. The latch handles and mechanisms are on the left T/R half. The latch keeper pins are on the right T/R half. Training Information Point Always open the latches in order from aft (No. 6) to forward (No. 1). Always close the latches in order from forward (No. 1) to aft (No. 6). You can use the latch lever tool (special tool) to help bring the T/R halves together. This makes it easy to close the tension latches. B737 NG GEN FAM ENGINE REFRESHER COURSE 12 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 70/80-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM ENGINE REFRESHER COURSE 13 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 70/80-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd THRUST REVERSER - THRUST REVERSER OPENING ACTUATOR Training Information Point Purpose The leading edge flaps can extend and damage the T/R cowls (halves) when they are in the open (maintenance) position. Follow the AMM procedures to prevent the leading edge flap operation before you open the T/Rs. An actuator safety lock is usually put around the T/R opening actuator's rod after the T/R cowl is open. The actuator safety lock is a safety device and backs up the lock collar if it fails. Two quick release pins hold the actuator safety lock around the T/R opening actuator rod. You use a hold open fitting (special tool) to keep the T/R halves open during an engine change. This fitting holds the T/R halves at approximately 45 degrees open. The outboard T/R halves can open more than 45 degrees. A hold open rod can keep these T/R halves open at 55 degrees. You use the T/R opening actuator to open the T/R cowl (half). Each engine has two T/R opening actuators. Each actuator opens its cowl to approximately 45 from the closed position. Location Each T/R opening actuator is on the forward face of its T/R cowl. The upper end of the T/R opening actuator attaches to the T/R cowl. The lower end attaches to the engine fan frame extension ring. You open the fan cowls to gain access to the T/R opening actuators. Functional Description WARNING: MAKE SURE YOU DO THE DEACTIVATION PROCEDURE FOR THE THRUST REVERSER. IF THE THRUST REVERSER IS NOT LOCKED, IT CAN ACCIDENTALLY OPERATE AND CAUSE INJURY TO PERSONS AND DAMAGE TO EQUIPMENT. Fluid from the hand pump causes the T/R opening actuator rod to extend and open the T/R cowl. As the actuator approaches the full extend position, the lock collar goes into the lock position. A red band on the rod shows when the collar is in the lock position. Fluid goes from the opening actuator back to the hand pump when you close the T/R cowl. WARNING: DO NOT OPERATE THE OPENING SYSTEM FOR THE THRUST REVERSER IF THE WIND VELOCITY IS MORE THAN 40 KNOTS. THE OPENING SYSTEM FOR THE THRUST REVERSER CAN HAVE A FAILURE IN LARGE WINDS WHICH CAN CAUSE INJURY TO PERSONS AND DAMAGE TO EQUIPMENT. Operation WARNING: IF YOU USE THE MANUAL PROCEDURE TO OPEN THE THRUST REVERSER AGAIN AND AGAIN, THE HYDRAULIC FLUID FOR THE POWER OPENING SYSTEM CAN DECREASE. THIS WILL DECREASE THE SNUBBING ACTION. IF THE HYDRAULIC FLUID IN THE POWER OPENING SYSTEM DECREASES, THE REVERSER HALF CAN CLOSE TOO FAST. THIS CAN CAUSE INJURY TO PERSONS AND DAMAGE TO EQUIPMENT. YOU MUST OPEN AND CLOSE THE REVERSER HALVES REGULARLY WITH THE PUMP METHOD TO REPLACE THE HYDRAULIC FLUID. There are two procedures to open the T/Rs. The pump procedure is the best. You use the manual procedure only if no pump is available. You usually use a hand pump to operate the T/R opening actuator. As the rod extends, the T/R cowl opens and the lock collar moves into the lock position. You can see and hear the lock collar move to the lock position. The red band confirms the lock collar position. With the manual procedure, you lift and move the cowl up until the actuator lock goes into the lock position. B737 NG GEN FAM ENGINE REFRESHER COURSE 14 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 70/80-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM ENGINE REFRESHER COURSE 15 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 70/80-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ENGINE CONTROLS - GENERAL DESCRIPTION Reverse Thrust Interlock Solenoids General There are two reverse thrust interlock solenoids, one for each engine. Each reverse thrust interlock solenoid limits the range of motion of a reverse thrust lever. You can make the thrust reverser deploy, but you can not increase the reverse thrust until the thrust reverser sleeves are near the full deployed position. The engine control system supplies manual and automatic control inputs to operate the engine. The engine control system has these components: - Thrust levers (forward and reverse) - Engine start levers and switches - Thrust lever interlock solenoids Thrust Levers You use the thrust levers to supply the manual inputs to the engine control system. There are two thrust lever assemblies, one for each engine. For each engine, there is a forward thrust lever and a reverse thrust lever. The reverse thrust lever is on the forward thrust lever. For each engine, the thrust levers supply a thrust command signal to the Electronic Engine Control (EEC) through a resolver. Each thrust lever assembly connects mechanically to a resolver through an adjustable rod. An interlock latch prevents the operation of the forward thrust lever and the reverse thrust lever at the same time. Start Levers There are two start levers, one for each engine. You use the engine start lever during an engine start. You also use it to shutdown the engine. The start levers operate switches which supply signals to different aircraft and engine systems and components. B737 NG GEN FAM ENGINE REFRESHER COURSE 16 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 70/80-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM ENGINE REFRESHER COURSE 17 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 70/80-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd ENGINE CONTROL - ELECTRONIC ENGINE CONTROL (EEC) General The Electronic Engine Control (EEC) is the primary control for the engine fuel and control system. The EEC uses digital and analogue signals for other systems control and monitoring data. The EEC is a two channel computer with an active control channel and a standby channel. The two channels are A and B. The two channels operation. The EEC receives information to calculate command logic signals from channel A or channel B. The EEC sends the control signals to operate the engine. B737 NG GEN FAM ENGINE REFRESHER COURSE 18 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 70/80-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM ENGINE REFRESHER COURSE 19 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 70/80-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK B737 NG GEN FAM ENGINE REFRESHER COURSE 20 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 70/80-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd. AMET Ltd B737 NG GEN FAM ENGINE REFRESHER COURSE 21 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 70/80-00-00 Version 1 AMET Ltd.